Aviation Brigade
Aviation Brigade
Aviation Brigade
Aviation Brigades
AUGUST 2003
Aviation Brigades
Contents
Page
PREFACE................................................................................................................... x
Chapter 1 FUNDAMENTALS, MISSIONS, ORGANIZATION .................................................. 1-1
Section I – General ................................................................................................. 1-1
Brigade Types .......................................................................................................... 1-1
Organization ............................................................................................................. 1-2
Brigade Missions ...................................................................................................... 1-2
Fundamentals........................................................................................................... 1-3
Training..................................................................................................................... 1-5
Section II – Corps Aviation Brigade ..................................................................... 1-6
Corps Aviation Brigade Mission .............................................................................. 1-6
Corps Aviation Brigade Organization ...................................................................... 1-6
Corps Aviation Brigade Fundamentals .................................................................... 1-6
Section III – Attack Helicopter Regiment (Corps Aviation Brigade).................. 1-7
Corps Attack Helicopter Regiment Mission ............................................................. 1-7
Corps Attack Helicopter Regiment Organization...................................................... 1-8
Corps Attack Helicopter Regiment Fundamentals ................................................... 1-8
Section IV – Aviation Group (Corps Aviation Brigade) ...................................... 1-9
Aviation Group Mission............................................................................................. 1-9
Aviation Group Organization .................................................................................... 1-9
Aviation Group Fundamentals................................................................................ 1-10
Section V – Division Aviation Brigade (Heavy Division) ...................................1-10
Aviation Brigade (Heavy Division) Mission..............................................................1-10
Aviation Brigade (Heavy Division) Organization..................................................... 1-10
Aviation Brigade (Heavy Division) Fundamentals .................................................. 1-11
Section VI – Division Aviation Brigade (Light Division) ................................... 1-12
Aviation Brigade (Light Division) Mission ............................................................... 1-12
Aviation Brigade (Light Division) Organization ....................................................... 1-13
i
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Page
ii
Contents
Page
iii
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Page
iv
Contents
Page
v
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Page
vi
Contents
Page
Overview................................................................................................................. 5-40
Task Organization Considerations ......................................................................... 5-40
How to Fight ........................................................................................................... 5-40
Section XII – Army Special Operations Aviation Regiment ............................. 5-42
vii
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Page
viii
Contents
Page
ix
Preface
The operational concepts in this field manual (FM) are based on Army doctrine as
established in FM 1 (FM 100-1) and FM 3-0 (FM 100-5). This manual is intended
for all Army aviation commanders, staffs, and any U.S. military personnel
expecting to conduct operations with Army aviation units.
This FM applies to the transition force across the full range of military
operations—stability and support operations (SASO), small scale contingencies
(SSC), and major theater war (MTW).
This FM covers each type aviation brigade in the Army, based on transition force
organization and force structure. The focus throughout this manual is how to
fight and sustain. It also will help Army branch schools teach Army aviation
brigade operations.
To standardize doctrine and simplify updates, the United States Army Aviation
Center (USAAVNC) is standardizing the format of aviation battalion and air
cavalry squadron manuals to match FM 3.04-111 (FM 1-111). Each manual will
contain the same chapter titles, in the same sequence, and corresponding
chapters of each manual will contain similar content. All appendices to this
manual also apply to the manuals listed below. When rewritten, these manuals
will not contain appendices unless a special demand exists for unit-specific
information.
• FM 3-04.112 (FM 1-112).
• FM 3-04.113 (FM 1-113).
• FM 3-04.114 (FM 1-114).
This manual applies to the Active Component (AC), Reserve Component (RC),
and Army civilians. It builds on the collective knowledge and experience gained
through recent operations, many exercises, and the deliberate process of
informed reasoning. It is rooted in time-tested principles and fundamentals,
while addressing new technologies and diverse threats to national security.
Finally, this FM furnishes a foundation for subordinate doctrine, force design,
materiel acquisition, professional education, and individual and unit training.
The proponent for this publication is the USAAVNC. Send comments and
recommended changes to Commander, USAAVNC, ATTN: ATZQ-TDS-D, Fort
Rucker, AL 36362.
Unless this publication states otherwise, masculine nouns or pronouns do not
refer exclusively to men.
x
Chapter 1
The aviation brigade is organized and equipped to support both Joint and
Army operations. It conducts continuous combat, combat support (CS),
and combat service support (CSS) operations throughout the depth and
breadth of the battlefield. Aviation brigades are found at every echelon
from the division to corps, field army, and theater command. Although
their organization and composition are different at each level, and their
principal focus can range from attack to support, each brigade follows
time-tested fundamentals to achieve success on the battlefield. Those
fundamentals are discussed in section I of this chapter. Following Section
I are sections for each of the 11 brigade-sized organizations, their
principal mission focus, and general comments.
SECTION I – GENERAL
BRIGADE TYPES
1-2. The Transition Force consists of 11 distinct types of aviation brigades.
The following brigade-sized organizations called regiments or group are
included:
• Corps Aviation Brigade.
• Attack Helicopter Regiment (Corps Aviation Brigade).
• Aviation Group (Corps Aviation Brigade).
• Division Aviation Brigade (Heavy Division).
• Division Aviation Brigade (Light Division).
1-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
ORGANIZATION
1-3. A brigade-sized organization has at least one headquarters and
headquarters company (HHC) and three subordinate battalions. Throughout
this manual, for readability, the term HHC includes a headquarters and
headquarters troop (HHT); and the term battalion includes squadron. The
terms HHT and squadron may be used when specifically discussing cavalry
organizations.
1-4. The HHC provides personnel and equipment for the C2 functions of the
brigade and security and defense of the command post (CP).
1-5. The numbers and types of subordinate battalions are based on the
brigade's mission. Although separate companies may be assigned, attached,
or under operational control (OPCON) to brigades, it presents challenges for
C2 as the brigade staff must also prepare plans and orders on the level of
detail normally found at the battalion level.
BRIGADE MISSIONS
1-6. Each brigade is tailored for specific missions as discussed in this
chapter. However, each brigade accepts other organizations and performs
missions not necessarily defined in the table of organization and equipment
(TOE) mission statement.
1-7. When task-organized with the appropriate assets from other aviation
brigades, all brigades can perform any of the traditional combat, CS, and CSS
missions. Each brigade, despite its structure, can plan, coordinate, and
execute reconnaissance, security, attack, air assault, air movement, and C2
operations. However, depending on their level of training, the TAB, the
aviation group in the corps aviation brigade, and the air assault division's
assault brigade may require augmentation to their staffs to conduct cavalry
and attack missions. Conversely, the attack regiment in the corps aviation
brigade and the air assault division's attack helicopter brigade may require
augmentation to their staffs to conduct air assault operations.
1-8. The appropriate section in this chapter describes each brigade's mission.
Chapters four through six describes each brigade’s operational aspects.
COMBAT MISSIONS
1-9. Aviation maneuver forces engage in destroying enemy forces by direct
and indirect fire. These missions include—
• Reconnaissance/surveillance.
• Security.
1-2
Chapter One
• Attack.
• Air assault.
• Fire support (FS).
• Joint Air Attack Team (JAAT).
• Defensive air combat.
1-10. Aspects of security missions include the following:
• All aviation maneuver forces can conduct screening operations. When
task-organized with ground units, they can screen over wider areas and
for longer time.
• Commensurate with their level of training to operate with ground
forces, when task-organized with the appropriate ground units, aviation
units can conduct guard operations.
• Aviation units normally do not conduct covering force operations, but do
participate in covering force operations as part of a larger force.
FUNDAMENTALS
1-13. Commanders and staffs must be fully aware of the battlefield operating
systems (BOS):
• Intelligence.
• Maneuver.
• FS.
• Air defense (AD).
• Mobility, countermobility, and survivability.
• CSS.
1-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
• C2.
1-14. All aviation brigades must be able to conduct—
• Strategic deployment by land, sea, or air (Appendix C).
• Administrative and tactical movements (Appendix D).
1-15. All aviation brigade headquarters must simultaneously—
• C2 multiple and diverse subordinate units.
• Conduct multiple current operations.
• Plan multiple future operations.
• Protect and sustain their forces.
1-16. All aviation brigade headquarters must conduct liaison simultaneously
with—
• Higher headquarters main, tactical CP, rear CP.
• Forward brigades.
• The reserve.
1-17. Corps and division aviation brigades, groups, and regiments must
simultaneously—
• C2 ground maneuver units.
• Coordinate as required with the deep operations coordination cell
(DOCC).
1-18. All aviation units must accomplish operations during any of the
following conditions:
• As a subordinate unit assigned, attached, OPCON, or tactical control
(TACON), to another service.
• Near ground forces.
• Day or night.
• Limited visibility (crew instrument meteorological conditions [IMC]
proficiency is critical).
• NBC.
• High altitude flight operations (engine power management skills are
paramount).
• All environments, such as desert, mountain, rolling hills, dense forest,
jungle, plains, urban, extreme cold weather, over water, shipboard.
• Operations with external fuel tanks (except OH-58D).
1-19. Each aviation unit must be proficient in the following areas:
• Ground gunnery (crew-served and individual weapons).
• Defensive air combat.
• Passage of lines.
• Formation flight.
• Terrain flight (low-level, contour, nap-of-the-earth [NOE]).
• Movement techniques (travelling, travelling overwatch, bounding
overwatch).
• Airfield and forward arming and refueling point (FARP) operations.
• Emergency procedures (aircraft, refueling, weapons malfunction).
1-4
Chapter One
TRAINING
1-23. The key to successful training is to assemble the required elements and
to train to standard (combined arms training strategies [CATS], MTPs,
ATMs, STPs), beginning at home station and extending to all operations.
Critical to effective training are opposing forces (OPFOR); observer
controllers (OCs); feedback systems, such as the multiple integrated laser
engagement system/air-ground engagement system (MILES/AGES) II,
tactical engagement simulator system (TESS), or aviation survivability
equipment trainer (ASET IV); higher and adjacent headquarters; and
supported headquarters for air-ground integration.
1-24. Training can be a major challenge, especially if the other elements of
the corps or division are not available for concurrent training. That challenge
is further complicated if MILES/AGES II, TESS, or ASET-IV is not available
for feedback. When those elements are not available, the aviation brigade
must develop alternatives. Elements that represent supporting, supported,
and higher elements (usually called white cells) can be assembled and
trained to represent those headquarters. Vehicles from within the brigade
can be organized to replicate OPFOR target arrays. The ground elements of
the cavalry squadron can replicate the supported force for divisional brigades.
1-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
1-6
Chapter One
1-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
1-8
Chapter One
1-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
1-10
Chapter One
1-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
conditions for success for each of its units in their support of the ground
maneuver commander. The brigade must be prepared to fight as a whole. It
must be prepared to provide aviation support for multiple missions requiring
pure or task-organized units.
1-52. The cavalry squadron fights under division or aviation brigade control.
Its primary missions are reconnaissance and security.
1-53. The ATKHB fights in close coordination with divisional ground units
and conducts shaping operations. It also conducts reconnaissance and
security missions.
1-54. The GSAB provides DS and GS to all elements of the division. These
include ground brigades, DISCOM, division artillery (DIVARTY), signal
battalion, the aviation brigade, the cavalry squadron, the ATKHB, and the
DASB.
1-12
Chapter One
1-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
1-14
Chapter One
1-15
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
1-16
Chapter One
1-17
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
1-18
Chapter One
1-19
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
1-20
Chapter One
ORGANIZATION
1-98. The ARSOAR (Figure 1-11) consists of an HHC, three battalions,
separate forward-deployed companies, a special operations aviation training
company (SOATC), and a systems integration and maintenance office
(SIMO). The ARSOAR's rotary-wing aircraft include the AH/MH-6, MH-60,
MH-60 variant known as the defensive armed penetrator (DAP), and MH-47.
1-21
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
ARSOA units are designed to plan, conduct, and support special operations
missions unilaterally or jointly in all theaters and at all levels of conflict. To
accomplish this mission, ARSOA units are task-organized according to the
unit they will support, the theater of operations, and expected missions.
ARSOA task organizations are formed around one of the regiment's
battalions.
FUNDAMENTALS
1-99. ARSOA units are trained and equipped to infiltrate, resupply, and
exfiltrate U.S. SOF and other designated personnel. Training is tailored
specifically to profiles that support the SOF mission. Units prefer to operate
at night, using night vision goggles (NVG) or night vision systems (NVS) and
low-level flight profiles. Training is conducted in all operational
environments and terrain—desert, mountain, jungle, urban, over water.
Inherent in the training is the ability to operate from maritime platforms.
1-22
Chapter One
Emphasis is placed on precise navigation over long range and under adverse
weather conditions.
1-100. ARSOA aircraft are modified to add the capability for aerial refueling
and to enhance precise navigation, secure communications, long-range flight
performance, and increased weapons lethality. These enhancements give
ARSOA the unique capability to take advantage of adverse weather, limited
visibility, or low-cloud ceilings. These conditions provide concealment for air
operations and help achieve surprise.
1-101. Organic attack helicopter aircrews are specifically trained to provide
close air support (CAS) and terminal guidance for precision munitions to
support SOF.
1-23
Chapter 2
INTRODUCTION
2-1. The modern battlefield may be linear, nonlinear, or both. Despite its
configuration, commanders employ decisive, shaping, and sustaining
operations to accomplish assigned missions. The aviation brigade is a key
maneuver and support force for these operations.
2-0
Chapter Two
DECISIVE OPERATIONS
2-4. There is only one decisive operation for any major operation, battle, or
engagement for any given echelon. It may include multiple actions conducted
simultaneously throughout the area of operations (AO). Commanders weight
the decisive operation by economizing combat power allocated to shaping
operations.
2-5. The aviation brigade participates in and supports decisive operations
by—
• Finding, fixing, and destroying enemy forces.
• Conducting air assaults and air movement.
• Emplacing minefields.
• Supporting C2 operations.
SHAPING OPERATIONS
2-6. Shaping operations establish conditions for the successful decisive
operation by setting the battlefield to our advantage. Shaping includes lethal
and nonlethal operations to make the enemy vulnerable to attack and impede
or divert his attempts to maneuver. It also facilitates the maneuver of
friendly forces, enhances deception, or otherwise dictates the time and place
for decisive battle. Through shaping, commanders gain the initiative,
preserve momentum, and control the tempo of combat.
2-7. When expressing their intent, commanders clearly and succinctly define
how the effects of shaping operations support the decisive operation. Shaping
operations may occur with, before, or after initiation of decisive operations.
They may involve any combination of forces.
2-8. Some shaping operations, especially those that occur simultaneously
with the decisive operation, are economy of force actions. If the available force
does not permit simultaneous decisive and shaping operations, the
2-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
SUSTAINING OPERATIONS
2-10. Sustaining operations generate and maintain combat power. Failure to
sustain normally results in failure of the overall effort. Sustaining operations
at any echelon are those that help the shaping and decisive operations by
assuring freedom of action and continuity of operations, such as CSS and C2.
Sustaining operations include CSS, sustainment base security and
maintenance, movement control, terrain management, and protection of lines
of communication (LOC) and headquarters.
2-11. Sustaining operations are inseparable from decisive and shaping
operations, although they are not by themselves decisive or shaping.
Sustaining operations occur throughout the AO. They underwrite the tempo
of the overall operation, assuring the ability to take advantage of any
opportunity without delay.
2-12. The assault and HvyHBs are ideal for sustaining operations. Air
cavalry and attack forces, coupled with the mobile and agile aerial C2
platforms, are excellent forces for protecting sustainment forces as they move
from one location to another or in their assembly areas (AAs).
NONLINEAR OPERATIONS
2-13. Nonlinear operations now characterize mission environments more
than ever. A nonlinear battlefield lacks the traditional grid of close, deep, and
rear areas. The resulting battle space is fluid, changing throughout mission
preparation and execution. In the nonlinear environment, aviation is an
essential force for success.
2-14. Within the nonlinear environment, maneuver units may be deployed in
contiguous or noncontiguous AOs (Figures 2-1 and 2-2). Even when operating
in contiguous AOs, maneuver forces orient on assigned objectives without
geographic reference to adjacent forces. These operations typically focus on
multiple decisive points. Most decisive results occur when distributed
operations (attacking the enemy at multiple locations) are synchronized to
achieve simultaneous effects. SASO normally are nonlinear with
noncontiguous AOs.
2-15. Nonlinear and linear operations are not mutually exclusive. Depending
upon perspective and echelon, operations often combine nonlinear and linear
characteristics. For example, a brigade may be deployed in a nonlinear
manner, while its battalions or some companies are deployed linearly with
respect to each other.
2-2
Chapter Two
2-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
LINEAR OPERATIONS
2-16. Traditional linear operations involve conventional combat and
concentrated maneuver forces. Ground forces share boundaries and orient
against a similarly organized enemy force. Terrain or friendly forces secure
flanks and protect CSS operations.
2-17. Despite the increasing nonlinear nature of operations, linearity still
characterizes many operations or phases of operations. When U.S. forces lack
sufficient information, are severely outnumbered, or when the threat to LOCs
reduces freedom of action, a force may conduct linear operations to
concentrate and synchronize combat power. In some multinational
operations, the capabilities and doctrine of partners may dictate this spatial
organization of the AO. In such situations commanders direct and focus on
close, deep, and rear area operations. The aviation brigade contributes in
combat, CS, and CSS by providing reconnaissance, security, attack, assault,
utility, heavy helicopter, CASEVAC, and C2 forces (Figure 2-3).
CLOSE AREAS
2-18. The close area is that area where the commander envisions close
combat taking place or being imminent. Here he seeks to overmatch the
enemy by synchronizing combat effects using maneuver and supporting fires
to produce a decision. Subordinate commanders engaged in the force
commander's close area designate their own close, deep, and rear areas.
2-19. Fratricide avoidance is an especially important consideration when
operating near friendly ground forces. Avoidance is enhanced by—
• Detailed planning and coordination by the aviation brigade and its
subordinate units with supported ground units.
• Accurate unit locations, times, frequencies, and recognition signals.
• Well-rehearsed plans, fully supported by tested battle drills involving
all elements of the air and ground force.
• Common standing operating procedures (SOP) and exercises to hone
skills.
DEEP AREAS
2-20. The deep area is an area forward of the close area that commanders
use to shape enemy forces before they are encountered or engaged in the close
area. Typically, the deep area extends from the forward boundary of
subordinate units to the forward boundary of the controlling echelon. Thus,
the deep area relates to the close area not only in terms of geography but also
in terms of purpose and time. The aviation brigade depends heavily on its
higher headquarters to develop the intelligence necessary to successfully
execute operations in deep areas.
2-4
Chapter Two
REAR AREAS
2-21. The rear area is a specific area within the AO used primarily for the
performance of support functions. The majority of sustaining operations occur
in the rear areas. Operations in rear areas assure freedom of action,
continuity of operations, sustainment, and C2. The rear area may be
contiguous with or separate from a close area. On a linear battlefield, the
rear area for any particular command is the area extending forward from its
rear boundary to the rear of the area assigned to the next lower level of
command. On the nonlinear battlefield, it may be difficult to define rear
areas. In essence, rear areas are wherever there are no ground maneuver
forces within the higher headquarters AO. The ability of the aviation brigade
2-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
to rapidly react to enemy incursions and to move personnel and cargo allows
it to contribute greatly to rear area operations. However, the potential for
fratricide may be the greatest in the rear area. Detailed planning and
coordination, preplanned reaction drills, SOPs, and rehearsals serve to
reduce this risk.
SOURCES
2-24. Highly accurate SA is generated from many sources. These sources
include national assets, UAV, Army aviation, and the many other command,
control, communications, computers, intelligence, surveillance, and
reconnaissance (C4ISR) assets.
2-25. The front line soldier is another extremely valuable intelligence source.
Commanders should instill in all crew members that they are reconnaissance
soldiers. Their sightings and reporting of any activity may make the
difference between victory and defeat.
2-6
Chapter Two
INTELLIGENCE TEMPLATES
2-28. The S2 section provides graphic displays of doctrinal, situation, event,
and decision support templates (DSTs).
Doctrinal Template
2-30. Doctrinal templates illustrate the disposition and activity of enemy
forces and assets conducting a particular operation unconstrained by the
effects of the battle space. They represent the application of enemy doctrine
under ideal conditions. Ideally, doctrinal templates depict the enemy's
normal organization for combat, frontages, depths, boundaries and other
control measures. The staff uses the doctrinal template as a guide and
modifies the portrayed dispositions to take advantage of available defensive
terrain. It also uses doctrinal templates to determine the likely locations of
high-value targets (HVTs). For unconventional operations, asynchronous
templates can be developed as enemy patterns of operations emerge.
Situation Template
2-31. Situation templates are graphic depictions of expected threat
dispositions should the threat adopt a particular course of action (COA). They
usually depict the most critical point in the operation as agreed upon by the
intelligence and operations officers. The staff uses situation templates to
support staff war gaming and develops event templates.
2-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Event Template
2-32. The differences between the named areas of interest (NAI), indicators,
and target priority lists (TPL) associated with each COA form the basis of the
event template. The event template is a guide for collection and intelligence,
surveillance, and reconnaissance (ISR) planning. It depicts where to collect
the information that will indicate which COA the threat has adopted.
COMMANDER'S INTENT
2-35. A clearly stated commander's intent, combined with specific
commander's critical information requirements (CCIR), is fundamental to
gain the intelligence information needed for the unit to accomplish its
missions. These also provide the focus required to understand critical
information throughout the aviation brigade.
2-8
Chapter Two
includes the collective and coordinated use of target acquisition data and
indirect fire weapons. It also includes fixed-wing aircraft, armed helicopters,
electronic warfare (EW), and other lethal and nonlethal means to attack
targets. FS plans must be integrated and synchronized with the aviation
brigade scheme of maneuver, consistent with the commander's intent, and
with A2C2.
MOBILITY/COUNTERMOBILITY/SURVIVABILITY BATTLEFIELD
OPERATING SYSTEM
2-40. The aviation brigade contributes directly or indirectly to each of these
operations.
MOBILITY
2-41. Mobility operations preserve friendly force freedom of maneuver. They
include breaching obstacles, increasing battlefield circulation, improving or
building roads, providing bridge and raft support, and identifying routes
around contaminated areas. Aviation assets can perform reconnaissance to
find adequate sites and routes, insert personnel and equipment, and provide
overwatch for ground operations.
COUNTERMOBILITY
2-42. Countermobility denies mobility to enemy forces. It limits the
maneuver of enemy forces and enhances the effectiveness of friendly fires.
Countermobility missions include obstacle building and smoke generation.
Aviation can perform reconnaissance to find appropriate sites and routes for
obstacle emplacement. They can insert engineers and materiel to create
obstacles and provide overwatch for ground operations. Selected UH-60s can
emplace minefields with the Volcano system, while air cavalry and attack
assets can provide fires to cover obstacles and employ white phosphorous
rockets to provide smoke.
SURVIVABILITY
2-43. Survivability operations protect friendly forces from the effects of
enemy weapons systems and from natural occurrences. Hardening of
facilities and fortification of battle positions (BPs) are active survivability
measures. Military deception, operations security (OPSEC), and dispersion
also increase survivability. NBC defense measures are essential survivability
2-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
tasks. Aviation can perform reconnaissance to find adequate sites and routes.
They can insert or extract personnel and equipment and provide overwatch
for ground operations. They also can conduct aerial surveys of known or
suspected NBC contaminated areas.
2-44. The brigade enhances aircrew survivability by mission planning,
coordination, and aircraft survivability equipment (ASE) settings based on
threat analysis. Appendix J addresses aircraft survivability.
CHARACTERISTICS OF OPERATIONS
2-48. Aviation brigade missions are offensively oriented and are typically the
same whether the division or corps is attacking or defending. Fundamental to
the success of operations are the characteristics of surprise, concentration,
tempo, and audacity.
SURPRISE
2-49. Surprise is attacking the enemy at a time or place or in a manner for
which they are unprepared and do not expect. It delays enemy reactions,
2-10
Chapter Two
CONCENTRATION
2-51. Concentration is the massing of overwhelming combat power to achieve
a single purpose. Commanders concentrate forces to the degree necessary to
achieve overwhelming effects. They balance the necessity for concentrating
forces with avoiding large formations that are vulnerable to attack.
Synchronization is key to successful concentration.
TEMPO
2-52. Tempo is the rate of military action. After gaining the initiative, the
attacker sets the tempo to maintain relentless pressure on the enemy. This
forces the enemy to make decisions for which they are unprepared, to conduct
maneuver they have not rehearsed, and prevents them from recovering from
the initial shock of the attack. The key to maintaining the appropriate tempo
is to anticipate enemy reaction within the military decision-making process
(MDMP), prepare the necessary plans, rehearse as required, and then quickly
maneuver forces to seize opportunities when presented. The aviation
brigade's ability to rapidly exploit enemy weaknesses enhances friendly
tempo.
AUDACITY
2-53. Audacity is a simple plan of action, boldly executed. It seizes and
exploits the initiative. Commanders must be prepared to act quickly to
exploit opportunities.
2-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
PLANNING CONSIDERATIONS
2-55. The aviation brigade's organization and capabilities require some
unique planning considerations. A general discussion follows. Chapter 4
contains more detailed information, including identification of brigade
planning responsibilities versus those of the battalion.
AIR-GROUND INTEGRATION
2-56. Air and ground assets require effective integration to conduct
operations successfully and minimize the potential for fratricide and civilian
casualties. Integration starts at home station with the implementation of
effective tactical SOPs, habitual relationships, and training. It continues
through planning, preparation, and execution of the operation (see Appendix
Q).
Fundamentals
2-57. To ensure effective integration, commanders and staffs must consider
some fundamentals for air-ground integration. The fundamentals that
provide the framework for enhancing the effectiveness of both air and ground
maneuver assets include—
• Understanding capabilities and limitations of each force.
• Use of SOPs.
• C2.
• Maximizing and concentrating the effects of available assets.
• Employment methods.
• Coordination of direct and indirect fires.
• Synchronization.
Air-Ground Control
2-59. An alternate method of C2 is the formation of air-ground task forces or
teams. This normally is a temporary relationship to deal with a specific
situation. OPCON is the normal command relationship. Specific employment
guidelines must be established before operations. Air-ground teams are best
2-12
Chapter Two
SECURITY/FORCE PROTECTION
2-60. Aviation units have limited capability to secure unit AAs while
concurrently conducting operations and performing maintenance. A
battlefield of a nonlinear, asymmetric nature requires that aviation forces
carefully consider security force requirements. This battlefield rarely has
clearly defined flanks or rear areas. Forces must be allocated to protect
critical assets against conventional and terrorist attacks. Mutual support can
reduce the amount of dedicated security needed by aviation forces.
LOGISTICS SUPPORT
2-61. The combination of the nonlinear battlefield and the diversity of the
aviation brigade's battalions often requires that FARPs and maintenance
teams operate simultaneously at different locations. Establishment and
resupply operations require careful planning and coordination. When
possible, these activities should be part of the mission rehearsal.
2-13
Chapter 3
Battle Command
Leadership is based on the knowledge of men. Man is the fundamental instrument in
war; other instruments change but he remains relatively constant. Unless his
behavior and elemental attributes are understood, gross mistakes will be made in
planning operations and troop leading. In the training of the individual soldier, the
essential considerations are to integrate individuals into a group and to establish for
that group a high standard of military conduct and performance of duty without
destroying the initiative of the individual.
Chapter 4, Page 27
War Department Field Manual FM 100-5
Field Service Regulations
Operations
War Department, 15 June 1944
SECTION I - GENERAL
DECISION-MAKING
3-2. Decision-making is knowing whether to decide, then when and what to
decide. These are tactical and operational judgments, but can be strategic
judgments. To command is to—
• Anticipate the activities that will be put into motion once a decision is
made.
• Know how irretrievable some commitments will be once put into
motion.
• Know the consequences of deciding.
• Anticipate the outcomes that can be expected from implementing a
decision.
3-0
Chapter Three
LEADERSHIP
3-3. Leadership is taking responsibility for decisions. It is loyalty to
subordinates, inspiring and directing assigned forces and resources toward a
purposeful end, and establishing a teamwork climate. The climate should
produce success and demonstrate moral and physical courage in the face of
adversity. It also provides the vision that both focuses and anticipates the
future course of events.
3-4. “The duty of every leader is to be competent in the profession of arms.
Competence requires proficiency in four skill sets: interpersonal, conceptual,
technical, and tactical. Army leaders hone these skills through continual
training and self-study. . ..” 1
CONTROL
3-5. Control is inherent in battle command. Control monitors the status of
organizational effectiveness. It identifies deviations from standards and
corrects them. Control provides the means to regulate, synchronize, and
monitor forces and functions. These tasks are performed through collection,
fusion, assessment, and dissemination of information and data.
3-6. Commanders control operations. Commanders lead from critical points
on the battlefield, delegate authority, and synchronize aviation actions with
other battlefield operations. Skilled staffs work within command intent to
direct and control units. Skilled staffs resource allocations to support the
desired end.
1
FM 3-0, Operations, 14 June 2001, para. 4-17, p. 4-7.
3-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
decisions are based on the information derived from the C2 process, which
consists of the following:
• Acquire information.
• Assess whether new actions are required.
• Determine what these actions should be.
• Direct subordinates to take appropriate actions.
• Supervise and assess.
3-11. Effective and efficient C2 is a process that begins and ends with the
commander. The commander must develop techniques and procedures that
promote an expeditious flow of information throughout the entire C2 process.
These techniques and procedures should be in the unit's tactical SOP. FM 5-
0 (FM 101-5) and FM 1-02 (FM 101-5-1) discusses various techniques.
COMMAND RELATIONSHIPS
3-13. The command relationships are assigned, attached, OPCON, or
TACON. An aviation brigade unit is attached only to a unit that can support
its logistics needs. The aviation unit is placed under OPCON or TACON
when it is to be used for a specific mission, the effective time of the
relationship is short, or the gaining unit is unable to provide logistics
support. Normally, the parent headquarters retains control of the aviation
unit. Subordinate units may also be assigned, attached, OPCON, and
TACON. The air cavalry and attack units, pure or task-organized are—
• Attached to other aviation brigades; however, some support may still
have to come from the parent headquarters depending on the duration,
or intensity of the mission.
• Placed under OPCON or TACON of the gaining unit when the unit is to
be used for a specific mission, the effective time of the relationship is
short, or the gaining unit is unable to provide logistics support.
Assigned
3-14. Assigned is to place units or personnel in an organization where such
placement is relatively permanent. The organization controls and
administers the units or personnel for the primary function, or greater
portion of the functions, of the unit or personnel.
3-2
Chapter Three
unit
As required
As required Not
GS Parent unit Parent unit Parent unit Parent unit by parent Parent unit
by parent unit applicable
unit
NOTE 1: In NATO, the gaining unit may not task-organize a multinational unit.
NOTE 2: Commanders of units in DS may further assign support relationships between their subordinate units and elements of the
supported unit after coordination with the supported commander.
Attached
3-15. Attached is the placement of units or personnel in an organization
where such placement is relatively temporary. Subject to limitations imposed
by the attachment order, the commander of the unit receiving the attachment
provides sustainment support above its organic capability. Normally, the
parent unit is responsibility for transfers, promotion of personnel, nonjudicial
punishment, courts martial, and administrative actions.
Operational Control
3-16. OPCON is the authority to perform those functions of command over
subordinate forces involving organizing and employing commands and forces,
assigning tasks, designating objectives, and giving authoritative direction
necessary to accomplish the mission. OPCON may be delegated. It includes
authoritative direction over all aspects of military operations and joint
training necessary to accomplish missions assigned to the command. OPCON
normally provides full authority to organize commands and forces and to
employ those forces as the commander considers necessary to accomplish
3-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Tactical Control
3-17. TACON is the command authority that is limited to the detailed and,
usually, local direction and control of movements or maneuvers necessary to
accomplish missions or tasks assigned. TACON is inherent in OPCON.
TACON may be delegated. TACON allows commanders to apply force and
direct the tactical use of logistics assets but does not provide authority to
change organizational structure or direct administrative and logistical
support.
SUPPORT RELATIONSHIPS
3-18. The support relationships of utility and heavy helicopter assets are DS
and GS. Specific definitions and missions are listed below.
Direct Support
3-19. DS is a mission requiring a force to support another specific force and
authorizing it to answer directly to the supported force's request for
assistance. Assault and heavy helicopter units will often be placed in a DS
role for air movement operations, particularly logistics movement. When
operating in a DS role, the missions can be coordinated directly between the
aviation unit and the supported unit.
General Support
3-20. GS is the support that is given to the supported force as a whole and
not to any particular subdivision thereof. As an example, assault helicopters
units assigned at EAC and corps levels may be placed in GS to several units
within the theater or corps. These units will receive missions from their
parent headquarters based upon support priorities established by theater
and corps commanders. When operating in a GS role, the supported unit
must request aviation support from the appropriate headquarters (division
G3 for divisional aviation assets, corps G3 for corps aviation assets).
PLANNING
3-21. The aviation brigade develops its OPLANs as an integral part of its
higher headquarters staff, at its own headquarters, or both.
3-4
Chapter Three
TROOP-LEADING PROCEDURES
3-25. Although the MDMP is essential to accomplish the mission, effective
troop-leading procedures are equally important. For this reason troop-leading
procedures must be a matter of SOP and checklists within that SOP.
Although personality can accomplish much in certain circumstances, a
missed step can easily lead to mission shortfalls or failure. Written troop-
leading procedure steps provide a guide the leader applies in ways that are
consistent with the situation, the leader's experience, and the experience of
subordinate leaders.
3-26. Troop-leading procedures ensure rapid setup, tear down, and
movement of C2 elements. The brigade C2 elements and supporting signal
units must practice to ensure they relocate in a timely manner.
3-27. Figure 3-1 shows the relationship between the MDMP and troop-
leading procedures.
3-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
3-6
Chapter Three
3-30. A HVT is a target the enemy commander requires for the successful
completion of the mission. The loss of HVTs would be expected to seriously
degrade important enemy functions throughout the friendly commander's
area of interest.
3-31. A high-payoff target (HPT) is a target whose loss to the enemy will
significantly contribute to the success of the friendly COA. HPTs are those
HVTs, identified through war gaming, that must be acquired and successfully
attacked for the success of the friendly commander's mission.
DECIDE
3-32. The decide function is the first step of the D3A process. It is based on
current intelligence and helps define further intelligence development
requirements. Targeting priorities must be addressed for each phase or
critical event of an operation. The products developed include the high-payoff
target list (HPTL). The HPTL is a prioritized list containing those targets
whose loss to the enemy will contribute to the success of the friendly COA. It
also includes the main targets and those targets that protect it. It provides
the overall focus and sets priorities for intelligence collection, target selection
standards (TSS) and attack planning. The decide function should answer the
following questions:
• What targets or objectives should be acquired and attacked?
• In what priority should targets or objectives be attacked?
• When and where are the targets or objectives likely to be found?
• What routes are required for Army aviation ingress and egress?
• Who or what can locate the targets?
• How accurately must the target location be known to initiate the
attack?
• What channels are needed to provide acquisition on a real-time basis?
3-33. The decide function is facilitated and supported by—
• The intelligence collection plan (which may include external assets such
as UAVs, Air Force, Navy, and Marine assets) that answers the
commander’s priority information requirements (PIR), to include those
HPTs designated as PIR. At division level and below, an ISR plan
supports the intelligence collection plan (see FM 2-00.21 [FM 34-2-1]).·
• The TSS that address target location accuracy or other specific criteria
that must be met before targets can be attacked.·
• The attack guidance matrix that is approved by the commander
addresses which targets will be attacked, how, when, and the desired
effects.
3-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
indicate the commander's operational need for BDA of the specific target and
the time window for collecting and reporting it.
DETECT
3-35. The detect process finds the HPTs (critical enemy forces) that must be
attacked to accomplish what has been decided for each phase of an operation.
Target acquisition assets and agencies execute the intelligence collection plan
and focus on specific areas of interest. Mobile HPTs must be detected and
tracked to maintain a current target location. Target tracking is inherent to
detection and is executed throughout the collection plan. Tracking priorities
are based on the commander’s concept of the operation and targeting
priorities. The detect function should answer the following questions:
• What is the target description and its size?
• Where are the targets?
• What objective must be secured?
• How long will the enemy remain in the desired target area once
acquired?
• Do any ingress or egress routes have to be changed or modified?
Collection
3-36. The S2 is the main figure in directing the effort to detect the HPTs
identified in the decide function. He determines accurate, identifiable, and
timely requirements for collection systems. The detect function involves
locating HPTs accurately enough to engage them. It primarily entails
executing the intelligence collection plan.
DELIVER
3-37. The deliver function of the process executes the attack guidance and
supports the commander’s battle plan once the HPTs have been located and
identified. Both tactical and technical decisions affect the selection of the
attack systems and the units to conduct the attack. The decisions are
reflected in the staff’s earlier development of the attack guidance matrix,
schemes of maneuver, and FS plans for planned targets. The decision to
attack targets of opportunity follows the attack guidance. It is based on
factors such as target activity, dwell time, and payoff compared to other
targets currently being processed for engagement. The deliver function
should answer the following questions:
• When should the target or objective be attacked?
• What is protecting the target and how will those targets be neutralized
or destroyed?
• What is the desired effect/degree of damage?
• What attack system (aviation, artillery, other service, lethal or
nonlethal) should be used?
• What unit(s), including ground forces, will conduct the attack?
• What are the number and type of munitions to be employed?
• What is the response time of the attacking unit(s)?
3-8
Chapter Three
Attack Guidance
3-38. Attack guidance is recommended by the staff, approved by the
commander, and distributed via the attack guidance matrix. The guidance
should detail a prioritized list of HPTs; when, how, desired effects, SPINS,
and those HPTs that require BDA. The S3 or fire support officer (FSO)
recommends the attack system for each target. All attack assets, including
ground forces, should be considered. The attack should optimize the
capabilities of—
• Ground and SOF.
• Helicopters.
• Armed UAVs.
• Indirect fire assets: artillery, mortars, Naval surface fire support
(NSFS).
• Combat air operations—CAS and air interdiction (AI).
• Engineers (countermobility: helicopter and artillery delivered mines).
• ADA.
• Cruise missiles.
• EW.
• Psychological operations (PSYOP).
• Civil affairs.
• Deception.
Attack Criteria
3-39. Effects refer to the target or objective attack criteria. The S3/FSO
specifies attack criteria according to higher headquarters guidance. Target
criteria should be given in quantifiable terms. Criteria may be expressed as a
percentage of casualties, destroyed elements, time on target (TOT), duration
of fires, number of tubes or launchers, allocation or application of assets. If
ground forces are required to achieve the desired effects, the size of force,
time on the ground, extraction, and linkup plans must be determined.
Additionally, the S3/FSO should identify accuracy or time constraints,
required coordination, limitations on amount or types of ammunition (Table
3-2), use of ground forces, and BDA requirements.
3-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Machine Gun, .50 caliber, Light armor, concrete shelters, and similar bullet resistant
armor piercing targets.
Machine Gun, .50 caliber, Hardened or armored targets to ignite flammable material.
incendiary
Machine Gun, .50 caliber, Combined effects of armor piercing and incendiary rounds.
armor piercing incendiary
Machine Gun, 7.62 mm ball Personnel and unarmored targets.
Machine Gun, 7.62 mm tracer Observation of trajectory, incendiary effect, signaling.
Machine Gun, 7.62 mm armor Light armor, concrete shelters, and similar bullet resistant
piercing targets.
Rocket, high explosive Materiel, personnel.
Rocket, high explosive multi- Light armor, wheeled vehicles, materiel, personnel.
purpose
Rocket, flechette Personnel, unarmored vehicles, and helicopters.
Rocket, illumination Battlefield illumination, shut-down of enemy night vision
devices (NVDs).
Rocket, white phosphorous Target marking, incendiary.
(smoke)
Danger Close
3-40. FM 3-09.32 (FM 90-20) provides risk-estimates for fixed- and rotary-
winged aircraft-delivered ordnance.
3-41. FM 3-09.32 (FM 90-20) designates danger close for Army aircraft
systems as—
• Hellfire, 75 m.
• Rockets, 175 m.
• Guns, 150 m.
3-10
Chapter Three
WARNING
These estimates and the resultant danger close
ranges are for use in combat and are not minimum
safe distances for peacetime training use. The
supported commander must accept responsibility
for the risk to friendly forces when targets are
inside the danger close range.
ASSESS
3-43. Combat assessment is the determination of the overall effectiveness of
force employment during military operations. Combat assessment is
composed of the following three major components:
• BDA.
• Munitions effectiveness assessment.
• Reattack recommendation.
3-44. BDA is the timely and accurate estimate of damage resulting from the
application of military force. BDA provides commanders with snapshots of
their effectiveness on the enemy and an estimate of the enemy’s remaining
combat effectiveness, capabilities, and intentions. It provides essential
information for determining if a reattack is required.
3-45. Munitions effectiveness assessment is conducted concurrently with
BDA. It is the basis of recommendations for changes to increase the
effectiveness of—
• Methodology.
• Tactics.
• Weapon system.
• Munitions.
• Weapon delivery parameters.
3-46. Reattack and other recommendations should address operational
objectives relative to—
• Target.
• Target critical elements.
• Target systems.
• Enemy combat force strengths.
3-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
MISSION ANALYSIS
3-48. During mission analysis, the S2 provides the HVT that result from
aviation brigade and higher headquarters analysis of the enemy COAs. The
HVT list details the capabilities and limitations of each target. Additionally,
each staff member reviews the assets available to acquire (detect), attack
(deliver), or assess targets.
COMMANDER'S GUIDANCE
3-49. The commander issues guidance following approval of the restated
mission. This guidance provides the staff an initial planning focus. The
commander identifies the enemy COA considered most probable or most
dangerous, along with its associated HVTs. The commander also identifies an
initial focus on targets deemed critical to mission success. While issuing
guidance on the scheme of maneuver, the commander issues initial attack
guidance, indicating the desired effect on targets.
3-12
Chapter Three
3-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
3-59. As one phase of a mission completes, the download of aircraft data into
AMPS and subsequently MCS, can assist development of intelligence for
higher echelons and staffs planning follow-on missions.
3-14
Chapter Three
BATTLE RHYTHM
3-65. Successful continuous operations require a tactical SOP that covers the
management of rest, especially for critical personnel. For the purposes of
describing the aspects of that requirement, the commonly accepted term
battle rhythm is used.
Training
3-69. It is difficult, if not impossible, to establish battle rhythm while
simultaneously conducting operations. Preplanning makes it happen.
Planning, preparing, and training before deployment lays a solid foundation
for a viable battle rhythm during operations.
3-15
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Staff Depth
3-71. Established processes and SOPs relieve many antagonistic effects of
extended operations. SOPs that establish and maintain battle rhythm by
facilitating routine decisions and operations are a step in the right direction.
Soldiers who are trained to do the right things in the absence of leaders or
orders can relieve commanders and staff of many of the time-consuming
tasks that rob them of essential rest. Examples of areas that
noncommissioned officers (NCOs) and junior officers can accomplish for the
commander and staff include—
• Battle summaries and updates during a fight.
• Intelligence updates before, during, and after a battle.
• CSS updates before, during, and after a battle.
• Updates to the next higher commander.
• Shift change briefings.
3-16
Chapter Three
Sleep Plans
3-76. Units must develop detailed rest plans and enforce them. Leaders have
to rest to maintain their effectiveness; however, some leaders attempt to get
involved in every aspect of planning and execution. This phenomenon is
linked to trust and confidence building. The attitude that it is easier to do
something yourself than it is to train someone else to do it can unhinge any
rest plan. An integral part of the planning process is to determine when
senior leader presence is required. It is just as important to identify when a
leader's presence is not required. The planning process should include the
following supporting techniques:
• Include a sleep plan in the METT-TC analysis.
• Ensure that leaders have confidence in the second and third echelon of
leadership and their ability to make routine decisions.
• Instill trust and confidence in the officers, junior NCOs, and specialists
by effective training and SOPs.
• Consider contingencies and establish criteria for waking leaders.
• Post sleep plans in CPs.
• Synchronize sleep plans with higher and subordinate headquarters.
PILOTS' BRIEFS
3-78. Pilots' briefs normally are not conducted at the brigade level. However,
the brigade commander, his staff aviators, senior flying warrant officers, and
flight surgeon (FS) should attend subordinate unit pilot briefs on a routine
basis. This ensures their own familiarity with subordinate unit personnel,
operations, and tactics, techniques, and procedures (TTP). Additionally,
regular attendance at pilots' briefs provide the brigade and subordinate
commanders and staffs with direct feedback on the interaction between
brigade and battalion operations. Lastly, subordinate commanders,
operations personnel, standardization, safety, and maintenance officers
(MOs) should attend periodically the pilots' briefs of other units to
understand the level of standardization within the brigade.
3-17
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
GENERAL
3-79. A rehearsal is essential for success in operations. Appendix G, FM 5-0
(FM 101-5) contains a discussion of rehearsal types, techniques,
responsibilities, and conduct. Items critical to aviation operations are
discussed below.
3-80. Rehearsal types include—
• Confirmation Brief.
• Backbrief.
• Combined Arms Rehearsal.
• Support Rehearsal.
• Battle Drill or SOP Rehearsal.
3-81. Rehearsal techniques include—
• Full Dress Rehearsal.
• Reduced Force Rehearsal.
• Terrain Model Rehearsal.
• Sketch Map Rehearsal.
• Map Rehearsal.
• Radio Rehearsal.
3-82. Once commanders are satisfied that personnel understand the concept
of operation, they must rehearse the plan. Rehearsals are accomplished at all
levels. They may be conducted separately at each echelon, in one large
rehearsal, or using a combination of the two. An appropriate large rehearsal
would be operation in a deep area or cross-forward line of own troops (FLOT)
air assault. An appropriate by-echelon rehearsal would be normal support to
daily operations. Rehearsals are as detailed as time and resources permit.
They may be a series of full-up, live-fire rehearsals or as simple as a quick
review on the map. All rehearsals must include reviewing or conducting—
• Actions on the objective.
• Maneuver, movement, and fires.
• Critical event rehearsals (FARP, PZ).
• Contact drills en route.
• Contingencies.
3-18
Chapter Three
during the rehearsal, then give adequate attention to the most critical part of
the mission. If time allows, the rehearsal should also cover—
• Actions on the objective.
• Actions on contact.
• Occupation of reconnaissance or surveillance positions, BPs, and
landing plans.
• Passage of lines.
• En route and return route plans.
• Actions in the AA (outfront boresight, communication checks, line-up
for take-off, take-off, landing upon return).
• Loading plan (ammunition for attack and reconnaissance; troops, cargo,
and equipment for assault).
• CASEVAC procedures.
• CSAR procedures.
• In-stride downed aircrew recovery procedures.
• Contingency plans (change of mission, aircraft equipment malfunction).
3-19
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
REHEARSAL COMPLETION
3-86. At the end of any rehearsal the commander should receive correct
responses from every member present about the—
• Mission/actions at the objective.
• Commander's intent.
• Timetable for mission execution.
BRIGADE COMMANDER
3-90. The brigade commander commands, controls, and coordinates the
aviation brigade. He is responsible for the outcome of his force's combat
actions. The variety and impact of tasks confronting him are unique.
Although he commands a brigade-level organization, his focus of employment
is at division and corps level, and often higher. These tasks require
cooperation of many people, integration of complex systems that span into the
joint community, and sensible division of work. The brigade commander C2s
organic, assigned, or attached forces. He must task-organize these forces to
accomplish all specified and implied tasks. He must integrate the critical
2
FM 101-5-1, Operational Terms and Graphics, 30 September 1997, p. 1-143.
3-20
Chapter Three
COMMANDER'S PRESENCE
3-97. When not in battle, the brigade commander normally operates in the
main CP. During battle, he moves to a position to best make the decisions
necessary to influence the outcome of the fight. He must be in a position to
affect operations while maintaining communications with higher, lower, and
adjacent units. The best location for the commander could be the main CP,
the tactical CP, or forward with the battle. This decision is based on METT-
TC as well as the commander's assessment of whether personal presence may
3-21
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
COMMANDER'S AIRCRAFT
3-98. The brigade commander selects the type helicopter that gives him the
best visualization of the situation, time on station, or personal presence. The
aviation brigade commander should be rated in more than one of the
brigade's aircraft. The commander also should be current in his primary
aircraft before assuming command.
EXECUTIVE OFFICER
3-100. The executive officer (XO) is second in command and the principal
assistant to the commander. The scope of the XO's duties are often tailored
by the desires of the commander. Normally, the XO directs, supervises, and
ensures coordination of staff work except in those specific areas reserved by
the brigade commander. During combat operations, the XO usually is
positioned in the main CP to direct and coordinate the staff. The XO remains
current on the tactical and logistics situations and is always prepared to
assume command. The commander should allow the XO to assume command
during selected training exercises so that he will be prepared to assume
command in combat.
3-101. As staff coordinator and supervisor, the XO—
• Formulates and announces staff operating policies.
• Ensures that the commander and staff are informed on matters
affecting the command.
• Supervises the main CP operations.
• Ensures execution of staff tasks and the coordinated efforts of staff
members.
• Ensures that the staff performs as a team; assigns definite
responsibilities.
• Transmits the commander's decisions to the staff and to subordinate
commanders, when applicable, for the commander. Staff members can
deal directly with the commander; however, they are obligated to
inform the XO of the commander's instructions or requirements.
• Establishes and monitors liaison and liaison activities.
• Supervises the information program.
• Serves as the materiel readiness officer.
3-22
Chapter Three
GENERAL
3-105. The brigade staff consists of the officers and enlisted personnel who
plan, supervise, and synchronize combat, CS and CSS according to the
brigade commander's concept and intent. Except in scope, duties and
responsibilities of the brigade staff are similar to those of higher echelon
staff. Key personnel must be positioned on the battlefield where they can
carry out their duties.
3-23
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
ESTIMATES
3-109. Staff estimates may be informal at brigade level and below; however,
they must address battlefield activity, project COA, and predict results.
Careful IPB, selection of the most important enemy indicators, and
development of contingency plans facilitate estimates and allow timely
response. The key person in this process is the XO. He ensures that the staff
maintains a proper perspective.
3-24
Chapter Three
ADJUTANT
3-112. The Adjutant (S1) assesses unit readiness and combat effectiveness
for the organization. The S1 provides the following support to soldiers and
their families:
• Manning the unit.
• Personnel readiness.
• Strength accounting.
• Casualty operations.
• Replacement operations.
• Mail operations.
• Morale, welfare, and recreation.
• Other essential personnel support and services.
3-113. The S1 also has coordinating responsibility for finance, religious
activities, public affairs, and legal services support for the unit. The S1 is
normally collocated with the S4 in the ALOC. The S1 and S4 must cross-train
to enable them to conduct continuous operations.
INTELLIGENCE OFFICER
3-114. The Intelligence Officer (S2) provides combat intelligence, which
includes collecting and processing information. The S2 provides current
information and analyzed intelligence of tactical value concerning terrain,
weather, and the enemy. This intelligence helps to facilitate planning and
execution of combat operations. The S2 performs the following functions:
• Converts the information requirements of the commander into the
CCIR.
• Facilitates the IPB process.
• Helps develop the DST.
• Coordinates intelligence activities.
• Frequently updates the commander and staff on the enemy situation.
• Maintains isolated personnel reports (ISOPREP).
• Works closely with the fire support element (FSE) and S3 section to
ensure information is passed throughout the brigade.
OPERATIONS OFFICER
3-115. The Operations Officer (S3) is responsible for matters pertaining to
the organization, employment, training, and operations of the brigade and
supporting elements. The S3 section provides planning and task organization
of brigade elements for combat operations, including personnel recovery. The
S3 monitors the battle, ensures necessary CS assets are provided when and
where required, and anticipates developing situations. The S3 section
maintains routine reporting, coordinates the activities of liaison personnel,
and is always planning ahead. In the area of command, control,
communications, computers, and intelligence (C4I), the S3, through the
communications-electronics officer (S6), ensures that procedures are in place
to resolve complexities posed by the different communications systems,
3-25
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
ATCCS, and connectivity in each type aircraft. For example, the TOC usually
does not have HF, ultra high frequency (UHF), or very high frequency (VHF)
radios; the AH-64 has only one FM radio; CH-47s may not have Have Quick;
and not all aircraft have HF radios. The S3 maintains close coordination with
the S4 and the S1 for logistics and personnel statuses. If possible, the S3
should be rated in more than one of the brigade's aircraft.
CHEMICAL OFFICER
3-116. The chemical officer advises the commander on NBC operations,
decontamination, smoke, obscurants, and flame. The chemical officer works
directly for the S3 and integrates NBC into all aspects of operations. The
chemical officer may have other S3 section responsibilities, and can act as an
assistant S3 when directed.
3-26
Chapter Three
3-27
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
The brigade SP often flies as the other crew member for the brigade
commander or the S3. If the brigade commander does not use the SP as his
pilot, he may want an SP rated in an aircraft other than the ones in which
the commander is rated to expand available expertise.
3-28
Chapter Three
LOGISTICS OFFICER
3-132. The logistics officer (S4), as the brigade's logistics planner,
coordinates with battalion S4s or separate company supply officers or first
sergeants (1SGs) about status of maintenance, equipment, and supplies. He
coordinates with supporting units and higher headquarters staffs to ensure
logistics support is continuous. The S4 section provides supervision and
coordination of food service, supply, transportation, and maintenance support
for the brigade.
3-29
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
trainer and peer leader for the subordinate unit AMOs. He should be rated in
the highest-density type aircraft in the brigade.
CIVIL-MILITARY OPERATIONS
3-136. Civil-military operations (CMOs) are activities that support military
operations embracing the interaction between the military force and civilian
authorities. These operations foster the development of favorable emotions,
attitudes, and behavior in neutral, friendly, or hostile groups.
COMMUNICATIONS-ELECTRONICS OFFICER
3-138. The Communications-Electronics Officer (S6) advises the commander
on signal matters, CP location, signal facilities, signal assets, and signal
activities for deception. The S6 section plans for, coordinates, and oversees
implementation of communications systems. It performs unit-level
maintenance on ground radio and field wire communications equipment. It
installs, operates, and maintains the radio retransmission site. The S6
monitors the maintenance status of signal equipment, coordinates the
preparation and distribution of the signal operation instructions (SOI), and
manages communications security (COMSEC) activities. The S6 section’s
3-30
Chapter Three
ENGINEER OFFICER
3-141. An engineer officer is not normally available. When available, the
engineer officer is the commander or leader of the engineer unit supporting
the brigade. He is a terrain expert and an excellent resource for assisting the
S2 on the effects of terrain and weather with respect to the IPB. The engineer
officer also assists with Volcano operations. In the absence of an engineer
officer, the S3 is responsible for engineer functions. The S3 may designate
someone to act as the engineer officer.
ENGINEER UNITS
3-142. Engineer units normally support the brigade for construction of
protective works or facilities as required by the situation and according to the
engineer priority of work.
FLIGHT SURGEON
3-144. The brigade FS advises and assists commanders on matters
concerning the medical condition of the command including preventive,
curative, and restorative care. The FS periodically flies with aircrews to
3-31
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
monitor medical and environmental factors that affect crew readiness. He,
with subordinate unit FSs, conducts flight physicals for unit personnel. The
FS determines requirements for the requisition, procurement, storage,
maintenance, distribution, management, and documentation of medical
equipment and supplies for the brigade HHC. The FS operates the brigade
aid station that is normally located in the AA.
3-32
Chapter Three
SUPPLY SECTION
3-150. The supply section provides unit-level supply support for the brigade
HHC. It requests, receives, stores, issues, turns in, and accounts for
necessary supplies and equipment. It maintains supply records and secures
weapons and other equipment. The supply section is often only one or two
persons and may not be able to handle all weapons, which include NVS and
other sensitive items. It performs unit maintenance on all individual and
crew-served ground weapons.
Water Storage
3-153. The company headquarters is equipped with a water trailer. It
supplies water necessary to perform various maintenance functions and
satisfy the company's daily requirement for potable water.
GENERAL
3-154. CPs throughout the brigade serve the C2 needs of the commander and
staff. The dynamics of the battlefield require the highest level of
organizational and operational efficiency within every CP. C2 facilities
include—
• Command group
• Main CP.
• TOC.
• ALOC.
• Tactical CP.
• Rear CP.
• Alternate CP.
3-33
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Digitized Challenges
3-156. As digitized systems are fielded, C2 nets and procedures will change.
The challenge will be to integrate those changes and train to standard to
ensure that the increased capabilities of new systems are maximized. This
requires focused initial training and sustainment training.
3-34
Chapter Three
changes to the operation or reduce the size of their battle space. SOPs and
nondigital contingency plans must ensure operational continuity.
3-35
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
3-36
Chapter Three
Friendly Factors
3-169. The status of friendly forces that can affect the mission include—
• Changes in higher, subordinate, or adjacent unit mission.
• Changes in task organization.
• Changes in boundaries.
• Changes in supporting fires or tactical air (TACAIR) priority.
• Loss of unit combat effectiveness including DS or attached units,
whether maneuver, CS, or CSS.
• Critical changes in Class III and V availability or location.
• Changes in status of obstacles and contaminated areas.
• Employment of smoke.
• Employment of nuclear and directed-energy weapons.
• Other elements of information according to the brigade commander's
guidance.
• Status of the reserve.
Enemy Factors
3-170. Enemy factors that can affect the mission include—
• Contact with or sighting of enemy maneuver or FS forces.
• Absence of enemy forces in an area or zone.
• Movement of enemy units—withdrawal, lateral, or forward.
• Employment of the enemy's reserve.
• Employment of NBC weapons or sighting of NBC capable equipment.
• Employment of directed-energy weapons.
• Employment of smoke.
• AD forces.
• Logistical stockpiles.
• Other elements of information according to the brigade commander's
guidance.
3-37
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
OFFENSIVE OPERATIONS
3-172. During offensive operations, the main CP should be well forward. In
fast-moving operations, the main CP may have to operate on the move. Staff
coordination and communications are usually degraded when CPs are
moving; thus, CPs must train to operate while moving.
DEFENSIVE OPERATIONS
3-173. During defensive operations, the main CP normally locates farther to
the rear to minimize its vulnerability. The exact location depends on the
enemy, terrain, the road network, and the ability to communicate.
URBAN OPERATIONS
3-174. The main CP often sets up in built-up areas. Barns, garages, and
warehouses minimize the need for detailed camouflage. Basements offer
protection from enemy fires. Built-up areas also reduce IR and
electromagnetic signatures.
REVERSE SLOPES
3-175. Reverse slopes cover and conceal CPs from direct observation and
fires. Reverse slopes can degrade the enemy's ability to collect, monitor, and
jam electronic transmissions. Electronic profiles run by the S6 provide the
information to determine the ability to transmit and receive. Analysis of
those profiles by the S2 provides the information to determine the enemy's
ability to degrade CP capabilities or intercept traffic.
3-38
Chapter Three
DISPLACEMENT STEPS
3-178. The S3 establishes the general area for the new CP. The HHC
commander, signal officer, and a NBC team conduct detailed reconnaissance.
Steps for the reconnaissance are listed below.
• The reconnaissance party identifies possible routes and sites. Locations
must provide effective communications and accommodate all required
vehicles and equipment. Several possible sites must be identified,
reconnoitered, and planned to provide flexibility and alternate sites.
• The reconnaissance party makes route and site sketch maps showing
the exact element locations within the new CP location.
• The S3 or commander approves the primary and alternate sites.
• A movement order is published. An SOP that has been practiced and
drilled greatly reduces the effort required to produce the order.
• Security and guides are dispatched. The security force ensures the area
is clear of enemy and contamination, and the guides prevent wrong
turns and assist elements in occupation. Signals are especially
important for low visibility and night displacements.
• Reporting and coordinating functions are shifted as required. This may
be within main CP echelons, to the tactical CP, or to the rear or
alternate CP.
• CP and HHC elements prepare and execute movement per SOP. The
main CP may displace in one echelon if the tactical CP can provide C2
for the interim. If the tactical CP cannot execute the required C2, the
main CP displaces in two echelons. The first echelon displaces with
enough assets and personnel to establish minimum C2. The second
echelon remains is place and provides C2 until the first echelon
assumes control, then it displaces.
3-39
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Reaction Forces
3-183. Reaction forces and attachments must be fully integrated into the
overall plan. Each individual must have a clear and current SU of friendly
and enemy forces in the AO. For example, a CP reaction force should know if
military police (MP) are conducting mounted patrols near the CP. The overall
reaction force plan must integrate those MP units or establish boundaries
between the reaction force and the MP unit.
3-184. A clear chain of command and training supported by battle drills are
essential for reaction force preparedness. They must assemble and be ready
to fight in no more than 10 minutes.
• Alarms should be the same throughout the brigade, division, and corps.
These alarms should be in the SOP.
• Reaction plans are rehearsed and executed on a routine basis. Prior to
deployment and at in-country training centers, MILES gear and live or
blank ammunition supplemented by pyrotechnics should be used
whenever possible to enhance the realism. The reaction to a night
attack on the main CP must be second nature if the enemy force is to be
repelled.
3-185. Each reaction force assembles based on an alarm or orders. Personnel
move to a predetermined rally point, establish communications, and conduct
operations as required to counter the threat.
Preparation for the Security and Defense of the Main Command Post Site
3-186. Physical preparation for the defense of the main CP site includes—
• Ensuring each soldier is briefed, has a copy the ROE, and understands
the ROE (for complicated ROE, it is often necessary to conduct
situational training exercises to ensure understanding).
• Concealment—use of urban areas and camouflage.
3-40
Chapter Three
3-41
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
deployed. The TOC also includes the FSE, ALO, engineer, and S5, when
available.
• Monitors and assists in C2 by maintaining contact and coordination
with higher, subordinate, and adjacent units and continuously updating
the enemy and friendly situation.
• Analyzes and disseminates tactical information (including A2C2).
• Maintains situation maps.
• Ensures reports are submitted and received on time.
• Plans future operations and forecasts requirements.
• Coordinates with the ALOC to ensure that CSS is integrated and
synchronized into the mission effort.
OPERATIONS CELL
3-188. The operations cell includes the following functional positions:
• The battle captain is usually the most experienced S3 officer other than
the S3. He continuously monitors operations within the TOC to ensure
proper personnel are available for the mission at hand. He does not
command the battle, but performs battle tracking and makes
operational decisions within assigned responsibilities.
• The operations NCO is the noncommissioned officer in charge (NCOIC)
of the TOC. He moves and sets up the TOC. He is responsible for the
physical functioning of the TOC. He also is responsible for shift
schedules, organization within the TOC, and other functions as
assigned.
• The TOC NCOIC is assisted by other S3 NCOs and assigned personnel,
who maintain unit status, receive and process reports, and keep the
unit journal.
• The S2, S2 NCO, and intelligence analysts are responsible for all
intelligence functions. They alert the commander, XO, or S3 to
situations that meet the established CCIR. Intelligence personnel
receive incoming tactical reports and process intelligence information.
They also assist in moving, setting up, and the physical functioning of
the TOC.
• When available, the FSO and fire support noncommissioned officer
(FSNCO), as part of the FSE, are responsible for FS. They coordinate
for responsive fires and expedite clearance of fires. They assist in
moving, setting up, and the physical functioning of the TOC.
• Radio telephone operators (RTO) are critical links in the C2 structure.
They often use radio headsets, answer telephones, and operate
computer consoles. As such, they may be the only people who hear
transmissions or see a critical piece of information. They must be aware
of the operation so they can alert the leadership of any situation that
might require their attention. RTOs cannot assume that all calls,
information, and reports they monitor are also monitored or seen by the
TOC at large.
3-42
Chapter Three
PLANS CELL
3-189. The plans cell is activated as required. It consists of personnel
required to plan for the operations, such as S2, S3, FS, ALO, S1, S4, S6,
engineer, S5, and attached units. Normally the chief of the plans cell is the
senior S3 representative.
3-43
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
• RTOs are as critical in the ALOC as in the TOC and perform the same
functions.
3-44
Chapter Three
COMMAND GROUP
3-202. The command group consists of the brigade commander and the
representatives from the brigade staff and supporting units that the
commander chooses. At a minimum this normally will be the S3, an S2
representative, and the FSO and ALO, if they are available. The command
group may operate from ground vehicles or an aircraft. The command group
is not a command facility per se, but a grouping of critical decision makers
that may operate separately from the main CP or the tactical CP periodically.
The command group may deploy when personal observation or presence is
necessary to accomplish the mission.
OVERVIEW
3-203. C2 is the exercise of authority and direction by a designated
commander of assigned and attached forces. Command includes both the
authority and responsibility for effectively using available resources to
accomplish missions. Communications and computer systems provide the
means to collect, transport, process, disseminate, and protect information.
3-45
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
COMMAND
3-204. Command at all levels is the art of motivating and directing people
and organizations to accomplish missions. Command requires visualizing the
current state of friendly and enemy forces, the future state of those forces
that must exist to accomplish the mission, and formulates concepts of
operations to achieve victory. Prior to execution, commanders influence the
outcome of operations by—
• Defining his intent.
• Assigning missions.
• Designating the priority efforts.
• Prioritizing and allocating CS and CSS.
• Deciding what level of risk to accept.
• Placing reserves.
• Assessing the needs of subordinates and seniors.
• Guiding and motivating the organization toward the desired end.
3-205. Once operations begin, commanders influence the operations by—
• Changing task organization.
• Changing allocation of CS.
• Changing priority of CSS.
• Changing boundaries.
• Allocating more time.
• Personal presence.
CONTROL
3-206. To control is to regulate forces and functions to execute the
commander's intent. Control of forces and functions helps commanders and
staffs compute requirements, allocate means, and integrate efforts. Control is
necessary to determine the status of organizational effectiveness, identify
variance from set standards, and correct deviations from these standards.
Control permits commanders to acquire and apply means to accomplish their
intent and develop specific instructions from general guidance. Ultimately, it
provides commanders a means to measure, report, and correct performance.
Control allows commanders freedom to operate, delegate authority, place
themselves in the best position to lead, and synchronize actions throughout
the operational area. Commanders exercise authority and direction through
and with the assistance of a C2 system. The C2 system consists of the
facilities, equipment, communications, procedures, and personnel essential
for planning, directing, and controlling operations of forces pursuant to the
missions assigned.
3-46
Chapter Three
COMMUNICATIONS
3-211. Reporting combat information and exploiting that information is
fundamental to combat operations. This information and the opportunities it
presents are of interest to other maneuver units and higher headquarters
staffs. It requires wide and rapid dissemination. Brigade elements frequently
operate over long distances, wide fronts, and extended depths from their
controlling headquarters. Communications must be redundant and long
range to meet internal and external requirements. Long-range
communications can be augmented through signal support. The systems
must be in place before they are needed.
HIGHER TO SUBORDINATE
3-212. The brigade headquarters ensures that its communications
architecture (command, operations and intelligence (O&I), administrative
and logistics (A&L), FS, MSE, and SATCOM) are operational at all times.
3-47
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
SUBORDINATE TO HIGHER
3-213. Battalions and separate companies continually monitor the brigade
nets as directed (usually command and O&I). Likewise, the brigade
continually monitors its higher headquarters nets.
SUPPORTING TO SUPPORTED
3-214. Liaison elements supporting the brigade maintain communications
between their organization and the brigade.
COMMUNICATIONS DISRUPTION
3-215. Communications, particularly electromagnetic, are subject to
disruption. Disruption may result from unintentional friendly interference,
intentional enemy action, equipment failure, atmospheric conditions, EMP,
or terrain interference. To compensate for these, the commander should—
• Provide for redundancy in means of communication.
• Ensure subordinates understand the commander's intent so they know
what to do during communications interruptions.
• Avoid overloading the communications systems.
• Minimize use of radio.
• Ensure signal security and COMSEC practices are followed.
COMMUNICATION RESPONSIBILITIES
3-216. All levels of command gain and maintain communications with the
necessary headquarters and personnel. Communications methods and
procedures should be established in unit SOPs and practiced during battle
drills and flight operations. Traditional communications responsibilities
are—
• Higher to lower. The higher unit establishes and maintains
communications with a lower unit. An attached unit of any size is
considered lower to the command to which it is attached.
• Supporting to supported. A supporting unit establishes and maintains
communications with the supported unit.
• Reinforcing to reinforced. A reinforcing unit establishes and maintaines
communications with the reinforced unit.
• Passage of lines. During passage of lines (forward, rearward, or lateral),
the passing unit establishes initial contact with the stationary unit.
However, the primary flow of information must be from the unit in
contact.
• Lateral communications. Establishing communications between
adjacent units may be fixed by the next higher commander, by order, or
3-48
Chapter Three
RESTORATION
3-217. Regardless of establishment responsibility, all units take prompt
action to restore lost communications.
MEANS OF COMMUNICATION
3-218. The brigade uses the full spectrum of communications means.
VIDEO TELECONFERENCE
3-220. Video teleconferences (VTCs) among corps, divisions, and brigades are
becoming more common. Some brigades are already fielded with that
capability. VTCs are an excellent method for coordination over long distances
and can save commanders time.
WIRE/COMMERCIAL LINES
3-221. Normally wire is used for communications within the CP, AA, and
support area. It is the primary means of communication whenever the
situation permits. Initially, wire is laid on the ground. Then, if time permits,
wire is buried or installed overhead. Buried wire is the preferred method to
counter enemy intrusion and EMP. However, wire should be overhead when
crossing roads, except where culverts and bridges are available. Overhead
wire should be a minimum of 18 feet above ground. Wire should be tagged
according to a system in the SOP. At a minimum, tags should be at the ends
of each line. This facilitates reattaching wires when they are pulled out or
cut. Overhead wire in vicinity of helipads and airfields should be avoided;
however, if used, overhead wires must be clearly marked.
3-222. Commercial lines are used when approved by higher headquarters. To
deny enemy collection efforts, secure devices should be used with commercial
lines. If a unit is forced to withdraw, and with the approval of higher
headquarters, existing wire lines (including commercial lines) are cut and
sections removed so the enemy cannot use them.
3-49
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
RADIO
3-223. Operations often depend on radio as the primary means of
communication. This is especially true during mobile combat operations.
Radio communications should be kept to an absolute minimum until enemy
contact is made.
3-224. FM communications are the primary O&I and A&L nets, and the
means of communicating with ground forces. However, aviation has a broad
range of other radios that facilitate joint, internal, long-range and NOE
communications. These radios include—
• HF—long distance and NOE communications.
• UHF—internal communications and communication with joint aircraft.
• VHF—internal communications and communications with ATS.
• Tactical satellite (TACSAT) and SATCOM—long distance
communications.
Appendix E discusses these systems.
3-225. To avoid detection by enemy direction finding equipment, the brigade
uses all other means of communication to supplement radio. Although secure
equipment may prevent the enemy from knowing the content of the
communications, location and volume are easy to detect and analyze. This
gives the enemy valuable combat information.
RADIO RETRANSMISSION
3-226. The brigade retransmission stations are employed according to the
tactical situation to provide FM radio communications between stations too
far apart to communicate directly. The brigade can deploy both ground and
air retransmission stations. Ground retransmission normally support the
brigade command net. Airborne retransmission has a limited time on station,
but is a vulnerable asset. Preplanning is essential to the effective use of
airborne retransmission. Moving ground retransmission by sling load is an
efficient and effective method of emplacing radio retransmission.
MESSENGERS
3-227. Messengers may be used anywhere but normally are used for critical
communications between CPs, trains, and higher and lower headquarters.
Messengers also are used during electronic and radio silence. While ground
messengers are slower than other means of communications, aviation
provides a rapid capability if preplanned. Aviation messengers may be
particularly useful in carrying A&L messages when en route to and from rear
units. They can be used even if units are in contact and especially when
jamming or interception hampers radio communication. During electronic
and radio silence, opening and closing flight plans by land lines may be
required to control helicopter movements.
3-50
Chapter Three
and documents that may warrant aerial delivery include combat plans and
orders, written coordination and control measures, and graphics. They also
include public affairs materials to sustain public understanding and support
for the Army's continued operations. Using aviation to deliver messages or
documents is a sound technique; however, it is most efficient when there is a
prepared plan for execution. If an aviation messenger service is anticipated,
it should be part of the aviation brigade and higher headquarters SOPs.
OPERATIONS SECURITY
3-230. OPSEC includes measures taken to deny the enemy information
about friendly forces and operations. OPSEC consists of physical security,
information security, signal security, deception, and counter-surveillance.
Because these categories are interrelated, the commander normally chooses
to employ multiple techniques to counter a threat. Commanders analyze
hostile intelligence efforts and vulnerabilities, execute OPSEC counter-
measures, and survey the effectiveness of countermeasures. Commanders can
then counter specific hostile intelligence efforts.
LINES OF COMMUNICATION
3-231. LOCs include roads, supply routes, relay and retransmission sites,
critical signal nodes, microwave facilities, and telephone and wire systems.
The brigade may conduct reconnaissance and security operations of any of
the critical LOCs on a periodic basis or for a specified time to keep the route
open and update information about the route.
3-51
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
AERIAL RECONNAISSANCE
3-235. Brigade elements may be employed to verify unit locations or even
their existence. For example, if the higher headquarters commander loses
communications with a subordinate unit, that commander may ask the
aviation commander to verify the unit's location and status.
RADIO RELAY/RETRANSMISSION
3-236. The brigade can insert and resupply ground retransmission teams
into sites inaccessible by ground. Brigade aircraft may carry retransmission
equipment, relay equipment, or both. Aircrews also can transmit or relay
with onboard equipment.
3-52
Chapter Three
3-53
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
3-242. This net is controlled by the S1 and S4. It is used for A&L traffic. The
A&L net, like the O&I net, normally is not monitored by the brigade or
subordinate commanders. The net is for details and discussion that leads to
the resolution of administration and logistics matters. Critical information is
relayed to the appropriate commander or discussed on the command net. The
unit XO, operating in the TOC, ensures that analysis is done and relayed in a
timely manner and by the appropriate means. If the rear CP is used, it also
monitors O&I. This allows the rear CP to anticipate critical support
requirements and problems (Figure 3-4).
3-54
Chapter Three
own command net, the attack battalion command net, and the command nets
of the supported ground battalion—detected a friendly fire incident and
issued a cease fire before other friendly elements were engaged, averting an
even worse catastrophe.
3-247. The brigade commander should have three FM nets, one UHF/VHF
net, one HF radio and one SATCOM radio—all in addition to brigade and
higher headquarters command nets. These nets enable him to monitor
subordinate unit, supported unit command, O&I, A&L, or any other nets he
deems important to the missions at hand.
3-55
Chapter 4
SECTION I – FUNDAMENTALS
GENERAL
4-1. Aviation brigades are tailored to execute operations that support the
unit to which they are assigned. The principal role of the brigade is to set the
conditions for success for its units.
4-2. Each aviation brigade can C2 combat, CS, and CSS missions as a whole,
or with one or more of its subordinate units. However, each brigade is
tailored for its specific TOE mission and does not have the organic assets to
accomplish the full range of combat, CS, and CSS missions. For example, a
TAB can C2 attack helicopter operations, but it is not organized with attack
helicopter assets because its TOE mission is air movement and C2 support.
The corps aviation brigade, through its attack regiment and aviation group,
conducts the full gamut of aviation operations. However, if it requires fixed-
wing support, it must coordinate for that support from the TAB. Because
combat operations may cause task organizations that differ from the
brigade's primary mission focus, brigade commanders and staff should be
familiar with the current doctrinal literature for all elements of each type
brigade.
WARNING ORDER
4-4. A WARNORD is a preliminary notice of an order or action that will
follow. It serves as a planning directive that describes the situation, allocates
forces and resources, and establishes command relationships. It provides
other initial planning guidance and initiates subordinate unit mission
planning. Planning and coordination begin when the unit receives a notice of
mission. The aviation commander, LNO, or a staff officer may be sent to a
supported commander's headquarters to assist in planning. Aviation units
may begin to reconfigure or reposition to support the upcoming operation.
4-0
Chapter Four
4-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
the same level of expertise and detail expected of a mission area subject
matter expert.
SITUATIONAL AWARENESS
4-13. SA involves knowing enemy and friendly positions and capabilities, as
well as the status of environmental factors (weather, terrain, civilian
populations). SA is critical to achieving SU and operational success.
4-2
Chapter Four
TYPES OF OPERATIONS
4-18. There are four types of operations: offensive, defensive, stability, and
support (Tables 4-2 through 4-5).
Table 4-2. Types of Offensive Operations
OFFENSE DEFINITION
Movement to
Used to develop the situation, establish, or regain contact with the enemy.
Contact
An operation characterized by movement supported by fire. The purpose is to destroy,
delay, disrupt, or attrit the enemy.
Hasty attack: An operation in which preparation time is traded for speed to exploit an
opportunity.
4-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Retrograde Mission that trades space for time while retaining flexibility and freedom of
(Delay) action.
Retrograde
A planned, voluntary disengagement that anticipates enemy interference.
(Withdrawal)
Retrograde
A force not in contact with the enemy moves away from the enemy.
(Retirement)
STABILITY DEFINITION
Peace Operations Operations conducted to support diplomatic efforts to establish and maintain
(PO) peace.
Foreign Internal Operations in support of a foreign government to free and protect its society
Defense (FID) from subversion, lawlessness, and insurgency.
A group of programs that support U.S. national policies and objectives by
Security
providing defense articles, military training, and other defense-related services
Assistance
to foreign nations by grant, loan, credit, or cash sales.
Humanitarian and
Assistance provided with military operations and exercises.
Civic Assistance
On National Command Authority (NCA) order, Army forces (ARFOR) support
Support to
insurgencies that oppose regimes that threaten U.S. interests or regional
Insurgencies
stability.
Support to ARFOR always conduct counter-drug operations that support other U.S.
Counter-Drug government agencies. When conducted inside the U.S. and its territories, they
Operations are domestic support operations.
Combatting
Operations to deter or defeat terrorist attacks.
Terrorism
Noncombatant
Operations to relocate threatened civilian noncombatants from locations in a
Evacuation
foreign nation to secure areas.
Operations (NEO)
Conducted to bolster and reassure allies, deter potential aggressors, and gain
Show of Force
or increase influence.
4-4
Chapter Four
SUPPORT DEFINITION
Domestic Assistance to U.S. civilian authorities in activities such as civil
Support disturbance control, counter-drug operations, combatting terrorism,
Operations and law enforcement.
Foreign Operations to relieve or reduce the results of natural or man-made
Humanitarian disasters including conditions such as pain, disease, hunger, or
Assistance privation that present a serious threat to life or loss of property.
COMMON TERMS
4-19. The terms defined below are terms common to aviation operations.
ASSEMBLY AREAS
4-20. There are three types of AAs used by Army aviation units—heavy
assembly areas (HAA), FAA, and RAA. Appendix D contains additional
information on AAs.
General
4-21. An AA is a location where the unit prepares for operations. Activities
include planning, orders, maintenance, and Class I, III, and V resupply. AAs
should be located out of enemy medium artillery range and be large enough
for dispersion of the unit. AAs should not be located along an axis of advance.
Other considerations involved in selecting appropriate AAs are—
• Security.
• Concealment.
• Accessibility to main supply routes (MSR).
• Air avenues of approach.
• Location of friendly units.
• Suitability of ingress and egress routes.
4-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
4-6
Chapter Four
BATTLE POSITIONS
4-25. BPs are areas in which aviation units can maneuver and fire into a
designated EA or engage targets of opportunity. BPs contain firing positions
(FPs) and attack positions (Figure 4-4).
HOLDING AREAS
4-26. HAs provide cover and concealment from enemy direct fire or
observation. Units establish HAs to loiter short of FPs to resolve timing
errors, and conduct reconnaissance or final coordination before attack.
Helicopters should not shut down or go to auxiliary power units in HAs
without a thorough risk assessment. Do not use HAs to plan unless
absolutely necessary. Planning should be done in a FAA or HAA (Figure 4-5).
4-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
FIRING POSITIONS
4-27. Units use FPs to engage the enemy. Standoff must be maintained. As a
general guideline, FPs are no closer to the enemy than the distances shown
below. Ranges may be altered by METT-TC (Figure 4-6).
• Rockets: 5,500 meters.
• Hellfire: 5,000 meters.
• 30mm: 2,500 meters.
ATTACK BY FIRE
4-28. Attack by fire (ABF) are fires (direct and indirect) employed to destroy
the enemy from a distance, normally used when the mission does not dictate
or support occupation of the objective. This task is usually given to the
supporting element during the offensive and as a counterattack option for the
reserve during defensive operations. An ABF is not done in conjunction with
a maneuvering force. When assigning this task, the commander must specify
the intent of the fire—either to destroy, fix, or suppress. ABF positions are
less restrictive than BPs and better suited to a fluid battlefield. They allow
the unit to maneuver and engage the enemy, but not maneuver over the
enemy (Figure 4-7).
SUPPORT BY FIRE
4-29. Support by fire is a tactical task in which a maneuver element moves to
a position on the battlefield where it can engage the enemy by direct fire. It
supports a maneuvering force by either support by fire by overwatching or by
establishing a base of fire. The maneuver element does not attempt to
maneuver to capture enemy forces or terrain (Figure 4-8).
4-8
Chapter Four
RALLY POINT
4-30. Units designate a rally point to reassemble separated or dispersed
elements (Figure 4-9). A rally point is used to—
• Reform units before, during, or after an operation.
• Regroup a team, platoon, or company after a hasty withdrawal from
contact.
• Assemble personnel after their position has been overrun.
• Assemble reaction teams.
Traveling
4-32. Traveling is used for moving rapidly over the battlefield when enemy
contact is unlikely, or the situation requires speed to evade the enemy. All
aircraft move at the same speed. Units often employ low-level flight with the
traveling movement technique.
Traveling Overwatch
4-33. Traveling overwatch is used when speed is essential and enemy contact
is possible. Lead aircraft move constantly and trail aircraft move as
necessary to maintain overwatch of lead. Units often employ contour flight
with the traveling overwatch technique.
4-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Bounding Overwatch
4-34. Bounding overwatch is used when expecting enemy contact. It is the
slowest movement technique. It uses alternate or successive bounds, with
lead aircraft moving to a position while trail aircraft overwatch. The
overwatching aircraft then bound to a position ahead of the lead aircraft.
Each aircraft bounds separately while the other overwatches the movement.
Length of the bound depends on the terrain, visibility, and the effective range
of the overwatching weapon system. Units normally employ NOE flight with
the bounding overwatch technique.
4-10
Chapter Four
work with their higher headquarters to ensure that this fact is part of the
higher headquarters SOP.
ATTACK
4-38. The primary attack mission is to destroy enemy ground forces. A well-
suited secondary mission is cavalry operations—reconnaissance, counter-
reconnaissance, and security. A third mission is defensive air combat against
enemy helicopter forces. Given USAF capabilities to establish air superiority,
Army counter-air training lacks emphasis. However, at a minimum, attack
units must plan for and practice defensive counter-air.
4-39. Attack units can conduct operations in deep areas or attack with
ground maneuver units during close and rear battle operations. Attack units
normally are most effective when used in mass on the enemy's flanks and
rear. An aviation brigade may be called upon to conduct attack operations as
a whole, or with one or more subordinate units. Assault and heavy helicopter
units provide substantial flexibility in resupply of Class III/V, mine
emplacement, and insertion of ground troops at blocking positions or OPs.
4-40. Attack aviation normally operates under aviation brigade control.
Based on METT-TC, the aviation brigade staff backward plans (just as in air
assault operations) from actions in the EA, method of employment
(continuous, phased, or maximum destruction), occupation of BPs, HAs, air
movement routes (to include passage of lines, if required), to preparatory
actions in the AA.
4-41. In the example shown in Figure 4-11, the aviation brigade has a
mission to attack to destroy the enemy reserve tank regiment. The aviation
brigade commander decides to attack with two battalions simultaneously and
to keep his third battalion in reserve. The first battalion, in the north, moves
via route Hawk to positions to ABF the northern half of EA Chris. The second
battalion, in the south, moves via route Wren to attack positions to attack by
fire the southern half of EA Chris. The aviation brigade commander acts as
the AMC to ensure coordination of the attacks and inflict maximum
destruction. The brigade provides its own UH-60 aircraft, or another brigade
provides UH-60 aircraft to conduct airborne C2, CASEVAC, downed aircrew
recovery, and, if required, to conduct emergency resupply of the FARP. For
this operation, attacking with two battalions simultaneously, no attack
helicopter fires across the battalion boundaries are allowed. This reduces the
potential of fratricide. FM 3-04.112 (FM 1-112) contains a detailed discussion
of attack helicopter operations.
4-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
CAVALRY
4-42. Each type of aviation brigade, when task-organized, is an adequate air
cavalry force. The divisional brigades, the air assault division brigades (task-
organized), the corps aviation brigade, and the corps attack regiment (with
support from the corps aviation group) are ideally suited to conduct
reconnaissance, screens, and economy of force operations. Inherent in all
cavalry operations is counter-reconnaissance. When augmented with ground
forces and UAV support, aviation brigades are even more capable. They can
operate as a reaction force to develop the situation, occupy ground OPs, seize
key terrain, and conduct raids. METT-TC determines whether the brigade
commander operates with battalions pure or task-organized. Even though the
UH-60 lacks sophisticated weapons and sensors, when pressed, the brigade
may use assault units to conduct limited reconnaissance and screening,
according to METT-TC. The level of training in the aviation brigade will
dictate its ability as an air cavalry or cavalry force (Figure 4-12).
Reconnaissance
4-43. Reconnaissance is a focused collection effort to obtain information
about the activities and resources of an enemy or about the meteorological,
hydrographic, or geographic characteristics of an area. It is performed before,
during, and after other combat operations to provide information.
Reconnaissance missions are divided into five categories—route, zone, area,
reconnaissance in force, and multi-dimensional. FM 3-04.114 (FM 1-114) and
FM 3-20.95 (FM 17-95) address these categories.
4-12
Chapter Four
Security
4-44. Security operations are undertaken to—
• Provide early and accurate warning of enemy operations.
• Provide the force being protected with time and maneuver space within
which to react to the enemy.
• Develop the situation to allow the commander to effectively use the
protected force.
4-45. Security operations are characterized by reconnaissance to reduce
terrain and enemy unknowns, gaining and maintaining contact with the
enemy to ensure continuous information flow, and providing early and
accurate reporting of information to the protected force. Pure aviation
security missions are limited to screening. When augmented with the
appropriate ground forces, it can guard. The brigade participates in covering
force operations as a part of a larger force. To act as the covering force
headquarters, the aviation brigade requires ground maneuver forces and DS
artillery. FM 3-04.114 (FM 1-114) and FM 3-20.95 (FM 17-95) contain
detailed discussions of security operations.
Screen Lines
4-46. The graphical symbol for the screen (lightning bolts) indicates the
general area for screening operations. In no way does the symbol indicate a
requirement for physical occupation.
4-47. Once the order to screen is received, the aviation brigade S3
coordinates with all units that will be adjacent to the screen. The S3
establishes boundaries, contact points, passage points (PPs), and other
coordinating measures as required to allow the cavalry squadron to pass
through and operate in vicinity of main body units.
4-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
4-48. The cavalry squadron then provides the orders and graphics necessary
to accomplish the screen. The squadron provides exact OP locations, how long
OPs will be occupied, routes between OPs, and other graphics required.
4-49. The cavalry troops then execute the screen mission from the OPs
assigned by squadron.
GENERAL
4-51. Planning considerations are predicated on METT-TC. Some of these
elements are specific to the mission and are discussed in the appropriate
chapter of this manual. This section addresses planning considerations that
are common to any mission the brigade might be assigned.
MISSION
4-52. Higher headquarters assign missions to the aviation brigade.
Commanders determine their specified and implied tasks by analyzing their
assigned mission and coordinating with supported units. The results of that
analysis yield the essential tasks that, together with the purpose of the
operation, clearly indicate the actions required. The mission includes what
tasks must be accomplished; who is to do them; and when, where, and why
the tasks are to be done. It includes risk management considerations.
MISSION CRITERIA
4-53. For any mission, the commander seeks to establish criteria that will
maximize his probability of success (such as ground conditions, visibility, and
force ratios). The supported commander and the brigade higher headquarters
set mission criteria. During the planning process, mission criteria are
quantified and stated in easily understood terms. If any of the stated criteria
are achieved before or during the mission, the designated commander should
execute predetermined actions.
ENEMY
4-54. Analysis of the enemy includes information about his strength,
location, activity, and capabilities. Commanders and staffs also assess the
most likely enemy COAs. Analysis includes adversaries, potentially hostile
parties, and other threats to success. Threats may include the spread of
infectious disease, regional instabilities, or misinformation. Commanders
consider asymmetric as well as conventional threats.
4-14
Chapter Four
THREAT ANALYSIS
4-55. The brigade conducts a threat analysis during planning, based upon
the IPB prepared by it and higher headquarters. A common mistake is to
orient too much on terrain as opposed to the enemy. Knowing the enemy's
location, his forces, capabilities, and intentions are key to success. Knowledge
of the enemy ensures the best use of terrain to exploit his weaknesses and
capitalize on friendly strengths.
TERRAIN ANALYSIS
4-57. Commanders and staffs perform terrain analysis whether using
digitized tools or paper maps. They evaluate terrain for cover and
concealment, its impact on maneuver, and the enemy's movements. The key
elements of terrain analysis are summarized in the following mnemonic
OCOKA:
• Observation and fields of fire.
• Cover and concealment.
• Obstacles to movement.
• Key terrain.
• Avenues of approach.
OBSTACLES
4-58. Obstacles and reinforcement of terrain must be included in the tactical
plan. Engineers use obstacles to disrupt, fix, turn, or block the enemy.
Disruptive obstacles cause enemy formations to separate or bunch up, which
disrupts their maneuver and attack. Fixing obstacles slow enemy progress
and allow friendly fires the opportunity to mass effects. Turning obstacles
drive the enemy toward friendly EAs and massed fires or force them to
expose their flanks. Blocking obstacles deny the enemy access to an area or
prevent advance in a given direction. Although the brigade probably will not
have engineer support to establish obstacles, the commander must
understand the ground force commander's obstacle plan and use it to his
advantage.
TERRAIN RECONNAISSANCE
4-59. Because maps are sometimes inaccurate or incomplete, commanders
should conduct detailed, personal reconnaissance. Brigade commanders
should create the conditions where battalion commanders can ensure their
aircrews are familiar with the terrain and scheme of maneuver. If possible,
battalion commanders—and their crews—should perform a map
4-15
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
reconnaissance; visit LZs, PZs, and BPs and FPs; and conduct rehearsals.
These actions help them understand the scheme of maneuver and
commander's intent, and quicken their reactions during the chaos of battle.
Commanders consider all sources of intelligence. Aerial photographs, satellite
imagery, and human intelligence (HUMINT) can be critical.
WEATHER
4-60. Weather affects soldiers, equipment, operations, and terrain. Cloud
cover, wind, rain, snow, fog, dust, light conditions, and temperature extremes
combine in various ways to affect human efficiency. They also limit the use
of weapons and equipment. Weather impacts both friendly and enemy assets.
For example, rain can degrade forward looking infrared (FLIR) systems, but
it also inhibits the cross-country maneuverability of enemy forces. Each
system used on the battlefield has its strong and weak points in relation to
the weather. Commanders must know the strengths of their systems and use
them to attack the weaknesses of the enemy systems.
VISIBILITY
4-61. Limited visibility affects operations and often favors ground maneuver.
Fog and smoke reduce the effective range of many weapon systems, including
AD weapons, and friendly SAL Hellfire. Commanders use the concealment of
limited visibility to maneuver forces to a positional advantage. The brigade
should plan operations to maximize the advantages of its superior sensor
systems.
AIRSPACE COORDINATION
4-64. Total familiarity with the TAGS is essential to deconflict operations
and prevent mission delays. Brigades may need to comply with provisions in
the ACO, ATO, and SPINS. They have strict timelines and FSCMs to take
into account during brigade and subordinate planning cycles.
4-16
Chapter Four
TIME AVAILABLE
4-66. Commanders assess time available for planning, preparing, and
executing the mission. They consider how friendly and enemy forces will use
the time and the possible results. Proper use of time available can be a key to
success. The one-third, two-thirds rule should be used whenever possible.
Concurrent planning makes the best use of time. Emerging digital systems
enhance concurrent planning capabilities. For operations in deep areas,
concurrent planning also must involve the aviation brigade's higher
headquarters staff.
CIVIL CONSIDERATIONS
4-67. Civil considerations relate to civilian populations, culture,
organizations, and leaders within the AO. Commanders consider the natural
environment (Appendix O), to include cultural sites, in operations directly or
indirectly affecting civilians. They include political, economic, and
information matters, as well as more immediate civilian activities and
attitudes.
CIVIL IMPACT
4-68. Civil considerations at the tactical level generally focus on the
immediate impact of civilians on current operations; however, they also
consider larger, long-term diplomatic, economic, and information issues. Civil
considerations can tax the resources of tactical commanders. The local
population and displaced persons influence commanders' decisions. Their
presence and the need to address their control, protection, and welfare affect
the choice of COAs and allocation of resources. In stability operations and
support operations, civilians can be a central feature of planning.
POLITICAL BOUNDARIES
4-69. Political boundaries of nations, provinces, and towns are important
considerations. Conflict often develops across boundaries, and boundaries
may impose limits on friendly action. Boundaries, whether official or not,
determine which civilian leaders and institutions can influence a situation.
MEDIA PRESENCE
4-70. Media presence guarantees that a global audience views military
activities in near real-time. The activities of the force—including individual
soldiers—can have far-reaching effects on domestic and international opinion
(see appendix M).
4-17
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
PLANNING MODELS
4-71. Aviation brigades plan missions to support ground units. An air assault
is an example of a mission in support of a ground unit. They also plan
missions that are commanded and controlled by the aviation brigade. A
deliberate attack across the FLOT by attack helicopters is an example of a
mission under the C2 of the aviation brigade.
4-72. Each type mission requires a model to guide the planning and
execution. Examples of each are shown in Figures 4-13 and 4-14.
H-Hour (line of departure [LD], LZ). Exact planning times from AA to LD, PP, BP, PZ, or LZ.
EAs, LZs, PZs, battle areas or Release points (RPs), rally points, FPs, ABF positions,
potential BPs. exact BPs, kill zones, landing areas.
4-18
Chapter Four
4-19
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
4-20
Chapter Four
4-21
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
4-22
Chapter Four
4-23
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
4-24
Chapter Four
responses. The aviation brigade must avoid the effects of NBC weapons,
respond to their use, take protective measures, and continue the mission.
SOPs and training are the best preparation for operations in an NBC
environment.
4-78. The commander must consider the exposure guidance from higher
headquarters, the enemy's capability, the mission, and the condition of the
unit when establishing the unit's mission oriented protective posture
(MOPP). Because of the degradation in aircrew effectiveness in MOPP
equipment, intensive fighter management is required. To reduce risk in an
NBC environment, units must—
• Avoid detection.
• Retain mobility.
• Seek terrain shielding by carefully selecting AAs and preparing
shelters and fighting positions.
• Instill discipline and physical conditioning to prepare troops for the
confusion and physical demands of a NBC environment.
• Plan for continued operations if attacked.
CONTAMINATION AVOIDANCE
4-79. The term avoidance does not necessarily mean aborting a mission or
suspending operations. Soldiers go into contaminated areas only when
necessary. Normally, it is preferable to bypass these areas. The NBC warning
and reporting system, reconnaissance, monitoring, and surveys identify
contaminated areas.
PROTECTIVE MEASURES
4-80. When elements cannot avoid contamination, or are under direct attack,
soldiers must take appropriate actions to survive. Specific actions are taken
before, during, and after attack. To sustain operations in an NBC
environment, personnel must understand and practice individual and
collective protection. Individual protection involves those measures each
soldier must take to survive and continue the mission. These measures
include immediately donning MOPP gear, seeking cover, and using other
protective equipment and devices. Collective protection provides a
contamination-free environment for selected personnel and precludes the
continuous wear of MOPP gear. Considerations for NBC protection include—
• Positioning NBC reconnaissance assets at likely locations for enemy
employment.
• Combining reach-back intelligence with battlefield sources to anticipate
enemy use of weapons of mass destruction.
• Using smoke to support disengagement.
4-25
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
4-81. The brigade will be called upon to execute its mission in a variety of
environments. It is imperative that commanders understand the impact of
these environments on their soldiers and equipment. Commanders need to
think through the impact of environmental conditions and provide necessary
training. The Army's concept of "just in time" training, supported by the use
of distance learning products, provides opportunities for commander's to meet
some of the unique training challenges that special environments demand.
URBANIZED TERRAIN
4-82. In urban areas, fields of fire are restricted, landing areas are limited,
and buildings provide cover for enemy forces to engage helicopters with near
impunity. The presence of noncombatants, protected structures, and
important resources and facilities normally demands careful weapons and
munitions selection to avoid collateral damage. The proximity of enemy and
friendly ground forces increases the risk of fratricide. Communications may
be degraded by many structures. Thermal effects from paved surfaces and the
channeling effects of buildings can cause wind conditions to vary significantly
from point to point. Special, restrictive ROE should be expected. Standoff is
key to aviation survival. Chapter 6 and Appendix R cover Urban Operations.
4-26
Chapter Four
services to prevent icing. Aircraft that become ice-covered may take hours to
deice. Aircraft skis may also be required. Units that normally do not operate
in these conditions should request unit SOPs and guidance from units
experienced in these conditions.
JUNGLES
4-86. Dense jungles and wooded areas degrade fields of fire and target
identification, and can negate the advantages afforded by superior
acquisition systems. Humid, tropical air decreases the effectiveness of optics.
It also decreases payload capacity. While tropical jungle can be some of the
harshest terrain available for aviation operations, mobility advantages
offered by aviation over ground forces are exponentially increased.
DESERTS
4-87. The brigade can operate effectively in the desert, but open desert
terrain increases the unit's vulnerability to enemy long-range observation
and acquisition. The lack of navigational aids (NAVAIDs) and prominent
terrain features, man-made or natural, makes navigation extremely difficult
without GPS, Doppler, or some other form of navigation assistance. Heat
limits weapon and fuel loads, while sand and dust cause damage and
increases maintenance requirements. Placing FARPs closer to the objective
areas can mitigate the effects of reduced payload capabilities. Aircraft flying
low and slow produce large dust clouds that the enemy can easily detect.
Dust clouds also obscure aircraft acquisition systems.
OVER-WATER OPERATIONS
4-88. Over-water operations may be necessary to defeat enemy waterborne
operations or to move from one location to another. As in desert
environments, openness increases the unit's vulnerability to enemy long-
range observation and acquisition. The lack of NAVAIDs and prominent
terrain features makes navigation extremely difficult without GPS, Doppler,
or some other form of navigation assistance. Over-water operations require
special equipment and training. For example, water wings, rafts, and
helicopter emergency egress device (HEED). Units that normally do not
operate in these conditions should request unit SOPs and guidance from
units experienced in these conditions.
4-27
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
FRIENDLY SMOKE
4-90. Through the use of smoke, the brigade can—
• Suppress visually sighted enemy AD systems and small arms.
• Sector portions of EAs, isolating part of the enemy force.
• Obscure LZ or PZ operations from enemy view.
• Screen the displacement of attack or reconnaissance aircraft while they
move or break contact.
4-28
Chapter Four
4-29
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
4-30
Chapter Four
AIR MOVEMENT/SELF-DEPLOYMENT
4-101. To accomplish the mission, some tactical movements and self-
deployments may have to be conducted under IMC or a combination of IMC
and visual meteorological conditions (VMC). Training is essential to
accomplish these missions.
GROUND ATTACK
4-103. If ground forces attack a brigade location during IMC, the unit may
have to relocate aircraft under instrument conditions. Units must have a
rehearsed plan for aircraft evacuation under IMC.
PLANNING CONSIDERATIONS
4-105. The following factors are considered in determining the best formation
or sequence of formations:
• Mission of the supported unit and the aviation unit.
• Current enemy situation, enemy AD capability and placement, and
vulnerability to enemy visual or electronic surveillance.
• Artillery support available, LZ preparation planning, air support
availability and requirements, Naval surface weapon systems
(including planned types of ordnance), and en route JSEAD.
• Configuration of en route obstacles or corridors; size, shape and surface
of the LZ; obstacles affecting approaches to the LZ; ceiling and
visibility; wind and turbulence, ambient light levels; and IR crossover
throughout the mission.
• Possible changes in the mission or the situation and evasive tactics to
be used.
• Number and type of armed escort aircraft required and available.
4-31
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
SECTION IX – RECONSTITUTION
OVERVIEW
4-108. Reconstitution actions are implemented immediately after a
commander's determination that a unit is not sufficiently effective to meet
operational requirements. Possible actions include reestablishing or
reinforcing C2; cross-leveling or replacing personnel, supplies, and
equipment; and conducting essential training.
4-109. If reconstitution is necessary, commanders have two options—
reorganization and regeneration. Often these are executed together.
REORGANIZATION
4-110. Reorganization shifts internal resources within a degraded unit to
increase its combat effectiveness. Equipment and personnel are redistributed
among internal elements to balance combat capabilities, match operational
weapon systems with crews, and form composite units. Reorganization is
categorized as either immediate or deliberate.
Immediate Reorganization
4-111. Immediate reorganization is the quick, temporary restoration of
degraded units to minimum levels of combat capability.
Deliberate Reorganization
4-112. Deliberate reorganization restores degraded units to a specified
degree of combat capability. It involves more extensive repair and cross-
leveling procedures, and is usually conducted farther to the rear than
immediate reorganization.
4-32
Chapter Four
REGENERATION
4-113. Regeneration rebuilds a unit through large-scale replacement of
personnel, equipment, and supplies. C2 is reestablished and mission-essential
training is conducted. Regeneration is the more challenging reconstitution
option. It requires more time and resources. Regeneration is categorized as
either incremental or whole-unit.
• Incremental regeneration is accomplished by adding personnel and
equipment to an existing unit.
• Whole-unit regeneration is the replacement of entire units or definable
subelements in an organization.
4-33
Chapter 5
Employment
SECTION I – GENERAL
5-1. This chapter addresses employment aspects for each type aviation
brigade. Those operations common to all brigades are covered in Chapter 4,
and are not repeated here. However, within this chapter, some brigade
sections repeat information from other brigade sections, as some employment
factors are common to more than one, but not all brigades. This ensures that
each brigade section stands alone.
5-2. The aviation brigade's primary role is to set the conditions for success.
To do that it must—
• Ensure the required C2 facilities are in place and operational.
• Ensure SU—enemy, friendly, and allied.
• Ensure the necessary liaison to and from other organizations is in
place.
• Coordinate the brigade's movements and operations within the
battlespace.
• Have the necessary CS and CSS.
OVERVIEW
5-3. The corps aviation brigade is the primary headquarters for Army
aviation operations conducted by the corps. Within the brigade there is an
attack regiment and an aviation group. All aviation group headquarters are
in the RC, while many subordinate battalions and companies are AC. The
corps aviation brigade commander and staff must control these active units
until the group headquarters activates, certifies, and deploys. This additional
C2 requirement is manageable in peace. However, it limits the brigade's
wartime agility and flexibility to accomplish multiple, diverse missions while
concurrently planning future operations. The brigade needs a large staff
augmentation until the group headquarters arrives. Peacetime training
exercises are critical to the timely integration of RC units when mobilized.
5-0
Chapter Five
AIRFIELDS
5-5. Some corps aviation brigade assets will operate from airfields. This
airfield may be part of the host nation infrastructure, a captured enemy
airfield, another service's airfield, or one built by Army or other service
engineers. Airfields may be used when the air and missile threat is low.
HOW TO FIGHT
5-6. The corps aviation brigade's primary role is to set the conditions for
success for each of its units. It conducts attack, reconnaissance, security, air
assault, C2, air movement, and ATS. It plans, coordinates, and executes
aviation operations to support the corps scheme of maneuver. It can be
expected to operate anywhere in the corps area.
5-7. The attack regiment conducts corps shaping operations and augments
division attack battalions to support decisive operations. The attack regiment
can also conduct guard operations when task-organized with ground
maneuver forces. The attack regiment is an ideal air cavalry force.
5-8. The aviation group coordinates the corps's myriad aviation support
requirements.
• The CAB moves commanders and staffs to coordinate and execute
operations.
• The CSAB accomplishes critical CS and CSS missions for the corps and
divisions and may augment air assault operations.
• The AHB provides air assault support for corps and division operations.
• The HvyHB provides heavy lift capability for combat and support
missions.
• The ATS battalion provides ATS throughout the corps.
INTELLIGENCE
5-9. The S2 prepares intelligence estimates and conducts the IPB process.
Regardless of the nature and intensity of conflict, this involves a time-tested
process. FM 2-01.3 (FM 34-130) contains appropriate checklists and an
aviation-specific section. IPB results are used to develop the products to
support collection management, identify potential enemy COAs, and support
the development of the commander's scheme of maneuver (to include
branches and sequels).
5-10. The brigade has many sources of intelligence; however, the corps G2
section is key. Close coordination with the corps G2 section is essential to
maintain SA and understanding. The brigade S2 contacts corps and division
intelligence sections to ensure the latest information is available for
operations and aircrews. Corps aviation units may have access in their CPs
to Joint Surveillance Target Attack Radar Systems (JSTARS) ground station
modules or common ground stations. These provide continuous access to
moving target indicator (MTI) ground tracks, and synthetic aperture radar,
UAV, and satellite imagery. If not, the brigade accesses via liaison or staff
presence in the corps intelligence section.
5-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
MANEUVER
5-11. The corps aviation brigade C2s operations to support the corps
commander's tactical and OPLANs.
5-12. Corps aviation brigades plan, coordinate, and execute attacks on enemy
C2 facilities; moving armor, artillery, and troop formations; communications
nodes; supply depots; delivery systems for weapons of mass destruction
(theater missile defense [TMD]); and other hard and soft targets. For the
TMD mission, Longbow aircraft with extended range fuel tanks can search
using the FCR to detect vehicles, and FLIR—augmented by joint assets—to
detect missile launches. Utility and heavy lift aircraft insert air assault
forces. AH-64 aircraft conduct both attack and search and attack missions.
5-13. When corps aviation brigade forces conduct operations in deep areas,
air assaults, and raids against any target, the commander plans and conducts
maneuver functions, supporting fires, and JAAT assets through mission-type
orders or as part of the ATO. Attack, assault and heavy helicopter assets also
support division close battle requirements. The corps commander may
employ corps assault and attack assets as a reaction force against level III
rear area threats.
5-14. Brigade UH-60 and AH-64 aircraft may conduct in-stride recovery of
downed aircrews, or support Air Force CSAR missions if in-stride recovery is
not possible. The Longbow can assist ingress and egress security through its
FCR SA, and augment supporting fires for recovery aircraft. UH-60s, within
capabilities, can insert ground security forces.
FIRE SUPPORT
5-15. The brigade's attack helicopter regiment aircraft may provide laser
designation for other service aircraft, its own aircraft, and precision fires
delivered by Army or other service units. The corps aviation brigade can also
coordinate Army tactical missile systems (ATACMS), multiple launcher
rocket system (MLRS), cannon artillery, and NSFS. Heavy helicopter and
utility assets may transport towed howitzers, their crews, ammunition, and
prime movers. Heavy helicopters may air transport ATACMS, MLRS, and
cannon artillery ammunition for corps and division units. Air transport of
forward observers, mortar crews, and Q-36 Firefinder radars also are
potential missions.
AIR DEFENSE
5-16. The attack helicopter regiment may conduct defensive air combat and
team insertions against enemy forces performing operations deep in our rear
areas. In operations in enemy deep areas, attack helicopter regiment
elements may conduct overwatch and defensive air combat to defend the
main body. AH-64D aircraft with FCR can identify and engage enemy
helicopters with RF and SAL missiles, flechette rockets, and guns.
5-17. Because corps attack regiments often use airfields as AAs, the brigade
requires AD against both air and tactical ballistic/cruise missiles to protect
against attack while on the ground.
5-2
Chapter Five
5-18. Brigade elements employ active and passive AD. Active measures
include use of integral systems and door guns for defensive air combat.
Passive measures include terrain flight, camouflage, and selection of
locations that provide cover and concealment for CPs, AAs, and FARPs. Air
guards for vehicle movements and road marches provide early warning.
Convoy discipline, such as maintaining proper distances between vehicles,
limits damage from air attack. Elements use identification friend or foe (IFF)
codes to avoid fratricide. A2C2 plans, procedures, and orders ensure AD
elements are aware of aircraft AAs and ingress and egress routes.
MOBILITY/COUNTERMOBILITY/SURVIVABILITY
5-19. Corps aviation brigade aircraft routinely support engineer mobility and
countermobility efforts. Road construction and improvement are major
mobility efforts that can require helicopter transport of outsize loads such as
metal pipes for culverts and bridge materiel. Volcano-equipped aircraft,
escorted by armed helicopters, can emplace minefields. Helicopters may also
transport survivability materiel such as concertina and sandbags for base
camp security.
5-20. Group aircraft move MP reaction forces and traffic control teams,
chemical reconnaissance teams, and decontamination teams. They also
transport firefighters and water buckets in relief missions.
5-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
5-26. Corps aviation brigades support their own C2 through the CP structure
and employment of relays for LOS combat net radios. HF radios provide an
alternate non-line of sight (NLOS) communications means for longer distance
missions and NOE communications. SATCOM may be required to support
both C2 aircraft customers and the brigade's own C2 needs.
OVERVIEW
5-27. Within each corps aviation brigade, a subordinate attack regiment
controls the ATKHBs. The regimental headquarters and its battalions may
be in the active or RC. For those units in RCs, peacetime training is critical to
timely integration.
HOW TO FIGHT
5-32. The attack regiment's primary role is to set the conditions for success
for each of its units. It conducts corps shaping operations and augments
division attack battalions to support decisive operations. The attack regiment
is also an excellent air cavalry force.
• During initial entry, attack helicopter regiments often fight as part of a
joint force. They may conduct joint shaping operations as a matter of
5-4
Chapter Five
INTELLIGENCE
5-33. The S2 prepares intelligence estimates and conducts the IPB process.
Regardless of the nature and intensity of conflict, this involves a time-tested
process. FM 2-01.3 (FM 34-130) contains appropriate checklists and an
aviation-specific section. IPB results are used to develop the products to
support collection management, identify potential enemy COAs, and support
the development of the commander's scheme of maneuver (to include
branches and sequels).
5-34. The regiment has many sources of intelligence; however, the corps G2
section is key. Close coordination with the corps G2 section is essential to
maintain SA and understanding. The regimental S2 contacts corps and
division intelligence sections to ensure the latest information is available for
operations and aircrews. As a primary corps asset for shaping operations, the
regiment routinely accesses high-priority intelligence assets like JSTARS,
Airborne Warning and Control System (AWACS), Guardrail C-12, RC-135
Rivet Joint, UAV and satellite imagery, signals intelligence, and electronic
intelligence. Training with these systems and close coordination with the
corps intelligence staff is essential and should be a matter of SOP. C2 aircraft
are required to ensure access to UAV, JSTARS, and other information while
executing missions. The regiment's aircrews also are a great source of combat
information.
MANEUVER
5-35. The regiment normally conducts operations as a regiment. It may
OPCON one or two ATKHBs to other aviation units; but normally it will
retain at least one ATKHB to act as an element of the corps reserve. It may
also control ground maneuver units as part of a guard, covering force, or
corps reserve mission.
5-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
5-36. Corps operations in deep areas require extensive planning. The attacks
themselves are often joint and may include cruise missile, MLRS, ATACMS,
armed UAV, AI assets, NSFS, and Marine attack helicopters. The ATKHBs
attack simultaneously in a maximum destruction attack or in a phased or
continuous attack. The threat, availability of ingress and egress routes, size
of the target, availability of terrain from which to attack, and distance to the
target are factors that determine which method of attack is used.
5-37. The DOCC is a key part of ensuring all aspects of coordination are
accomplished. Every aspect of coordination should be a matter of SOP and
incorporated into checklists and execution matrices.
5-38. Corps attack helicopter regiments play a critical role in support of
light, airborne, and air assault divisions. These early deploying divisions
have limited mobile ground antiarmor assets. Corps attack helicopter
regiments are an excellent means of weakening enemy armor approaching
lighter divisions prior to arrival of sea-deploying heavy forces (Figure 5-1).
5-39. To support the close battle, fratricide issues that effect division attack
battalions also apply to corps attack regiments. Training and SOPs are
essential to avoid fratricide. Ground units and ATKHBs employ control
measures that limit where and when each can fire, and aircrews identify
targets before engagement.
FIRE SUPPORT
5-40. Corps attack regiments ensure JSEAD is planned and coordinated.
Both lethal and nonlethal means are used to ensure suppression or
destruction. ATACMS, MLRS, AC-130, F-16C Block 50 Wild Weasel, F/A-18,
EA-6B, EC-130H Compass Call, and helicopter weapons systems are
employed. Fires in the objective area are planned to ensure all available fires
are placed on the enemy. Units also employ on-call fires during the close
battle, and preplan protective fires around airfields, AAs, and FARPs.
AIR DEFENSE
5-41. The regiment employs both active and passive AD measures. Active
measures include use of Stinger missiles, gun, Hellfire, and rocket
ammunition to conduct defensive air combat. Passive measures include
terrain flight, use of camouflage nets, and locations that provide cover and
concealment for CPs, AAs, and FARPs. Using air guards for vehicle
movements and road marches provides early warning. Convoy discipline,
such as maintaining proper distances between vehicles, limits damage from
air attack. A2C2 plans, procedures, and orders ensure AD elements are aware
of aircraft AAs and ingress and egress routes.
5-42. Corps attack helicopter regiments conducting operations in deep areas
have a greater likelihood of encountering enemy rotorcraft and fighters. AH-
64D aircraft with FCR can identify enemy rotorcraft and engage with RF and
SAL missiles, flechette rockets, and guns. JSTARS and AWACS may or may
not provide adequate early warning for joint assets to destroy enemy aircraft
before they engage friendly forces. During the deep battle, the risk of
fratricide increases from friendly joint assets conducting combat air patrols
and from friendly AD during the return to friendly lines. IFF procedures are
5-6
Chapter Five
critical. IFF systems may be turned off while in enemy territory to avoid
emitting, but that choice must be balanced with the fratricide risk from other
service and allied aircraft. IFF must be on before returning to friendly lines.
Regiments may designate and arm aircraft to provide security for regimental
deep strikes and conduct rear area defensive air combat against infiltrating
enemy rotorcraft.
MOBILITY/COUNTERMOBILITY/SURVIVABILITY
5-43. Aerial delivery of mines can support operations in deep areas. These
operations may be conducted just before or simultaneous to the regiment's
attack. Aerial mining operations must be planned with the same level of
detail as a operation in a deep area to ensure the slow-moving mine delivery
aircraft are not interdicted by enemy action (Figure 5-1).
5-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
OVERVIEW
5-47. Within each corps aviation brigade, a subordinate aviation group
controls the assault, command aviation, CS aviation, heavy helicopter, and
ATS battalions. Because all corps aviation group headquarters are in the RC,
the corps aviation brigade commands the group's active battalions and
companies until the group activates and deploys. This diverse command
structure consists of UH-60, CH-47, and ATS assets with varying missions
and capabilities that support combat, CS, and CSS missions.
5-8
Chapter Five
HOW TO FIGHT
5-53. Until the group headquarters activates and deploys, the corps aviation
brigade commander accomplishes the required C2 functions of the aviation
group. The group's primary role is to set the conditions for success for each of
its units. It establishes a close relationship through liaison and presence with
the corps staff and COSCOM to coordinate the corps's myriad aviation
support requirements. Missions for the group are approved by the corps G3
and given to the group directly or through the corps aviation brigade:
• The CAB moves commanders and staffs to coordinate and execute
operations.
• The CSAB accomplishes critical CS and CSS missions for the corps and
divisions, and may augment air assault operations.
• The AHB provides air assault support for corps and division operations.
• The HvyHB provides heavy lift capability for combat and support
missions.
• The ATS battalion provides ATS throughout the corps.
5-54. During SASO and SSC, individual UH-60 battalions and CH-47
companies may activate to support specific missions or for a specific duration
in a rotation.
5-55. During peacetime, units must form habitual training relationships to
ensure wartime readiness. Peacetime RC missions to support disaster relief
and air movement of personnel indirectly provide training for wartime air
movement and C2 support, but not for air assaults.
INTELLIGENCE
5-56. The S2 prepares intelligence estimates and conducts the IPB process.
Regardless of the nature and intensity of conflict, this involves a time-tested
process. FM 2-01.3 (FM 34-130) contains appropriate checklists and an
aviation-specific section. IPB results are used to develop the products to
support collection management, identify potential enemy COAs, and support
the development of the commander's scheme of maneuver (to include
branches and sequels).
5-57. The group obtains its intelligence support from the corps aviation
brigade and supported units. Many of its aircraft operate singularly or in
5-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
MANEUVER
5-60. During initial entry, the aviation group often deploys as part of a joint
force. They support operations to defend the lodgment. These operations may
be under Army or other service command.
5-61. The group supports aviation operations for the ARFOR or corps
commander. Many of their operations are directed and planned by a DOCC.
The aviation group commander and staff routinely participate in DOCC
planning and execution. The combatant commander for the AO may or may
not require missions to appear on the ATO.
5-62. The deep nature of corps operations may require aircraft to fly with
auxiliary fuel tanks. Training to use these tanks and the resultant reduction
in payload and power available is essential. It must be part of the unit SOP.
5-63. During close area operations the group may place some of its units
OPCON to one or more divisions while it plans and executes other operations
with its remaining units. Light and airborne divisions benefit greatly from
group aircraft for larger scale air maneuver of forces. Heavy divisions conduct
air assaults with dismounted mechanized infantry or attached light infantry
to secure the terrain inaccessible to Bradley Fighting Vehicles during river
and gap-crossing efforts. Group CH-47s also have key roles in tactical
transport of troops and equipment. The ability to carry up to 60 troops (with
seats removed) provides a capability to insert tremendous combat power with
one aircraft; however, it also places those soldiers in grave danger if the
threat is high (Figure 5-2).
5-64. In all operations, group units can expect to transport U.S. and allied
soldiers and to operate with allied helicopter units. In SASO and SSC, units
may also perform a reconnaissance function or carry civilian or military
observers.
FIRE SUPPORT
5-65. Group UH-60 aircraft transport forward observer teams. Corps CH-47s
externally-transport mortar and towed artillery units and Q-36 Firefinder
5-10
Chapter Five
radars for support in terrain with little road access, or for artillery raids. UH-
60s can move lighter artillery loads. U.S. aircraft may transport allied mortar
teams and towed artillery to base camps and mountaintop vantage points to
ensure coverage and observation.
AIR DEFENSE
5-66. Aviation group elements employ both active and passive AD measures.
Active measures include use of door guns to conduct defensive air combat.
Passive measures include terrain flight, camouflage, and selection of
locations that provide cover and concealment for CPs, AAs, and FARPs. Air
guards for vehicle movements and road marches provide early warning.
Convoy discipline, such as maintaining proper distances between vehicles,
limits damage from air attack. Elements use IFF codes to avoid fratricide.
A2C2 plans, procedures, and orders ensure AD elements are aware of aircraft
AAs and ingress and egress routes.
5-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
5-68. In SASO and SSC, an air threat may not exist; however, aircraft may
be required to trail drug smuggling aircraft prior to handoff to the Drug
Enforcement Administration (DEA), Coast Guard, or host nation air forces.
These aircraft may perform evasive maneuvers or fly at high speeds to avoid
capture. Missions such as these require additional training because they are
not normally part of a unit's METL.
MOBILITY/COUNTERMOBILITY/SURVIVABILITY
5-69. Aviation group aircraft routinely support engineers. Road construction
and improvement are major mobility efforts that can require helicopter
support to transport outsize loads such as metal pipes for culverts, bridge
materiel, and personnel. Heavy helicopters can assist river crossings by
lifting ribbon bridge bays into place. Volcano-equipped aircraft escorted by
attack helicopters can emplace minefields. Helicopters may also transport
survivability materiel such as concertina and sandbags to support security
for base camps.
5-70. Group aircraft conduct air movement of MP reaction forces and traffic
control teams, as well as, movement of chemical reconnaissance and
decontamination teams. They also transport firefighters and water bucket to
support relief missions.
5-12
Chapter Five
OVERVIEW
5-75. The heavy division aviation brigade is the primary headquarters for
Army aviation operations conducted by the division. The brigade has an
ATKHB, a divisional cavalry squadron with two ACTs (except 1st Infantry
Division), and a GSAB.
HOW TO FIGHT
5-77. The aviation brigade is the primary integrator of aviation assets within
the division. Its primary role is to set the conditions for success for each of its
units. The brigade must prepare to fight as a whole, to support other units
using pure or task-organized units, and to conduct multiple independent
missions requiring pure or task-organized units. Heavy division aviation
brigade missions include—
• Conducting movement to contact as part of the division's guard. Forces
may include all aviation brigade's organic assets (less those supporting
division C2 missions), one or two heavy task forces, supporting artillery,
and other divisional elements.
• Conducting operations with the cavalry squadron under brigade or
division control.
• Conducting decisive or shaping operations for division attacks, with its
ATKHB and mine-dispensing aircraft from the GSAB.
• Supporting the maneuver brigades with direct aerial fires and indirect
rocket fires, conducting counterattacks, and overwatching fires,upon
completion of decisive or shaping operations.
• Inserting and extracting reconnaissance teams. Conducting cross-FLOT
air assaults to seize key terrain or destroy enemy forces. Emplacing
minefields at chokepoints and primary enemy avenues of advance using
mine-dispensing aircraft. Inserting and extracting special operating
forces to conduct raids, surveillance, or reconnaissance.
• Providing C2 aircraft support.
• Supporting DISCOM air movement and aerial resupply.
5-78. The aviation brigade allocates resources based on METT-TC, the
scheme of maneuver, available assets, and the division commander's
priorities.
5-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
INTELLIGENCE
5-80. The S2 prepares intelligence estimates and conducts the IPB process.
Regardless of the nature and intensity of conflict, this involves a time-tested
process. FM 2-01.3 (FM 34-130) contains appropriate checklists and an
aviation-specific section. The IPB results are used to develop the products to
support collection management, identify potential enemy COAs, and support
the development of the commander's scheme of maneuver (to include
branches and sequels).
5-81. Intelligence is provided from many sources; however, the major
intelligence source will be the division G2 section, attached military
intelligence (MI) assets, and subordinate unit reports. The brigade S2 is the
key intelligence coordinator.
5-82. The division may task the brigade with conducting intelligence liaison
with other elements to gather aviation-specific information. This could be as
simple as flying to the closest Air Force intelligence source, or as complicated
as placing LNOs with allied and joint forces. The brigade may be provided
with a common ground station to display JSTARS feed. UAV support for
aviation missions is essential to identify threats without risking manned
aircraft. The brigade's aircrews also are a great source of combat information.
MANEUVER
5-83. The ATKHB and ACTs are the aviation maneuver forces for the heavy
division. The GSAB has a critical CS role with its mine-dispensing Volcano
systems, team insertion, C2 platforms, and limited air assault capability.
5-84. The aviation brigade conducts shaping operations with the ATKHB,
and may support operations with air cavalry and aerial mine delivery. In the
economy-of-force role, it may advance with or without ground maneuver, and
with or without air assault forces in an effort to hold enemy forces in check
while the bulk of the division's ground maneuver forces advance on another
axis. As the division reserve, it may respond to rear area threats, support the
division commander's scheme of maneuver when he needs to exploit success,
conduct pursuit, or reinforce ground forces.
5-85. The ATKHBs may support or be OPCON to heavy maneuver brigades
as a guard or part of a covering force. They may also operate in an overwatch
and support-by-fire capacity. Division and ground brigade commanders may
employ aircraft directly on top of or slightly behind ground maneuver forces
to maintain awareness of their location vis-à-vis friendly armor. When
employed in this manner, aviation forces are vulnerable to enemy artillery
attack and direct fires intended to target friendly forces, and may reveal
ground force locations. The greater range of Hellfire missiles allows
overwatch and support-by-fire to occur without keeping attack helicopters
directly over ground forces, but this can lead to confusion with respect to
target priorities. The FCR is a valuable source of combat information for the
digitized ground maneuver force (Figure 5-3).
5-14
Chapter Five
FIRE SUPPORT
5-90. Aviation brigades ensure JSEAD is planned and coordinated to include
nonlethal means. The ATKHB and cavalry squadron exploit preplanned and
on-call fires to engage targets. Proper application of fires can destroy lightly
armored targets and disrupt armored targets. Armed aircraft can designate
laser guided artillery and other service munitions. If supporting fires are not
adequate, attack and cavalry aircraft can launch 2.75-inch rockets and
5-15
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Hellfire to provide suppressive fires of their own, but such fires detract from
their primary mission. Guns can be effective if enemy AD sites are
unexpectedly encountered at close ranges. Utility aircraft can transport
forward observers to observation points and quickly relocate them.
AIR DEFENSE
5-91. Brigade elements employ both active and passive AD measures. Active
measures include use of Stinger missiles, gun, Hellfire, and rockets for
defensive air combat. Passive measures include terrain flight, camouflage,
and selection of locations that provide cover and concealment for CPs, AAs,
and FARPs. Air guards for vehicle movements and road marches provide
early warning. Convoy discipline, such as maintaining proper distances
between vehicles, limits damage from air attack. Elements use IFF codes to
avoid fratricide. A2C2 plans, procedures, and orders ensure AD elements are
aware of aircraft AAs and ingress and egress routes.
5-92. In SASO and SSC, an air threat may not exist; however, aircraft may
be required to trail drug smuggling aircraft before handoff to the DEA, Coast
Guard, or host nation air forces. These aircraft may perform evasive
maneuvers or fly at high speeds in an attempt to avoid capture. Missions
such as these require additional training because they are not normally part
of a unit's METL.
MOBILITY/COUNTERMOBILITY/SURVIVABILITY
5-93. Division aviation brigade aircraft routinely support the mobility and
countermobility efforts of engineers in MTW, SSC and SASO. Road
improvements are major mobility efforts that can require helicopter support
to transport outsize loads such as metal pipes for culverts, bridge materiel,
and personnel. Supporting heavy helicopters can assist river crossings by
lifting ribbon bridge bays into place. Volcano-equipped aircraft escorted by
attack helicopters security can emplace minefields. Helicopters may also
transport survivability materiel such as concertina and sandbags to support
security for base camps.
5-94. Division brigade aircraft also conduct air movement of MP reaction
forces and traffic control teams, as well as, movement of chemical
reconnaissance and decontamination teams. They also transport firefighters
and water bucket to support domestic missions.
5-16
Chapter Five
OVERVIEW
5-100. The light division aviation brigade is the primary headquarters for
Army aviation operations conducted by the division. The brigade has an
AHB, ATKHB, and a divisional cavalry squadron with two ACTs.
5-101. The aviation brigade practices to deploy with as little as two days
notification. The division sacrifices some combat power by using OH-58D in
lieu of AH-64 in the attack battalion to enhance air-deployability.
5-17
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
When the entire division deploys, elements of DCSA Bdes may be attached to
the division to augment assault support.
HOW TO FIGHT
5-104. The aviation brigade is the primary integrator of aviation assets
within the division. The brigade's primary role is to set the conditions for
success for each of its units. The brigade must prepare to fight as a whole, to
support other units using pure or task-organized units, and to conduct
multiple independent missions requiring pure or task-organized units. Light
division aviation brigade missions include—
• Conducting a movement to contact as part of the division's guard.
Forces may include all aviation brigade organic assets (less those
supporting division C2 missions), one to two light infantry battalions,
supporting artillery, and other divisional elements to include OPCON
tanks or armored gun systems if available.
• Supporting the division's main attack with the attack battalion.
Conducting and supporting an air assault to achieve ground brigade or
division objectives. Supporting the DISCOM with utility aircraft.
Inserting and extracting reconnaissance teams forward of the FLOT.
Conducting a screen with the cavalry squadron or attack battalion
under brigade or division control.
• Conducting cross-FLOT air assaults to seize key terrain or destroy
enemy forces. Providing C2 aircraft supporting these assaults.
Emplacing minefields at chokepoints and along primary enemy avenues
of advance using mine-dispensing aircraft. Inserting and extracting
special operating forces and light infantry units to conduct raids,
surveillance, or reconnaissance. Supporting DISCOM air movement
and aerial resupply with utility aircraft. Providing C2 aircraft support.
Supporting the forward brigades with aerial fires and conduct
counterattacks as required.
5-105. The aviation brigade allocates resources based on METT-TC, the
scheme of maneuver, available assets, and the division commander's
priorities.
5-106. The brigade commander requires units to maintain collective training
proficiency among the ATKHB, cavalry squadron, AHB, and units they
habitually support.
INTELLIGENCE
5-107. The S2 prepares intelligence estimates and conducts the IPB process.
Regardless of the nature and intensity of conflict, this involves a time-tested
process. FM 2-01.3 (FM 34-130) contains appropriate checklists and an
aviation-specific section. IPB results are used to develop the products to
support collection management, identify potential enemy COAs, and support
the development of the commander's scheme of maneuver (to include
branches and sequels).
5-108. Intelligence is provided from many sources; however, the major
intelligence source will be the division G2 section, attached MI assets, and
subordinate unit reports. The brigade S2 is the key intelligence coordinator.
5-18
Chapter Five
5-109. The division may task the brigade with conducting intelligence liaison
with other elements to gather aviation-specific information. This could be as
simple as flying to the closest Air Force intelligence source, or as complicated
as placing LNOs with allied and joint forces. The brigade may have access to
a JSTARS common ground station that can provide real-time intelligence
access from a variety of sources. UAV support for aviation missions is
essential to identify threats without risking manned aircraft. The light
division cavalry squadron and brigade aircrews also are a great source of
combat information.
MANEUVER
5-110. The light infantry division exploits terrain and urban areas for both
offensive and defensive operations. Aviation forces can support light infantry
in any terrain, day or night. Aviation's rapid mobility can quickly assist the
light division's ground forces as they move under the concealment of night
and the cover and concealment of restricted terrain.
5-111. The aviation brigade conducts limited shaping operations with the
ATKHB and may support those operations with air cavalry and aerial mine
delivery. The brigade also conducts economy-of-force or reserve missions. In
the economy-of-force role it may advance with or without air assaults forces
to hold enemy forces in place while the division maneuvers toward the main
objective. As the division reserve, it may respond to area battle threats,
support the division commander's scheme of maneuver when he needs to
exploit success, conduct pursuit, or reinforce ground forces.
5-112. ATKHBs may support or be OPCON to light maneuver brigades as a
guard or part of a covering force. They may also operate in an overwatch and
support-by-fire capacity. Division and ground brigade commanders may
employ aircraft directly on top of or slightly behind ground maneuver forces
to maintain awareness of their location vis-à-vis friendly forces. When
employed in this manner, aviation forces are vulnerable to enemy artillery
attack and direct fires intended to target friendly forces, and may reveal
ground force locations. The greater range of Hellfire missiles allows
overwatch and support-by-fire to occur without keeping attack helicopters
directly over ground forces. However, this can lead to confusion with respect
to target priorities.
5-113. Employment of attack aviation with ground forces requires
coordinated force-oriented control measures that allow aviation forces to fix
and weaken the enemy at extended ranges and then to reinforce ground unit
fires with missile, rocket, and .50 cal fires. This type of employment requires
constant practice and very close coordination.
5-114. The cavalry squadron operates under division control or aviation
brigade control. It may operate with the attack battalion as the division
guard. It may also screen a vulnerable flank of the division advance. It also
provides security before, during, and after air assaults. The cavalry squadron
may provide security at the airhead or port of entry during the deployment
and redeployment phases.
5-115. Attack and cavalry conduct attacks against enemy artillery units that
can devastate light infantry forces. They can also conduct limited overwatch
5-19
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
5-20
Chapter Five
and hovering to avoid sniper, grenade and rocket propelled grenade (RPG)
engagement when inserting or overwatching forces (see Appendix R).
5-118. Brigade UH-60, attached UH-60/HH-60L air ambulances, and OH-
58D aircraft may provide assets for CSAR to recover downed joint and Army
aviators.
FIRE SUPPORT
5-119. Aviation brigades ensure JSEAD is planned and coordinated to
include nonlethal means. Utility aircraft externally transport 105 mm
howitzers and Q-36 Firefinder radars. They also transport forward observer
teams. Attack units may need to coordinate closely with artillery Firefinder
units to find and destroy enemy artillery and mortars that threaten light
infantry. OH-58D aircraft in the cavalry squadron and ATKHB are well-
equipped to support on-call fires and laser designate for joint laser-guided
munitions. They also have limited 2.75-inch rocket capability to suppress and
destroy maneuver forces and ADs.
AIR DEFENSE
5-120. Brigade elements employ active and passive AD measures. Active
measures include use of Stinger missiles, guns, Hellfire, and rockets
ammunition to conduct defensive air combat. Passive measures include
terrain flight, camouflage, and selection of locations that provide cover and
concealment for CPs, AAs, and FARPs. Air guards for vehicle movements and
road marches provide early warning. Convoy discipline, such as maintaining
proper distances between vehicles, limits damage from air attack. Elements
use IFF codes to avoid fratricide. A2C2 plans, procedures, and orders ensure
AD elements are aware of aircraft AAs and ingress and egress routes.
5-121. In SASO and SSC, an air threat may not exist; however, aircraft may
be required to trail drug smuggling aircraft before handoff to the DEA, Coast
Guard, or host nation air forces. These aircraft may perform evasive
maneuvers or fly at high speeds to avoid capture. Missions such as these
require additional training because they are not normally part of a unit's
METL.
MOBILITY/COUNTERMOBILITY/SURVIVABILITY
5-122. Division aviation brigade aircraft routinely support the mobility and
countermobility efforts of engineers in MTW, SSC and SASO. Road
improvements are major mobility efforts that can require helicopter support
to transport outsize loads such as metal pipes for culverts, bridge materiel,
and personnel. Supporting heavy helicopters can assist river crossings by
lifting ribbon bridge bays into place. Volcano-equipped aircraft escorted by
attack helicopters can emplace minefields. Helicopters may also transport
survivability materiel such as concertina wire and sandbags to support
security for base camps.
5-123. Division brigade aircraft also conduct air movement of MP reaction
forces and traffic control teams, as well as, movement of chemical
reconnaissance and decontamination teams. They also transport firefighters
and water bucket in support of domestic missions.
5-21
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
OVERVIEW
5-127. The airborne division aviation brigade is the primary headquarters
for Army aviation operations conducted by the division. The brigade has
AHB, ATKHB, and a divisional cavalry squadron with three ACTs.
5-128. The aviation brigade practices to deploy on short notice. The division
sacrifices some combat power by using OH-58D in lieu of AH-64 in the attack
battalion to enhance air-deployability. The brigade is nearly identical to light
infantry division aviation brigades except for the cavalry squadron, which
has a third air reconnaissance troop and a single ground troop.
5-22
Chapter Five
HOW TO FIGHT
5-130. The aviation brigade is the primary integrator of aviation assets
within the division. Its primary role is to set the conditions for success for
each of its units. The brigade must prepare to fight as a whole, to support
other units using pure or task-organized units, and to conduct multiple
independent missions requiring pure or task-organized units. Airborne
divisional aviation brigade missions include—
• Employing the cavalry squadron to screen the lodgement. Emplacing
minefields using Volcano-equipped aircraft during initial entry
lodgement defense. Conducting a movement to contact as the division's
guard, once the airhead is secure. Forces include all aviation brigade
organic assets (less those supporting division C2 missions), one to two
airborne infantry battalions, supporting artillery, and other divisional
elements to include tanks and armored gun systems, if available.
• Supporting the DMAIN attack with the ATKHB. Supporting forward
brigades with aerial fires, and conducting counterattacks as required.
Conducting and supporting air assaults to achieve ground brigade or
division close battle objectives. Supporting DISCOM air movement and
aerial resupply with UH-60 aircraft. Inserting and extracting
reconnaissance teams forward of the FLOT. Conducting flank screens
with the cavalry squadron under brigade or division control.
• Conducting cross-FLOT air assaults to seize key terrain or to destroy
enemy forces. Emplacing minefields at chokepoints and primary enemy
avenues of advance using Volcano-equipped aircraft. Inserting and
extracting special operating teams conducting raids, surveillance, or
reconnaissance. Supporting DISCOM air movement and aerial resupply
with utility aircraft. Supporting the forward brigades with aerial fires
and conducting counterattacks as required.
5-131. The aviation brigade allocates resources based on METT-TC, the
scheme of maneuver, available assets, and the division commander's
priorities.
5-132. The brigade commander requires units to maintain collective training
proficiency among the attack battalion, cavalry squadron, AHB, and units
they habitually support.
INTELLIGENCE
5-133. The S2 prepares intelligence estimates and conducts the IPB process.
Regardless of the nature and intensity of conflict, this involves a time-tested
process. FM 2-01.3 (FM 34-130) contains appropriate checklists and an
aviation-specific section. IPB results are used to develop the products to
support collection management, identify potential enemy COAs, and support
the development of the commander's scheme of maneuver (to include
branches and sequels).
5-134. Intelligence is provided from many sources; however, the major
intelligence source will be the division G2 section, attached MI assets, and
subordinate unit reports. The brigade S2 is the key intelligence coordinator.
5-23
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
MANEUVER
5-137. The airborne division fights and exploits terrain and urban areas for
both offensive and defensive operations. Airborne division aviation forces can
support light infantry in any terrain day or night. Aviation's rapid mobility
can quickly assist the division's ground forces as they move under the
concealment of night and the cover and concealment of restricted terrain
(Figure 5-5).
5-138. The attack and reconnaissance elements employ OH-58D aircraft to
enhance limited airlift capacity of Air Force aircraft. However, this limits
overall ordnance loads, which increases the division's reliance on corps AH-64
assets for deep missions and defense against large armored forces. As part of
an early entry force, attack and reconnaissance force elements may be part of
a forcible entry and subsequent lodgement defense. They may deploy from
ships or intermediate staging bases in adjacent allied territory. If airlifted
directly to the lodgement, rapid aircraft reassembly is critical.
5-139. Both attack and reconnaissance elements may be important parts of
the initial screening and security force for the lodgement. In subsequent
offensive missions, aircraft provide security for air assaults, and conduct
autonomous attack missions, and provide support for parachute infantry
regiment forces in contact. Aircraft have limited time on station and
frequently use the continuous employment technique to rotate companies
through the FARP to support ground troops. Reconnaissance elements
destroy enemy scouts as part of guard or screening force and provide early
warning and security for the division.
5-140. The aviation brigade conducts limited shaping operations with the
attack battalion and may support those operations with air cavalry and aerial
mine delivery. The brigade also conducts economy-of-force or reserve
missions. In the economy-of-force role it may advance with or without air
assaults forces to hold enemy forces in place while the division maneuvers
toward the main objective. As the division reserve, it may respond to rear
area threats, support the division commander's scheme of maneuver when he
needs to exploit success, conduct pursuit, or reinforce ground forces.
5-24
Chapter Five
5-25
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
may provide security at the airhead or port of entry during the deployment
and redeployment phase.
5-144. Attack and cavalry can conduct attacks against enemy artillery that
can devastate light infantry forces. They can also conduct limited overwatch
of bridges along key enemy avenues of approach, and obstacles and
minefields at key chokepoints in mountainous and densely forested, or
swampy terrain.
5-145. The AHB conducts air assaults to support seizure of key terrain or to
allow light forces to gain a maneuver advantage over enemy forces. It can
conduct a battalion-sized air assault without augmentation. For larger air
assaults, the division requires corps or other division augmentation.
Helicopters can transport troops to the objective or rapidly move them after
they infiltrate to it. They can also insert and extract reconnaissance teams
forward of the line of own troops. Aviation units may conduct false insertions
as part of the deception plan. Assault aircraft can drop forces atop ridgelines,
altitude and threat permitting, to allow them to fight down or along the
ridge. The assault battalion emplaces minefields using Volcano to reinforce
natural obstacles or to block chokepoints. It supports the division command
group, other brigades, the cavalry squadron, and the attack battalion with C2
helicopters.
5-146. In an urban environment helicopters can emplace forces on rooftops,
in parks, stadiums, parking areas, and other similar areas. The presence of
wires, poles, antennas, and other obstacles may limit some landing areas.
Attack battalion and cavalry aircraft cover landings by engaging targets
using running fire or from standoff ranges. Helicopters must minimize
ground time and hovering to avoid sniper, grenade and RPG engagement
when inserting or overwatching forces.
5-147. Brigade UH-60, attached UH-60/HH-60L air ambulances, and OH-
58D aircraft may provide assets for CSAR to recover downed joint and Army
aviators.
FIRE SUPPORT
5-148. Aviation brigades ensure JSEAD is planned and coordinated to
include nonlethal means. Utility aircraft externally transport 105 mm
howitzers and Q-36 Firefinder radars. They also transport forward observer
teams. Attack units may need to coordinate closely with artillery Firefinder
units to find and destroy enemy artillery and mortars that threaten light
infantry. OH-58D aircraft in the cavalry squadron and ATKHB are well-
equipped to support on-call fires and laser designate for joint laser-guided
munitions. They also have limited 2.75-inch rocket capability to suppress and
destroy maneuver forces and ADs. Guns can be effective if enemy AD sites
are unexpectedly encountered at close ranges.
5-26
Chapter Five
AIR DEFENSE
5-149. Brigade elements employ both active and passive AD measures.
Active measures include use of Stinger missiles, gun, Hellfire, and rocket
ammunition to conduct defensive air combat. Passive measures include
terrain flight, camouflage, and selection of locations that provide cover and
concealment for CPs, AAs, and FARPs. Air guards for vehicle movements and
road marches provide early warning. Convoy discipline, such as maintaining
proper distances between vehicles, limits damage from air attack. Elements
use IFF codes to avoid fratricide. A2C2 plans, procedures, and orders ensure
AD elements are aware of aircraft AAs and ingress and egress routes.
5-150. In SASO and SSC, an air threat may not exist; however, aircraft may
be required to trail drug smuggling aircraft before handoff to the DEA, Coast
Guard, or host nation air forces. These aircraft may perform evasive
maneuvers or fly at high speeds to avoid capture. Missions such as these
require additional training because they are not normally part of a unit's
METL.
MOBILITY/COUNTERMOBILITY/SURVIVABILITY
5-151. Division aviation brigade aircraft routinely support the mobility and
countermobility efforts of engineers in MTW, SSC and SASO. Road
improvements are major mobility efforts that can require helicopter support
to transport outsize loads such as metal pipes for culverts, bridge materiel,
and personnel. Volcano-equipped aircraft escorted by attack helicopters can
emplace minefields. Helicopters may also transport survivability materiel
such as concertina and sandbags to support security for base camps.
5-152. Division brigade aircraft also conduct air movement of MP reaction
forces and traffic control teams, as well as, movement of chemical
reconnaissance and decontamination teams. They also transport firefighters
and water bucket in support of domestic missions.
5-27
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
OVERVIEW
5-156. The air assault division attack helicopter brigade has three ATKHBs,
one air cavalry squadron, and one CAB. Its AH-64Ds differentiate it from
other light divisions that have OH-58Ds. It also has more attack battalions
than any other division.
5-157. The brigade prepares to deploy within 36 hours of notification.
5-158. It plans, synchronizes, and executes aerial fires as an element of an
air assault combined arms team. Its CAB supports the division C2 mission,
performs Volcano and team insertion missions, and provides an organic
source of FARP and other CSS aerial sustainment.
HOW TO FIGHT
5-160. The attack helicopter brigade's primary role is to set the conditions for
success for each of its units. The brigade must prepare to fight as a whole, to
support other units using pure or task-organized units, and to conduct
multiple independent missions requiring pure or task-organized units.
5-161. The attack helicopter brigade conducts division shaping or decisive
operations. It fights as a brigade or as a brigade (minus) with one or all of its
attack battalions operating to support the ground brigades. The air cavalry
squadron fights under brigade or division control, but normally under brigade
control. Its mine delivery capability found in the CAB supports brigade
operation, or operates in DS of a ground brigade. The attack helicopter
brigade is an excellent unit to support guard or covering force operations.
When task-organized with ground units, it can conduct both guard and cover
operations.
5-28
Chapter Five
• During initial entry, the attack helicopter brigade often fights as part of
a joint force. Additionally, they may conduct joint shaping operations as
a matter of necessity to defend the lodgement. These operation may be
conducted from Navy helicopter ships or aircraft carriers. These
operations may be under the command of Army or other service
headquarters.
• The attack helicopter brigade conducts shaping operations for the
ARFOR or division commander. These shaping operations are usually
directed and planned by a DOCC and supported by other services. The
brigade commander and staff routinely participate in DOCC planning
and execution. The combatant commander for the AO may or may not
require missions to appear on the ATO.
• The deep nature of attack brigade operations may require aircraft to fly
with auxiliary fuel tanks. Training to use these tanks and the resultant
reduction in munitions is essential. It must be part of the unit SOP.
Longbow-equipped attack regiments can employ RF missiles with
greater freedom and rapidity of launch because the deep nature of
many missions reduces fratricide risk.
• During the close battle, the attack regiment can OPCON one or more
battalions to one or more brigades while it plans and executes other
operations with its remaining attack battalions and air cavalry
squadron. It also provides air assault security for all air assault
operations with attack helicopter, air cavalry, mine delivery, and
airborne C2 support.
5-162. The CAB provides continuous C2 and mine delivery support to the
division. It also provides C2, mine delivery, and limited sustainment support
to the attack brigade.
INTELLIGENCE
5-163. The S2 prepares intelligence estimates and conducts the IPB process.
Regardless of the nature and intensity of conflict, this involves a time-tested
process. FM 2-01.3 (FM 34-130) contains appropriate checklists and an
aviation-specific section. IPB results are used to develop the products to
support collection management, identify potential enemy COAs, and support
the development of the commander's scheme of maneuver (to include
branches and sequels).
5-164. Intelligence is provided from many sources; however, the major
intelligence source will be the division G2 section, attached MI assets, and
subordinate unit reports. The brigade S2 is the key intelligence coordinator.
5-165. The attack brigade's size, and early entry mission give it greater
access to JSTARS Ground Station Module and Common Ground Station as
well as other joint and theater intelligence support like Trojan Spirit II. The
CAB, unique to this brigade, has an additional mission of emplacing long
range surveillance team members. The cavalry squadron provides another
robust source of combat information for the brigade. UAVs support cavalry
operations by detecting enemy scouts and advance bodies. Cavalry then
destroy the enemy or maintain contact while UAVs continue to search. UAVs
also support air assaults and operations in deep areas, and must identify
threats en route and at the objective, while allowing brigade, division, and
5-29
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
5-166. The division may task the brigade with conducting intelligence liaison
with other elements to gather aviation-specific information. This could be as
simple as flying to the closest Air Force intelligence source, or as complicated
as placing LNOs with allied and joint forces.
MANEUVER
5-167. The air assault division's attack brigade is comparable in size to corps
attack regiments and has more attack aircraft than any other division. This
gives the division a formidable antiarmor capability during independent
attacks or to support air assaults. While assault battalions provide habitual
support to individual infantry brigades, the attack battalions may do the
same or may fight independently depending on the division commander's
priorities for shaping versus decisive operations.
5-168. When providing habitual support for ground air assault brigades, one
battalion supports each brigade with antiarmor and suppressive rocket and
30mm gun fires. Some attack battalion companies provide security during air
5-30
Chapter Five
assaults while others continue attacks on the objective area. The brigade can
accept augmentation from corps attack and utility/heavy helicopter units.
5-169. The brigade conducts independent shaping and decisive operations as
the division commander dictates. It conducts hasty, deliberate, and spoiling
attacks, and counterattacks. It also conducts raids, feints, and
demonstrations. The attack brigade, with ground and assault force
augmentation, conducts movement to contract, pursuit and exploitation.
During initial lodgement and as conditions dictate, the brigade conducts
mobile and area defense, but even in the defense, its actions are offensive.
5-170. Cavalry and attack elements provide initial security and
reconnaissance during initial entry/lodgement. Conduct route, area and zone
reconnaissance and reconnaissance-in-force. The brigade can act as division
guard when augmented with ground units. It conducts flank screens with its
attack or cavalry assets, and provides security for MSRs and rear areas.
5-171. Brigade UH-60, attached UH-60/HH-60L air ambulances, and OH-
58D aircraft may provide assets for CSAR to recover downed joint and Army
aviators.
FIRE SUPPORT
5-172. Aviation brigades ensure JSEAD is planned and coordinated to
include nonlethal means. Brigade aircraft can provide supporting rocket and
gun fires for ground forces, assault elements, and shaping operations.
Aircrews can initiate preplanned and on-call fires from supporting towed
howitzers and MLRS units. Cavalry aircraft in the brigade will habitually
employ FS as part of its security and reconnaissance mission. Longbow and
Kiowa Warrior aircraft are well-equipped to provide on-call FS for air assault
task forces. They also have organic 2.75-inch rockets to provide suppressive
and destructive fires. Finally, they can laser designate for joint laser-guided
bombs.
AIR DEFENSE
5-173. The brigade employs both active and passive AD measures. Active
measures include use of Stinger missiles, gun, Hellfire, and rocket
ammunition to conduct defensive air combat. Passive measures include
terrain flight, camouflage, and selection of locations that provide cover and
concealment for CPs, AAs, and FARPs. Air guards for vehicle movements and
road marches provide early warning. Convoy discipline, such as maintaining
proper distances between vehicles, limits damage from air attack. Elements
use IFF codes to avoid fratricide. A2C2 plans, procedures, and orders ensure
AD elements are aware of aircraft AAs and ingress and egress routes.
5-174. Corps attack units conducting operations in deep areas have a greater
likelihood of encountering enemy rotorcraft and fighters. AH-64D aircraft
with FCR can identify enemy rotorcraft and engage with RF and SAL
missiles, flechette rockets, and guns. JSTARS and AWACS may or may not
provide adequate early warning for joint assets to destroy enemy aircraft
before they engage friendly forces. During deep battle the risk of fratricide
increases from friendly joint assets conducting combat air patrols and from
friendly ADs during the return to friendly lines. IFF procedures are critical.
5-31
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
IFF systems may be turned off while in enemy territory to avoid emitting, but
leaving them on must be balanced with the fratricide risk from other service
and allied aircraft. IFF must be on before returning to friendly lines.
Brigades may designate and arm aircraft to provide defensive air combat
security for regimental deep strikes and conduct rear area defensive air
combat against infiltrating enemy rotorcraft.
5-175. In SASO and SSC, an air threat may not exist; however, aircraft may
be required to trail drug smuggling aircraft before handoff to the DEA, Coast
Guard, or host nation air forces. These aircraft may perform evasive
maneuvers or fly at high speeds in an attempt to avoid capture. Missions
such as these require additional training because they are not normally part
of a unit's METL.
MOBILITY/COUNTERMOBILITY/SURVIVABILITY
5-176. Aerial delivery of mines can support regimental operations in deep
areas. These operations may be conducted just before or simultaneous to the
regiment's attack. Aerial mining operations must be planned with the same
level of detail as an operation in a deep area to ensure the slow moving mine
delivery aircraft are not interdicted by enemy action.
OVERVIEW
5-180. This unique brigade has three assault battalions, and a HvyHB. The
TOE CAB is permanently attached to the division's attack helicopter brigade.
The brigade prepares to deploy within 36 hours of notification. It plans,
synchronizes and executes air assault, air sustainment, and air movement
operations as an integrated element of an air assault combined arms team.
5-32
Chapter Five
HOW TO FIGHT
5-182. The air assault brigade is the primary integrator of utility and heavy
helicopter assets within the division. Its primary role is to set the conditions
for success for each of its units. The aviation brigade must prepare to fight as
a whole and to support individual ground brigades using pure or task-
organized battalion-sized units. It must prepare to conduct multiple
independent missions requiring pure or task-organized units. The brigade
provides habitual support for air assault infantry brigades for combat, CS,
and CSS missions.
• The brigade should be able to move the assault forces of a ground
brigade and its supporting artillery in one lift. However, emerging force
constraints may reduce that ability to two or three lifts.
• It can form air assault task forces to support all three brigades and
enable each brigade to move the assault forces of a ground battalion
and an artillery battery in one lift.
• It should be able to form a heavy air assault task force to support one
brigade with the ability to move the assault forces of two ground
battalions and two artillery batteries in one lift. It should be able to
provide an air assault task force to support another brigade with the
ability to move the assault forces of a ground battalion and an artillery
battery in one lift. However, emerging force constraints may reduce
that ability to two or three lifts (Figure 5-7).
• The HvyHB can move large amounts of supplies, equipment, and
troops. It can do that as a battalion or as separate companies and
platoons. HvyHC normally support the ground brigades as part of an
air assault task force.
• The ATS company provides ATS throughout the division.
INTELLIGENCE
5-183. The S2 prepares intelligence estimates and conducts the IPB process.
Regardless of the nature and intensity of conflict, this involves a time-tested
process. FM 2-01.3 (FM 34-130) contains appropriate checklists and an
aviation-specific section. IPB results are used to develop the products to
support collection management, identify potential enemy COAs, and support
the development of the commander's scheme of maneuver (to include
branches and sequels).
5-33
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
5-34
Chapter Five
5-187. The brigade may have access to a JSTARS common ground station
that can provide real-time intelligence access from a variety of sources. UAV
support for aviation missions is essential to identify threats without risking
manned aircraft. The brigade's aircrews are a great source of combat
information.
MANEUVER
5-188. The brigade's UH-60 and CH-47 aircraft are a primary means of
tactical transport for division soldiers. A typical deployment task force
includes an infantry brigade and a towed artillery battalion, an assault
battalion, an attack battalion, a CH-47 company, supporting engineers, and
CS/CSS units. This gives the brigade task force adequate capability to move
infantry forces and much of the supporting artillery in multiple lifts with UH-
60 seats removed and Kevlar blankets installed.
5-189. Such a brigade task force may perform forcible entry from ships or
intermediate staging bases in adjacent allied territory. It may conduct
assisted or unassisted entry as an airlifted force deployed to a lodgement
airfield. It subsequently defends the lodgement and conducts shaping air
assault and operations in deep areas as required to deter attacks on the
lodgement. As more forces deploy or if the brigade force is adequate to attack
the threat, the brigade task force may conduct a movement to contact,
deliberate and hasty attacks, and exploitation and pursuit.
5-190. Brigade aviation assault forces are well-suited to conduct mobile
strikes with infantry and supporting artillery to seize forward operating
bases from which attack aviation elements can conduct sustained operations
in deep areas. Assault elements can lift smaller infantry teams conducting
raids and ambushes to destroy limited objectives. They can conduct false and
brief insertions to deceive the enemy through feints and demonstrations.
5-191. To support SASO and SSC, the brigade deploys elements as part of
mutifunctional battalion task force that may tranport allied soldiers fighting
inurgency forces. Aircraft may operate out of remote base camps supporting
patrolling forces and reaction teams, as well as counterdrug efforts.
5-192. Brigade UH-60, attached UH-60/HH-60L air ambulances, and OH-
58D aircraft may provide assets for CSAR to recover downed joint and Army
aviators.
FIRE SUPPORT
5-193. Aviation brigades ensure JSEAD is planned and coordinated to
include nonlethal means. Utility aircraft transport forward observer teams.
Heavy helicopters transport towed 155mm howitzers and Q-36 Firefinder
radars. Many aircraft are available to resupply artillery units supporting the
ground and aviation brigades. AATFCs preplan JSEAD fires to support
ingress operations and preplan fires near the LZ and objective. Radio systems
aboard assault aircraft can be employed by FSEs to initiate on-call fires as
needed.
5-35
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
AIR DEFENSE
5-194. Brigade elements employ both active and passive AD measures. When
conducting air assaults and large air movements the brigade can expect to
have AH-64 units in support. Their active measures include use of Stinger
missiles, gun, Hellfire, and rocket ammunition to conduct defensive air
combat. Utility and heavy helicopters organic to the brigade lack self-defense
missiles and guns but their door guns provide limited AD capability. Utility
assets may internally transport Stinger teams and externally transport
Avenger systems. Passive measures include terrain flight, camouflage, and
selection of locations that provide cover and concealment for CPs, AAs, and
FARPs. Air guards for vehicle movements and road marches provide early
warning. Convoy discipline, such as maintaining proper distances between
vehicles, limits damage from air attack. Elements use IFF codes to avoid
fratricide. A2C2 plans, procedures, and orders ensure AD elements are aware
of aircraft AAs and ingress and egress routes.
5-195. In SASO and SSC, an air threat may not exist. However, aircraft may
be required to trail drug smuggling aircraft before handoff to the DEA, Coast
Guard, or host nation air forces. These aircraft may perform evasive
maneuvers or fly at high speeds to avoid capture. Missions such as these
require additional training because they are not normally part of a unit's
METL.
MOBILITY/COUNTERMOBILITY/SURVIVABILITY
5-196. Brigade aircraft routinely support the mobility and countermobility
efforts of engineers in MTW, SSC and SASO. Heavy helicopters can assist
river crossings by lifting ribbon bridge bays into place. Volcano-equipped
aircraft escorted by attack helicopters can emplace minefields. Helicopters
also may transport survivability materiel such as concertina wire and
sandbags to support security for base camps.
5-197. Division brigade aircraft also conduct air movement of MP reaction
forces and traffic control teams, as well as, movement of chemical
reconnaissance and decontamination teams. They also transport firefighters
and water bucket to support domestic missions.
5-36
Chapter Five
OVERVIEW
5-201. The TAB is the primary aviation headquarters for Army aviation
operations conducted by its parent headquarters. The brigade has a CAB, a
fixed-wing battalion, a HvyHB, and an ATS Group.
AIRFIELDS
5-205. The TAB normally operates its fixed-wing assets from airfields. These
airfields may be part of the host nation infrastructure, a captured enemy
airfield, another service's airfield, or one built by Army or other service
engineers. According to METT-TC, the other assets of the TAB may use
airfields.
5-37
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
HOW TO FIGHT
5-206. The TAB's primary role is to set the conditions for success for each of
its units. It accomplishes its mission through responsive C2 and logistics
support.
• TAB fixed-wing and C2 helicopter units assist EAC commander and
staff movement within the AO to coordinate and execute warfighting.
• Heavy and utility helicopter assets support critical EAC logistics and
CS.
• The TAB may provide C2 for aviation support operations such as air
assaults against rear area threats.
INTELLIGENCE
5-207. The S2 prepares intelligence estimates and conducts the IPB process.
Regardless of the nature and intensity of conflict, this involves a time-tested
process. FM 2-01.3 (FM 34-130) contains appropriate checklists and an
aviation-specific section. IPB results are used to develop the products to
support collection management, identify potential enemy COAs, and support
the development of the commander's scheme of maneuver (to include
branches and sequels).
5-208. Many sources provide intelligence for the TAB; however, the major
sources for brigade intelligence will be the EAC intelligence section. For
operations into subordinate unit areas, the brigade S2 contacts the
intelligence sections of corps and division units to gain the latest information
for aircrews moving commanders and staff to and from EAC HQ to
subordinate unit locations.
MANEUVER
5-209. The TAB may C2 maneuver operations; however, this is not its normal
function. The brigade's primary contribution to maneuver is its support of
higher echelon C2 and logistics. One possible brigade maneuver operation
may be support to level III rear area threats. The brigade may either support
or control U.S. ground maneuver forces, allied forces, or MP units in the
reaction to such threats. In some theaters, no AC utility and heavy
helicopters may exist at corps level. In that case, TAB assets play the major
role in assault support until corps assets activate and deploy.
FIRE SUPPORT
5-210. Support for theater level or subordinate unit FS units is a mission for
the TAB. Such support normally includes transport of equipment and
ammunition. Examples include external transport of towed artillery, air
transport of key FS ammunition for the ATACMS and MLRS, and transport
of Q36 Firefinder radars.
AIR DEFENSE
5-211. Brigade elements employ both active and passive AD measures.
Active measures include use of door guns to conduct defensive air combat.
Passive measures include terrain flight, camouflage, and selection of
locations that provide cover and concealment for CPs, AAs, and FARPs. Air
5-38
Chapter Five
guards for vehicle movements and road marches provide early warning.
Convoy discipline, such as maintaining proper distances between vehicles,
limits damage from air attack. Elements use IFF codes to avoid fratricide.
A2C2 plans, procedures, and orders ensure AD elements are aware of aircraft
AAs and ingress and egress routes.
5-212. At theater level, Patriot missile systems have a primary missile
defense mission besides AD functions. Because of their high priority theater
heavy helicopters may support Patriot batteries by transporting missiles.
MOBILITY/COUNTERMOBILITY/SURVIVABILITY
5-213. TAB aircraft routinely support the mobility and countermobility
efforts of engineers in MTW, SSC and SASO. Road construction and
improvement are major mobility efforts that can require helicopter support to
transport outsize loads such as metal pipes for culverts, bridge materiel, and
personnel. Heavy helicopters can assist river crossings by lifting ribbon
bridge bays into place. Helicopters may also transport survivability materiel
such as concertina and sandbags to support security for base camps.
5-214. Theater brigade aircraft also conduct air movement of MP reaction
forces and traffic control teams, as well as, movement of chemical
reconnaissance and decontamination teams. They also transport firefighters
and water bucket to support domestic missions.
5-39
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
OVERVIEW
5-220. The DCSA Bde is the primary headquarters for Army aviation
operations conducted by its division. The brigade normally includes GSABs,
AHBs, and a HvyHC.
5-221. The fielding of large numbers of UH-60s in the context of a smaller
number of active and RC divisions provides the opportunity to create a new
kind of aviation brigade to support war and military operations other than
war (MOOTW). There are two DCSA Bde equipped exclusively with UH-60
aircraft that provide peacetime C2, training and logistics support and
wartime/MOOTW habitual augmentation of active divisions. Each DCSA Bde
has multiple AHBs that support light, airborne, and air assault divisions and
GSAB that support heavy divisions, and the air assault division. Many of
these batttalions are currently equipped with UH-1H aircraft but will
transition to UH-60s.
HOW TO FIGHT
5-223. Unlike other aviation brigades, the DCSA Bde commander generally
will not fight the subordinate battalions in his command. The subordinate
battalions augment the assault and GS capabilities of the respective divisions
they support. As such they generally operate under the division aviation
brigade commander during major deployments, and whatever task force
commander is in charge during more minor rotation of forces. The same
assault and GS missions performed by division utility battalions also apply to
the DCSA Bde.
INTELLIGENCE
5-224. The S2 prepares intelligence estimates and conducts the IPB process.
Regardless of the nature and intensity of conflict, this involves a time-tested
process. FM 2-01.3 (FM 34-130) contains appropriate checklists and an
aviation-specific section. IPB results are used to develop the products to
support collection management, identify potential enemy COAs, and support
5-40
Chapter Five
MANEUVER
5-226. With downsizing of division utility units, DCSA Bde UH-60s will play
an increasing role in air assaults, TACAIR movement, and aerial
sustainment. Extended range fuel tanks give UH-60s extensive range and
endurance for mobile strikes. Light, and airborne divisions are particularly
dependent on DCSA Bde aircraft for larger scale air maneuver of forces.
DCSA Bde GS battalions augment heavy divisions conducting air assaults
with dismounted mechanized infantry to secure the far side during gap-
crossing efforts. Air assault of dismounted infantry may also occur to seize
chokepoints before the arrival of mechanized and armor forces. DCSA Bde
aircraft are also available to insert and extract infantry patrols and SOF
during raids and reconnaissance missions.
5-227. In SASO, DCSA Bde units can expect to transport U.S. and allied
soldiers who may be fighting guerillas. Guerillas may fire small arms, and
RPGs at group aircraft. In SASO and SSC, units may perform a
reconnaissance function or carry civilian or military observers. Urban
operations may be a primary activity requiring group aircraft to exercise
caution from both an enemy sniper and safety perspective given the presence
on noncombatants, wires, and antennas (see Appendix R).
FIRE SUPPORT
5-228. Utility aircraft transport forward observer teams. Aircraft can
externally transport towed 105mm howitzers and resupply artillery units
supporting the ground and aviation brigades. AATFCs preplan JSEAD fires
to support ingress operations, and preplan fires near the LZ and objective.
FSEs aboard assault aircraft can employ aircraft radios to initiate on-call
fires as needed. Aircraft can transport infantry mortar teams and Q-36
Firefinder radars.
AIR DEFENSE
5-229. UH-60 units transport Stinger teams and Avenger systems. During
air assaults, DCSA Bde battalions require attack or reconnaissance unit
security against air attack. Passive measures include terrain flight,
camouflage, and selection of locations that provide cover and concealment for
CPs, AAs, and FARPs. Air guards for vehicle movements and road marches
provide early warning. Convoy discipline, such as maintaining proper
distances between vehicles, limits damage from air attack. Elements use IFF
codes to avoid fratricide. A2C2 plans, procedures, and orders ensure AD
elements are aware of aircraft AAs and ingress and egress routes.
5-41
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
5-230. In SASO and SSC an air threat may not exist. However, units
involved in drug interdiction may trail drug smuggling aircraft before handoff
to DEA, Coast Guard, or host nation air forces. These aircraft may perform
evasive maneuvers or fly at high speed attempting to avoid capture.
MOBILITY/COUNTERMOBILITY/SURVIVABILITY
5-231. UH-60 aircraft support engineer, MP, and chemical soldiers in their
mobility, countermobility and survivability efforts. Aircraft transport
engineers teams and their equipment during road and obstacle construction.
Utility aircraft can assist engineers in river crossing by lifting security
elements to the far side. Utility aircraft transport MPs performing rear area,
peacekeeping, and mobility missions. Aircraft may transport enemy
prisoners. Chemical teams may require air movement to areas where
suspected chemical attacks have occurred, such as areas hit by tactical
ballistic and cruise missiles.
5-42
Chapter 6
PASSAGE OF LINES
6-1. A passage of lines is an operation in which one force moves through
another force's position, without interference, with the intent of moving into
or out of contact with the enemy. Aviation units can conduct a passage as a
part of reconnaissance, security, attack, or air assault operations. There are
occasions when other units pass through an aviation unit's position. Also, the
aviation unit may facilitate another unit's movement by monitoring its
progress through PPs and contact points.
• Forward Passage. Executed during offensive operations to continue an
attack; to conduct a penetration, envelopment, or a pursuit; or to pass
another unit for any reason. In the defense, a forward passage of lines
may be conducted as part of a counterattack of one unit through
another.
• Lateral Passage. Conducted in the same manner as a forward passage.
• Rearward Passage. Conducted as part of a retrograde operation or
when an aviation or ground unit returns from a cross-FLOT mission.
CONSIDERATIONS
6-2. When the aviation unit is the passing force, it is particularly vulnerable
because aircraft may be overly concentrated, stationary force fires may be
temporarily masked, and the unit passed through may not be positioned to
react to enemy actions. Reconnaissance and coordination ensure passage is
conducted quickly and smoothly.
6-3. Contact points for ground elements should be located along the
designated passage phase line to allow the passed unit to provide
overwatching fires. Contact points normally should be at easily identifiable
terrain features, such as road junctions. For terrain without many
identifiable terrain features, GPS coordinates are an excellent backup.
6-4. Other considerations include—
• Security measures during passage.
• Tactical cover and deception plans to retain secrecy and aid in gaining
or maintaining surprise.
• Priorities for movement control (priority to passing unit).
• Time or circumstances when responsibility for control of the AO will be
transferred.
6-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
COORDINATION
6-6. Timely and specific coordination before the operation is essential. The
most desirable method is a face-to-face exchange of information. As a
minimum, the exchange should include—
• Intelligence information.
• Tactical plans.
• SOPs.
• Period of time required for the passage.
• Locations of PPs and friendly unit locations.
• Disposition and scheme of maneuver of friendly units.
• Enemy situation in sector, including air activity.
• Types and numbers of aircraft to pass.
• Methods of communication, to include frequencies and call signs, visual
signals, and backups.
• Control of friendly supporting fires, including restrictive FS
coordination.
• AD weapon control status.
• Friendly minefields and obstacles.
• Contingency plans for stationary and passing units, if they are attacked
during passage.
PASSAGE PLANNING
6-7. The aviation commander analyzes the higher commander's intent and
provides guidance for the S3 to prepare the plan for the passage of lines. The
following factors are emphasized:
• Organization. When possible, unit integrity is maintained to provide
better C2.
• C2. Techniques of C2 depend on the number of PPs. Ideally, multiple
PPs are established to facilitate decentralized control. Control
measures are developed as required to maintain positive control
throughout the passage. Commanders position themselves where they
can best influence the operation.
6-2
Chapter Six
BATTLE HANDOVER
6-9. A battle handover (BHO) is a coordinated operation between two units
that transfers responsibility for fighting an enemy force from one element to
another. The BHO maintains continuity of the combined arms fight and
protect the combat potential of both forces. Ground BHOs, such as cavalry
passing back through friendly lines, usually are associated with a passage of
lines. BHO may occur during offensive or defensive operations.
PLANNING CONSIDERATIONS
6-11. Clear SOPs enable units to quickly effect the coordination required to
preclude loss of momentum in the attack. Control measures should be simple
and standardized. As a minimum, coordination should include—
• Establishment of communications.
• Exchange of friendly and enemy information.
• Collation of C2.
• Placement of representatives at contact points.
• Status of obstacles and routes.
6-12. In air-ground operations, participating air and ground commanders
often handover an enemy force in contact. BHO governs this process in terms
of close coordination, FS, and mutual understanding of responsibilities.
6-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
6-16. Deliberate and chance encounters with enemy aircraft may occur
throughout the AO.
PLANNING CONSIDERATIONS
6-17. Generally, air combat between Army helicopters and enemy rotary- or
fixed-wing aircraft is not desired. Although the aviation brigade staff sets the
battle space to minimize the probability of undesired aerial encounters,
commanders must anticipate the possibility of chance air combat operations
and plan accordingly. Priority remains to the assigned mission.
AVOID DETECTION
6-18. During the MDMP, the staff plans the operation to minimize the
enemy's ability to detect Army aircraft. Missions are planned to avoid known
and suspected enemy locations, if feasible. Appropriate maneuver, terrain
masking, cloud cover, obscurants, night operations, and FS are used to
degrade enemy detection capabilities. The tactical operations officer, with the
S2 and S3, recommends ASE settings to thwart the capabilities of known and
suspected threat detection systems.
6-4
Chapter Six
COORDINATING INSTRUCTIONS
6-21. The brigade OPORD should contain the commander's instructions
regarding subordinate unit action upon contact with enemy aircraft, if his
desires or priorities during the operation vary from actions specified in the
SOP. Actions available to aircrews, in order of preference, are to avoid, evade,
threaten, or engage threat aircraft.
AIR-TO-AIR STINGER
6-23. Depending on the armament configuration for a particular mission,
this system may be mounted on some or all OH-58Ds. Air-to-air Stinger
(ATAS) on some or all AH-64Ds is a potential future capability. The ATAS
should be used at or near maximum range. Although the ATAS may be used
in short-range firings (under 1,000 meters), the minimum arming range may
affect its lethality. In extended-range firing, the ATAS has a detectable
smoke signature under certain atmospheric conditions.
6-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
HELLFIRE MISSILE
6-28. Depending on the armament configuration for a particular mission, the
SAL Hellfire may be mounted on some or all OH-58D, AH-64A, or AH-64D
aircraft. Only the AH-64D has the necessary systems to employ the RF
Hellfire (see Appendix I). The Hellfire is an effective weapon against
attacking enemy aircraft. It can be used in either the direct or indirect fire
mode. Ideally, aircrews should engage with Hellfire using indirect fire if
terrain masking protects the firing aircraft. In the direct fire mode it can be
used against head-on, tail-on, or slow-flying enemy helicopters.
FEINT
6-30. A feint is a limited attack to divert an enemy's attack or to deceive him
as to the friendly force's intentions. Feints are frequently used for deception
before or during a main attack. To succeed, this feint must appear to be the
main attack. Additional feints are conducted to cause the enemy to reveal its
defensive posture and to disrupt its decision-making cycle. Feints reduce the
resistance that the main attacking force will encounter by holding enemy
units in the area of the feint.
6-31. Aviation brigade elements normally conduct reconnaissance and
security operations to support ground feints. Aviation can also conduct feints
independently. Assault units can assist in feint operations by executing false
or actual air assault operations.
DEMONSTRATION
6-32. A demonstration serves the same purpose as a feint, but does not
involve contact with the enemy. The objective of a demonstration is to deceive
and confuse the enemy as to the real intentions of the attacking force. For a
demonstration to succeed, the enemy must observe the demonstrating force's
operation and be deceived by it, but not actively engage the force. The nature
of a demonstration allows the use of decoys, simulations, and tactically
inoperable equipment to portray additional strength. Demonstrations also
may be used to provide security or to conduct reconnaissance to assess the
enemy reaction.
6-33. Aviation brigade elements normally conduct reconnaissance and
security operations to support a ground demonstration. Aviation can also
conduct demonstrations independently. Assault units may execute false air
assault operations.
6-6
Chapter Six
6-34. The search and attack mission is a variant of the movement to contact
by smaller, light maneuver units and air cavalry or air assault forces in large
areas to destroy enemy forces, or deny area to the enemy. Search and attack
operations may be conducted against a dispersed enemy in close terrain
unsuitable for armored forces, in rear areas against enemy SOF or
infiltrators, or as an area security mission to clear assigned zones.
6-35. The search and attack technique is best used when the enemy is
operating in small teams using hit-and-run tactics over a large area in a
generally decentralized manner. The purpose of this operation is defined as
one or more of the following:
• Destruction of the enemy.
• Area denial.
• Force protection.
AVIATION'S ROLE
6-36. From an aviation perspective, the search and attack mission is
performed like a movement to contact or a force-oriented area security
mission.
6-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
6-40. Any maneuver force with the combat power to destroy the designated
enemy force may accomplish the finishing portion. Aviation finishes the
enemy by massing fires in a hasty or deliberate attack, either independently
or with ground forces. The key to success for this part of the mission is to
bring the finishing force's combat power to bear at the key time when the
fixing force has halted the enemy's movement.
COORDINATION
6-42. Effective search and attack operations require a great deal of
coordination between the subordinate elements. SA is extremely important
because of the fluid environment in which this mission is conducted.
Subordinate commanders must keep abreast of current activities and the
locations of other air and ground elements to ensure they have their units in
the proper location and mission posture to deal with enemy contact.
SECTION V – RAIDS
6-8
Chapter Six
enemy. They also can deny him reinforcement while the ground force
completes its mission.
6-46. In case of a major enemy reaction, armed helicopters can provide
suppressive fires to cover the ground force's withdrawal. They also can
destroy abandoned friendly vehicles and weapon systems.
6-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
6-10
Chapter Six
Hovering in urban areas exposes aircraft to small arms fires and should only
be done if essential to the mission and adequate overwatch fires are
available. Wire, tower, and antenna hazards are especially prevalent and
must be considered in the IPB. Other examples include—
• Demographics of the local population.
• Subterranean, ground level, and above ground terrain analysis.
• Civilian maps and diagrams.
• Airfields, helipads, and rooftops that can be used as LZs.
• Structures and areas protected by the Law of War or restricted by ROE.
• Supplementary electronic and visual signals to differentiate friend from
foe.
• Weapons selection to produce the desired effect while minimizing
collateral damage, and maximizing standoff.
CIVIL CONCERNS
6-54. Operations in urbanized terrain almost always will have significant
impact on noncombatants. Special considerations are required. Units should
maintain liaison with local police, ATS, civil, and military authorities.
Care of Civilians
6-55. Civilians may be removed from the area or protected in their homes. In
some cases, the aviation brigade may be required to arrange for supply,
transportation, medical care, and other support for civilians.
Security
6-56. The threat of espionage, sabotage, and terrorism must be carefully
considered and guarded against.
6-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
GENERAL
6-58. SASO are two, separate activities that do not necessarily involve armed
conflict between organized forces.
EMPLOYMENT
6-60. The majority of missions assigned to aviation brigades during SASO
will either conform to or build upon their standard reconnaissance, security,
attack, air assault, and air movement roles. Generally, the major differences
in unit operations during SASO will be in the C2 relationships between the
aviation brigade and its higher headquarters, and the greater requirement
for restraint in potentially hostile situations.
SPECIAL CONSIDERATIONS
6-61. There are several key employment guidelines for the aviation
commander to consider during the planning process. These guidelines are
preparation, specialty personnel augmentation, host nation requirements,
and ROE.
Preparation
6-62. The aviation brigade should expect a wide range in the tempo of
operations and plan accordingly. The staff must be able to adjust rapidly to
many different operational considerations. They must plan ahead and have
contingency plans for many situations not normally addressed in the unit's
METL. These situations can be identified and trained at home station. Some
subjects that should be addressed are civilians on the battlefield, media
relations, public affairs, and defense against terrorism.
6-12
Chapter Six
and plan operations. LNOs from the aviation brigade to other units and from
supporting units to the aviation brigade are critical.
Rules of Engagement
6-65. All commanders must clearly understand the ROE and be prepared for
them to change at any time during an operation. All personnel must be
briefed on the ROE before every mission. For ROE assistance, the
commander should consult with the SJA representative (Appendix N).
CATEGORIES OF OPERATIONS
6-66. During stability operations, the aviation brigade primarily performs its
METL-related tasks and remains prepared for the potential escalation to full
armed conflict. During support operations, it uses the capabilities of its
combat systems to increase the effectiveness of the overall effort. Again, the
aviation brigade must remain prepared for renewed hostilities or civil
disorder. Many of these missions will be performed as an integrated piece of
the overall U.S. military capability—often with forces from other nations,
other U.S. agencies, nongovernmental organizations, and United Nations
forces. Therefore, leaders should familiarize themselves with joint
operational procedures and terms.
STABILITY OPERATIONS
6-67. Combatant commanders employ ARFOR in stability operations outside
the U.S. and its territories to promote and protect U.S. national interests.
Stability operations are designed to influence the threat, political, and
information dimensions of the operational environment. They include
developmental, cooperative activities during peacetime and coercive actions
in response to crisis. Stability operations are normally nonlinear and often
conducted in noncontiguous AOs. There are ten types of stability operations
that have some potential to result in armed conflict. FM 3-0 (FM 100-5)
contains additional information.
PEACE OPERATIONS
6-68. PO encompass peacekeeping operations (PKO) and peace enforcement
operations (PEO) that are conducted to support diplomatic efforts to establish
and maintain peace.
6-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Peacekeeping Operations
6-69. PKO are undertaken with the consent of all major parties to a dispute.
They are designed to monitor and facilitate implementation of a cease-fire,
truce, or other such agreement, and support diplomatic efforts to reach long-
term political settlements. PKO usually involve observing, monitoring, or
supervising and assisting parties to a dispute. ARFOR use or threaten force
only in self-defense or as a last resort. Air and ground assets are frequently
employed in screening a demilitarized zone.
SECURITY ASSISTANCE
6-72. Security assistance refers to a group of programs that support U.S.
national interests and objectives by providing defense articles, military
training, and other defense-related services to foreign nations. Aviation units
may be required to provide transportation, training teams, and maintenance
support personnel. They may be called on to perform or assist in
humanitarian activities.
SUPPORT TO INSURGENCIES
6-74. When ordered, ARFOR support insurgencies that oppose regimes that
threaten U.S. interests or regional stability. While any ARFOR can be tasked
6-14
Chapter Six
COMBATTING TERRORISM
6-76. Terrorism is the calculated use of unlawful violence or threat of
unlawful violence to instill fear. ARFOR routinely conduct operations to deter
or defeat terrorist attacks. Offensively oriented operations are categorized as
counter-terrorism; defensively oriented operations are antiterrorism.
Counter-Terrorism
6-77. Counter-terrorism consists of offensive measures taken to prevent,
deter, or respond to terrorism. Actions include strikes and raids against
terrorist organizations and facilities outside the U.S. and its territories.
Counter-terrorism is a specified mission for selected SOF that operate under
direct control of the NCA or under a combatant command arrangement.
Commanders who employ conventional forces against organized terrorist
forces operating inside their AO are conducting conventional offensive
operations, not counter-terrorism operations.
Antiterrorism
6-78. Antiterrorism consists of defensive measures used to reduce the
vulnerability of individuals and property to terrorist attacks, to include
limited response and containment by local military forces. Antiterrorism is a
consideration for all forces during all types of military operations.
Commanders take the security measures necessary to accomplish the mission
and protect the force against terrorism. Soldiers are most vulnerable during
off-duty periods and in recreational locations. Soldiers and families who
reside outside protected installations are ideal targets for terrorists.
6-15
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
natural disaster. They may also include host nation citizens and third
country nationals. A ground or aviation unit may evacuate noncombatants.
The aviation brigade can conduct reconnaissance to help locate
noncombatants, identify clogged routes, and provide security for all stages of
their assembly and movement.
ARMS CONTROL
6-80. ARFOR normally conduct these operations to support arms control
treaties and enforcement agencies. The aviation brigade can help ground
forces in locate, seize, and destroy weapons of mass destruction. Other
actions include escorting deliveries of weapons and materials to preclude loss
or unauthorized use.
SHOW OF FORCE
6-81. Shows of force are conducted to bolster and reassure allies, deter
potential aggressors, and gain or increase influence. They are designed to
demonstrate a credible and specific threat to an aggressor or potential
aggressor. These operations usually involve the deployment or buildup of
forces, an increase in the readiness and activity of designated forces, or a
demonstration of operational capabilities by forces already in the region.
Although actual combat is not desired, shows of force can rapidly and
unexpectedly escalate. Typical aviation missions include area and route
security, screen, air assault rehearsals, and other tactical demonstrations.
SUPPORT OPERATIONS
6-82. Support operations use ARFOR to assist civil authorities, foreign and
domestic, as they prepare for or respond to crises and relieve suffering.
ARFOR provide essential support, services, assets, or specialized resources to
help civil authorities deal with situations beyond their capabilities. The
purpose of support operations is to meet the immediate needs of designated
groups for a limited time, until civil authorities can do so without Army
assistance. In extreme or exceptional cases, ARFOR may provide relief or
assistance directly to those in need. More commonly, they help civil
authorities or nongovernmental organizations provide support. Support
operations usually are nonlinear and noncontiguous. Support operations
within the U.S. and its territories are domestic support operations. Support
operations outside the U.S. and its territories are Foreign Humanitarian
Assistance.
6-16
Chapter Six
MISSION ANALYSIS
6-86. Perhaps the greatest obstacle for the commander to overcome in SASO
is defining the mission for the unit. When he receives the OPLAN, OPORD,
or implementing instruction (INPIN) mission analysis begins. The
commander must pay particular attention to limitations placed upon him by
the ROE or political considerations.
TASK ORGANIZATION
6-87. Task organization for SASO is METT-TC driven. The commander must
assess the aviation brigade's capabilities to determine if the task organization
can accomplish assigned missions. If not, the commander should modify the
organization.
COMMAND RELATIONSHIPS
6-88. It is critical that the command relationships for SASO be established
early. Elements of the aviation brigade may deploy for SASO without its
parent headquarters. It also is possible that the aircraft may work for
another service or U.S. nonmilitary agency, such as the DEA or the Federal
Bureau of Investigation (FBI). A clear understanding of the C2 relationship
helps reduce confusion and allows the unit to integrate with their controlling
headquarters early.
6-17
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
SPLIT-BASED OPERATIONS
6-90. The aviation brigade, or some of its elements, will often deploy on
SASO into a theater that has an immature logistics base. Logistics operations
may be conducted in theater from the unit's home station. This is termed
split-based operations. The commander who deploys on an operation that is
split-based must consider the type of support required from home station. He
must pay special attention to communications between the theater of
operations and the home station, and to the transportation means available
to provide a timely flow of logistics.
FORCE PROTECTION
6-91. Force protection is essential throughout SASO. Coordination for an
external security force should be accomplished before deployment to the AO.
A continually updated intelligence picture, coupled with aggressive local
patrolling, is an essential element of force protection.
RULES OF ENGAGEMENT
6-92. ROE are designed to control the application of force. ROE are prepared
and issued by higher headquarters. Commanders must clearly understand
the ROE and ensure that all the soldiers in the unit understand them. ROE
situations should be rehearsed in detail before deploying or executing a
mission. No situation should occur in which personnel are unsure whether
they should use force, and what types of force—to include deadly force—are
warranted (Appendix N).
6-18
Chapter 7
Combat Support
7-1. Intelligence enables the commander to see the battlefield and directly
influence the effectiveness of maneuver, FS, and force protection. The
aviation brigade relies on its higher headquarters for information other than
it receives from its own sources.
ENABLERS
7-2. Ground support radar, remote sensors, UAVs, or other MI assets may be
placed under OPCON or attached to the brigade to enhance reconnaissance
and security capabilities. The S2 incorporates these assets into the ISR plan
and recommends employment methods to the commander.
COUNTER-INTELLIGENCE
7-3. The essence of counter-intelligence (CI) is to support force protection. CI
are those actions that counter the hostile intelligence threat; safeguard the
command from surprise; deceive enemy commanders; and counter sabotage,
subversive, and terrorist activities. FM 2-01.2 (FM 34-60) contains more
information on CI.
ELECTRONIC WARFARE
7-4. EW employs electromagnetic and directed energy to control the
electromagnetic spectrum (EMS) or attack the enemy while retaining its use
for friendly forces. The S2 works with his higher headquarters counterpart to
accomplish offensive and defensive EW tasks. Appendix J addresses aircraft
survivability.
Electronic Attack
7-6. Electronic attack (formerly electronic countermeasures) is to use
jamming, electronic deception, or directed energy to degrade, exploit, or
destroy the enemy's use of the EMS. Electronic attack can attack the enemy
anywhere from their tactical formations to their national infrastructure.
7-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Electronic Protection
7-7. EP (formerly electronic counter-countermeasures) is protection of the
friendly use of the EMS. EP covers the gamut of personnel, equipment, and
facilities. For example, self- and area-protection systems can interfere with
the enemy's target acquisition and engagement systems to prevent
destruction of friendly systems and forces.
Electronic Support
7-8. ES (formerly electronic support measures) is conflict-related information
that involves actions tasked by or under the direct control of an operational
commander to search for, intercept, identify, and locate sources of intentional
and unintentional radiated electromagnetic energy to detect immediate
threats. ES is the embodiment of combat information and capitalizes on the
timelines of sensor-to shooter systems.
PLANNING
7-9. Fires are used to set the conditions for operations. The objective of
effects-based fires is to apply a desired effect to achieve a specified purpose
(shaping, protective, decisive). Fires may be used for many effects,
including—
• Suppression, neutralization, or destruction of forces.
• Isolation of forces.
• Slowing, canalizing, or interdicting enemy maneuver.
• Obscuration of the battlefield.
• Reduction of the effects of enemy artillery with counter-fire.
7-10. Two critical pieces that must be in place to effectively employ FA are
the fire plan and a quick-fire net.
PREPLANNED FIRES
7-11. Preplanned fires are for relatively known situations and target
locations, such as in deliberate attacks and air assaults. This fire plan is
distributed and rehearsed before execution. Preplanned fires use an H-Hour
sequence.
ON-CALL FIRES
7-12. On-call fires are used for unknown situations such as a movement to
contact, screen, and zone reconnaissance. The brigade coordinates fires for
battalions, and establishes priorities. Usually the FSO in the battalion
tactical CP (or S3 if no FSO is available), conducts calls for fire relayed by
scout or attack crews because these helicopters usually operate too low to
establish communication directly with the artillery. When direct
communication can be attained, scout and attack crews may call directly.
Direct contact with the FA must be previously coordinated in the plan or
cleared by the battalion tactical CP.
7-2
Chapter Seven
QUICK-FIRE NETS
7-14. The aviation brigade often does not have artillery in DS. Quick fire
nets provide a means to request and receive responsive fires. An artillery unit
is assigned the nonstandard mission to answer calls for fires from the
participating unit. The FSO establishes communications with the designated
FA TOC on the appropriate fire net. The artillery TOC monitors the net to
ensure the appropriate FA unit processes requested fire missions or provides
additional fires as required.
7-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
7-4
Chapter Seven
7-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
7-6
Chapter Seven
No-Fire Area
7-22. The no-fire area (NFA) is an area in which no fires or effects of fires are
allowed. Two exceptions are when establishing headquarters approves fires
temporarily within the NFA on a mission basis, and when the enemy force
within the NFA engages a friendly force, the commander may engage the
enemy to defend his force (Figure 7-6).
7-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
NONLETHAL EFFECTS
7-24. Nonlethal systems are discussed below.
7-25. Electronic attack and special IO are used to degrade, neutralize, or
destroy enemy C2. They include deception and computer network attack.
7-26. PSYOP influence enemy force behavior in support of U.S. national
interests and other information-related activities.
7-27. Civil affairs teams are used to influence relations between military
forces and civil authorities.
7-28. Public affairs teams provide media support according to the public
affairs information strategy and conduct media facilitation, as necessary.
Preplanned Requests
7-31. Preplanned requests permit detailed planning, integration, and
coordination with the ground tactical plan. Munitions can be tailored
precisely to the target, and complete mission planning can be accomplished.
The aviation brigade S3, FSO, and ALO review unit requests for suitability of
the target and potential airspace conflicts. As a minimum, they integrate the
request into the FS plan. The S3 may add the missions to other preplanned
requests, consolidate it with other requests, or assign it a priority. The
consolidated preplanned mission request is then forwarded to the higher
headquarters S3/G3 Air.
Immediate Requests
7-32. Immediate requests fulfill urgent, unforeseen requirements. Details of
the mission are generally coordinated while CAS aircraft are held on airstrip
alert or are airborne. The aviation brigade S3 and ALO evaluate the request
and pass it to higher headquarters.
7-8
Chapter Seven
The specific tactical situation and type CAS aircraft available dictate the
better option.
Capabilities
7-36. CAS capabilities include high-speed and long-range support, versatile
weapon/ammunition mixes, and accurate delivery. CAS pilots have an
excellent air-to-ground communications capability and can strike moving
targets. In addition, night CAS is available using AC-130 gunships that can
provide accurate support for extended periods.
Limitations
7-37. CAS aircraft are limited by resource scarcity, delivery restrictions
caused by limited visibility, adverse weather, or the proximity of friendly
forces. CAS flight restrictions caused by enemy ADs may impose delayed
response and short loiter times, or may limit reattack capabilities.
7-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
7-40. It is possible that the enemy occasionally will control some of the
airspace above the battlefield. Beyond its supporting AD systems, the
aviation brigade may have to contribute directly to the AD effort.
7-10
Chapter Seven
7-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
7-12
Chapter Seven
STATIONARY UNITS
7-53. Stationary units should take the following precautions:
• Occupy positions that offer cover and concealment.
• Immediately wipe out vehicle track marks leading to and around the
position.
• Ensure new tracks follow existing paths, roads, fences, or natural lines
in the terrain pattern.
• Avoid silhouetting vehicles against the skyline or against an area of a
different color.
• Post air guards in dismounted positions to provide warning of
approaching aircraft.
• Rotate air guards frequently because scanning for long periods dulls
visual perception.
• Disperse vehicles to make detection difficult, and to reduce the
possibility of multiple losses from a single engagement.
7-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
MOVING UNITS
7-54. Moving units should take the following precautions:
• Travel in open columns with 80 to 100 meters between vehicles.
Dispersion decreases target density and reduces the lethal effects of
enemy ordnance.
• Post air guards on vehicles to provide warning of approaching aircraft.
• Rotate air guards frequently because scanning for long periods dulls
visual perception.
• Maintain COMSEC.
• Use covered and concealed routes.
• If attacked, turn vehicles 90 degrees from the direction of attack.
• Limit movements to periods of limited visibility as much as possible.
• Use armed helicopters for convoy security.
7-55. The aviation brigade may receive engineer support for a specified
mission or time.
PLANNING CONSIDERATIONS
7-56. The senior engineer officer advises the commander about using
engineers and their equipment. When planning engineer support for tactical
operations, the commander should consider that engineers will accompany
lead ground elements and be employed as far forward as possible.
FUNCTIONS
7-57. Engineer units provide countermobility, survivability, and sustainment
support. Engineer support should be incorporated into the defense plan.
Engineer units can also perform infantry combat missions, if essential. FM 3-
34 (FM 5-100) contains detailed information about engineer combat
operations.
COUNTERMOBILITY SUPPORT
7-58. Part of the countermobility task is to disrupt attackers or turn them
into selected areas such as EAs. These operations canalize the enemy,
degrade their ground mobility, and increase their time in the killing zone.
7-14
Chapter Seven
SURVIVABILITY SUPPORT
7-59. Engineer survivability operations protect semifixed positions from
enemy observation and fires. Engineers provide this protection for CPs,
FARPs, maintenance, sleeping, and other facilities. They can also build
aircraft revetments and perimeter defenses.
7-61. The aviation brigade may find itself working with or in support of MPs,
particularly in SASO. MPs perform missions critical to the success of the
tactical commander's intent and concept of operation. They expedite
movement of combat resources on MSRs leading into rear areas, and patrol
their AO to protect critical locations and facilities. They evacuate enemy
prisoners of war (EPW) from forward areas and conduct law-and-order
operations. These services include investigating criminal offenses, performing
law enforcement operations, and confining U.S. military prisoners. FM 3-
19.10 [FM 19-10] discusses MPs.
BATTLEFIELD MISSIONS
7-62. The specific operations MPs perform at a given time are determined by
the tactical commander's needs and the availability of MP resources.
AREA SECURITY
7-64. MPs protect designated facilities, units, convoys, MSR critical points,
and people from enemy activity in the rear area. They also conduct area
reconnaissance to gather and document information about enemy activity.
7-15
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
GENERAL
7-70. PSYOP teams enable commanders to communicate information to large
audiences via radio, television, leaflets, loudspeakers, and internet-based
distribution (particularly in a SASO environment). They seek to demoralize
the enemy by causing dissention and unrest in their ranks, while at the same
time persuading the local population to support U.S. troops. PSYOP teams
are also provided with continuous analysis of the attitudes and behavior of
enemy forces so they can develop, produce, and employ information
communication successfully.
7-16
Chapter Seven
7-72. Civil affairs teams are the commander's link to the civil authorities in
the AO. They assist a host government in meeting its peoples' needs and in
maintaining a stable and viable civil administration.
GENERAL
7-73. Civil affairs specialists identify critical requirements of civilians in war
or disaster situations. They also can—
• Locate civil resources to support military operations.
• Help minimize civilian interference with operations.
• Support national assistance activities.
• Plan and execute noncombatant evacuation.
• Support counter-drug operations.
• Establish and maintain liaison or dialogue with civilian personnel
agencies, commercial organizations, and private organizations.
WEATHER TEAMS
7-76. Weather teams exist at brigade and higher echelons. Depending on the
echelon, teams consist of a staff officer with forecasters and observers. In
those instances where aviation elements are operating independent of the
aviation brigade, necessary coordination must be made to insure availability
of weather support for aviation operations.
7-17
Chapter 8
SECTION I – OVERVIEW
SUSTAINMENT IMPERATIVES
8-1. Operations and CSS are inextricably linked. Sustaining the battle
requires commanders and staffs to adhere to the following CSS
characteristics (FMs 3-0 [FM 100-5] and 4-0 [FM 100-10]):
• Responsiveness.
• Simplicity.
• Economy.
• Flexibility.
• Attainability.
• Sustainability.
• Survivability.
• Integration.
RESPONSIVENESS
8-2. Responsiveness is the key characteristic of CSS. It means providing the
right support in the right place at the right time, and the ability to meet
changing requirements on short notice. Logisticians anticipate events and
requirements by understanding the commander's plan and foreseeing events
as operations unfold. This involves forecasting and providing necessary on-
hand assets, capabilities, and information necessary to meet support
requirements. On the other hand, accumulating materiel and personnel
reserves to address every possible contingency wastes resources and may
deprive other units in need.
SIMPLICITY
8-3. Complexity should be avoided in the planning and execution of
maintenance and logistics operations. Mission orders, drills, rehearsals, and
SOPs contribute to simplicity.
ECONOMY
8-4. If not properly prioritized, resources may become limited. Commanders
prioritize resources according to mission requirements.
FLEXIBILITY
8-5. The key to flexibility lies in adapting available logistics structures and
procedures to changing situations, missions, and concepts of operations.
Improvised methods and support sources can maintain CSS continuity when
8-0
Chapter Eight
ATTAINABILITY
8-6. Attainability is procuring the minimum essential supplies and services
necessary to begin operations. Commanders determine minimum acceptable
levels of support and sustainment operations. This includes replenishment
actions to comply with authorized stockage lists (ASL) levels.
SUSTAINABILITY
8-7. Sustainability is maintaining continuous support during all phases of
campaigns and major operations.
SURVIVABILITY
8-8. Being able to protect support functions from destruction or degradation
contributes to survivability. Robust and redundant support contributes to
survivability, but may run counter to economy.
INTEGRATION
8-9. Integration consists of synchronizing CSS operations with all aspects of
tactical operations. Logistics units must be organized to execute fix forward
doctrine while giving the commander the greatest possible freedom of action.
FUNDAMENTALS OF SUPPORT
8-10. Units take advantage of host-nation resources through formal
agreements, pursue ad hoc measures, forage, and use captured materiel.
These factors are essential to the success of sustained operations.
8-11. Under the direction of the XO, the S1 and S4 coordinate supply,
maintenance, personnel support, and health service activities with the S3
and S2 to support combat operations. CSS operations are conducted primarily
through the HHC and AVIM companies. The brigade also depends on CSS
from DISCOM or COSCOM.
8-12. Priorities for CSS are based on the tactical plan. Effective
communications between aviation units, supporting staffs, and AVIM units
enable the support commander to emphasize the flow of supplies rather than
the buildup of stocks. Stockage of critical supplies near points of anticipated
consumption may be necessary to permit continued operations in case the
CSS system is disrupted, but such action should not impede the mobility of
the maneuver battalions. Constant and complete coordination is necessary to
ensure effective and integrated transportation support.
COMBAT MISSION
8-13. The combat mission is the foremost consideration. Maintenance,
supply, and other support elements must be far enough forward to be
immediately responsive to the requirements of maneuver units. Resources
and priorities must be tailored to changing combat situations.
8-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Offensive Operations
8-14. Maintenance support in offensive operations must enable maneuver
units to maintain the momentum. Maintenance managers prepare and
organize for offensive operations based on the particular type of operation to
be supported and the nature of the battlefield. Support of offensive operations
must provide—
• Forward positioning of prescribed load list (PLL) support package and
supplies.
• Maximum use of maintenance support teams (MST) in forward areas.
• Use of airlift and airdrop for resupply of PLL items and supplies.
• Adequate communications between supported and supporting units.
• Means to ensure that maintenance preparation for the offense does not
interfere with tactical plans and operations.
Defensive Operations
8-15. Maintenance managers work with tactical commanders to ensure they
can effectively support the wide range of operations available to the tactical
commander. Maintenance managers should—
• Make maximum use of MST to repair equipment as far forward as
possible.
• Ensure that PLL items and supplies in the forward main battle area
are adequate.
• Keep their units mobile.
• Ensure that downed aircraft recovery teams (DARTs) are formed to
remove disabled aircraft.
8-16. During tactical retrograde operations, efforts should be made to
establish maintenance elements in depth and rearward, to limit the flow of
maintenance repair parts and supplies forward to only the most combat-
essential elements, and to keep supply and evacuation routes open. Fallback
points along withdrawal routes are preplanned for evacuation of supplies and
equipment.
8-2
Chapter Eight
SUPPLY
8-19. Supply involves acquisition, management, receipt, storage, and issue of
all classes of supply except Class VIII. FM 3-04.500 (FM 1-500) gives more
details on supply operations. FM 3-04.500 (FM 1-500), FM 4-0 (FM 100-10),
JP 4-0, JP 4-03, and FM 4-20 (FM 10-1) contain additional information.
MAINTENANCE
8-20. Maintenance entails keeping materiel in operational condition,
returning it to service, or updating and upgrading its capability. It includes
performance of preventive maintenance checks and services (PMCS);
recovery and evacuation of disabled equipment; diagnosis of equipment
faults; substitution of parts, components, and assemblies; exchange of
serviceable materiel for unserviceable materiel; and repair of equipment. FM
3-04.500 (FM 1-500) gives more details on aviation maintenance operations.
FM 4-0 (FM 100-10) and FM 4-30.3 (FM 9-43-1) contain additional
information.
TRANSPORTATION
8-21. Transportation is movement and transfer of units, personnel,
equipment (including disabled vehicles and aircraft), and supplies to support
the concept of operation. It incorporates military, commercial, and supporting
nation capabilities. Transportation assets include motor, rail, air/water
modes and units; terminal units, activities, and infrastructure; and
movement control units, activities, and systems. FM 4-0 (FM 100-10) and JP
4-01 contain additional information.
8-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
FIELD SERVICES
8-24. Field services involve feeding, clothing, and providing personal
services. It encompasses clothing exchange, laundry, shower, textile repair,
mortuary affairs, aerial delivery, and food services. FM 4-0 (FM 100-10), FM
4-20 (FM 10-1), and JP 4-06 contain additional information.
PERSONNEL SUPPORT
8-26. Personnel support provides activities and functions to sustain manning
the force and personnel service support. It ensures that trained personnel in
the right quantities are available when and where they are required. It
involves personnel readiness management, replacement, and career
management; strength accounting; replacement operations; casualty
operations; postal operations; human relations programs; morale, welfare,
and recreation; and community support activities. FM 4-0 (FM 100-10),
FM 1-0 (FM 12-6), and JP 1-0 contain additional information.
LEGAL SUPPORT
8-28. Legal support provides operational law support in all legal disciplines
(including military justice, international law, contract and fiscal law,
administrative and civil law, claims, and legal assistance) to support the
command, control, and sustainment of operations. FM 4-0 (FM 100-10), and
FM 1-04.0 (FM 27-100) contain additional information.
RELIGIOUS SUPPORT
8-29. Religious support includes pastoral care, religious counseling, spiritual
fitness training and assessment, religious services of worship, and advising
the command on matters of religion, morals and ethics, and morale. FM 4-0
(FM 100-10), FM 1-05 (FM 16-1), and JP 1-05 contain additional information.
8-30. AR 710-2, Department of the Army Pamphlet (DA Pam) 710-2-1, and
DA Pam 710-2-2 address supply procedures and policies.
8-4
Chapter Eight
METHODS OF DISTRIBUTION
8-31. Supplying units distribute supplies to using units by different methods.
UNIT DISTRIBUTION
8-34. The supplying unit delivers supplies to the receiving unit.
THROUGHPUT
8-35. Shipments bypass one or more echelons in the supply chain to lessen
handling and speed delivery forward. Throughput is more responsive to the
needs of the user, is a more efficient use of transportation assets, and reduces
exposure to pilferage and damage.
8-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
8-6
Chapter Eight
8-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Basic Load
8-55. The basic load is the quantity of ammunition authorized by the theater
commander for wartime purposes and is required to be carried into combat by
a unit. The basic load provides the unit with enough ammunition to sustain
itself in combat until the unit can be resupplied.
CLASS VI
8-56. Class VI supplies may be made available through local procurement,
transfer from theater stocks, or requisitioning from the Army and Air Force
Exchange Service (AAFES). Available shipping space dictates Class VI
supply to the theater. Class VI items are personal care items, candy, and
other items for individual consumption. Health and comfort items (formally
referred to as ration supplement sundry packages) are class VI supply items
managed by the Defense Personnel Supply Center. They are issued through
the standard supply system (normally class I supply channels) without cost to
soldiers in the early stages of a deployment. They contain items such as
disposable razors, toothbrushes, toothpaste, and other personal care items.
Defense Logistics Agency (DLA) Regulation 4145.36 contains additional
information on these packages.
CLASS VII
8-57. Class VII supplies consist of major end items such as vehicles and
aircraft. Because of their importance to combat readiness and high costs,
Class VII items usually are controlled through command channels and
managed by the supporting MMC. Each echelon manages the requisition,
distribution, maintenance, and disposal of these items to ensure visibility and
operational readiness. Units report losses of major items through both supply
and command channels. Replacement requires coordination among materiel
managers, Class VII supply units, transporters, maintenance elements, and
personnel managers.
8-8
Chapter Eight
8-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
UNIT MAINTENANCE
8-65. The operator or crew and organizational maintenance personnel
perform unit maintenance that includes scheduled and unscheduled unit-
level maintenance, repair, and PMCS. PMCS maintains the operational
readiness of equipment through preventive maintenance and early diagnosis
of problems.
DIRECT SUPPORT
8-66. DS maintenance units are tailored to the weapons systems of the
supported unit. They provide extensive maintenance expertise, component
repair capabilities, and repair parts supply. This level of maintenance is
normally found in the maintenance company of the DASB, forward support
battalion (FSB), MSB of the DISCOM, and COSCOM maintenance units.
GENERAL SUPPORT
8-67. GS maintenance is characterized by extensive component repair
capability. It repairs damaged systems for issue through the supply system
as Class II, VII, or IX items. This level of maintenance normally is found at
theater Army level.
RECOVERY PRINCIPLES
8-69. The unit recovers its equipment. When it lacks the physical means to
recover an item, the unit requests assistance from the supporting
maintenance element. Management of recovery operations is centralized at
the battalion whenever possible.
8-70. Maintenance personnel repair equipment as far forward as possible
within the limits of the tactical situation, amount of damage, and available
resources. Recovery vehicles return equipment no farther to the rear than
necessary, usually to the maintenance collection point of the supporting
maintenance unit.
8-71. Recovery missions that might interfere with combat operations, or
compromise security, are coordinated with the tactical commander.
8-10
Chapter Eight
MANAGEMENT BALANCE
8-73. Balancing the flying-hour program, operational ready rates, and bank
hours is critical to meeting operational needs. Commanders and
MOs/technicians evaluate available resources using the T4-P4 concept (tools,
time, technology, training, problem, plan, people, parts) and adjust them
accordingly.
SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE
8-74. Commanders avoid situations that cause an excessive number of
aircraft to require scheduled maintenance at the same time, or in which
scheduled maintenance must be overflown. All imminent scheduled
maintenance should be accomplished before deployment or initiation of surge
operations.
UNSCHEDULED MAINTENANCE
8-75. Unscheduled maintenance is generated by premature or unexpected
malfunction, improper operation, or battlefield damage. Units must be
doctrinally and organizationally prepared to apply responsive corrective
action on an as-needed basis.
OTHER MEASURES
8-76. The supporting AVIM company can provide personnel augmentation at
the AVUM location during surge periods. TM 1–1500–328–23 addresses
deferred maintenance.
8-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
8-12
Chapter Eight
8-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
RESPONSIBILITY
8-89. The owning unit is responsibility for aircraft recovery. The unit should
use its AVUM assets within the limits of their capability. A successful
recovery operation is a highly coordinated effort between the owning
organization, its AVIM support, other supporting unit, and the ground
element where the operation is to take place. If the recovery is beyond the
AVUM team's capability, AVIM support is requested. Overall, control of the
recovery rests with the aviation brigade TOC.
RECOVERY TEAMS
8-90. The AVUM organization prepares for aircraft recovery contingencies by
designating a DART. The DART, as a minimum, includes a maintenance test
pilot, maintenance personnel, aircraft assessor, and technical inspector. The
technical inspector may also be the assessor. All members must be trained to
prepare aircraft for recovery as preparing aircraft for recovery is a unit
responsibility. The team chief ensures that rigging equipment and quick-fix
BDR kits (tools, hardware, POL products, repair parts, and technical
manuals) are kept ready for quick-notice recovery missions. The owning flight
company may be required to provide a crew chief to the DART. FM 3-04.513
(FM 1-513) contains a sample aircraft recovery and evacuation SOP.
8-14
Chapter Eight
• Assets available.
COURSES OF ACTION
8-92. The unit SOP provides guidance required to determine which of the
following actions is appropriate for the situation:
• Make combat repairs, defer further maintenance, or return the aircraft
to service.
• Make repairs for one-time flight, and fly the aircraft to an appropriate
maintenance area.
• Rig the aircraft for recovery (surface or aerial) and arrange for
transport.
• Selectively cannibalize, destroy, or abandon the aircraft according to
TM 750-244-1-5 and unit SOP.
AERIAL RECOVERY
8-93. General procedures typically are covered in unit SOPs. FM 3-04.513
(FM 1-513) provides detailed procedures for preparing and performing aerial
recovery operations for specific aircraft. FM 3-04.120 (FM 1-120) provides
doctrinal guidance on the requirements, procedures, and C2 tasks involved in
planning, coordinating, and executing the airspace control function. Unless a
battalion has attached or assigned UH-60s or CH-47s, it will have to request
them to conduct an aerial recovery.
Planning
8-94. Recovery operations and, to a lesser degree, maintenance evacuations,
can easily be detected and attacked by enemy forces. Plan command, control,
and coordination for recovery operations in advance. Recovery and evacuation
procedures must be included in unit SOPs, contingency plans, OPORDs, and
air mission briefings.
Special Environments
8-95. NBC decontamination of aircraft, equipment, and personnel should be
accomplished before delivery to the maintenance site, if possible. The
increased risk associated with night recovery operations, must be weighed
against the urgency to recover the aircraft, considering time, weather, the
need for security, and the tactical situation.
8-15
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
GENERAL
8-97. Commanders ensure that mission-required ALSE is on hand in
sufficient quantities, and that the equipment is in serviceable condition. To
meet the Army's demanding transformation requirements, newer and more
complex, integrated systems are being fielded. These systems demand better
maintenance planning, higher maintenance skills, and dedicated facilities.
8-98. Commanders are required to establish an ALSS maintenance
management and training program budget to meet resource requirements.
Funding for equipment, supplies, and repair parts is imperative. When
preparing the budget, review AR 95-1, CTAs 8-100, 50-900, 50-909, and
applicable MTOEs and TDAs.
8-16
Chapter Eight
8-17
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
8-18
Chapter Eight
received from SARSS-1. SAMS-1 has interfaces with other systems such as
ULLS and SARSS-O. It also provides completed work order data to the
LOGSA for equipment performance and other analyses.
SECTION IX – SAFETY
8-19
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
ACCIDENT CAUSES
8-118. An aviation accident is seldom caused by a single factor such as
human error or materiel failure. Accidents are more likely to result from a
series of contributing incidents. The following areas require constant
command attention to prevent aviation accidents:
• Human factors.
• Training, education, and promotion.
• Equipment design, adequacy, and supply.
• Normal and emergency procedures.
• Maintenance.
• Facilities and services.
• Environment.
8-119. The more complex aircraft have higher maintenance-related mishap
rates. Commanders and maintenance supervisors must ensure that their
personnel learn from maintenance errors generated in their own units.
Flightfax and other publications provide additional examples and
information. All personnel must strictly adhere to published maintenance
procedures and apply risk management at all levels of operations.
SAFETY REGULATIONS
8-120. AR 385-10 regulates overall safety. AR 385-95 regulates the Army
aviation accident prevention program. DA Pam 385-40 covers accident
investigation and reporting.
8-20
Chapter Eight
RESPONSIBILITIES
8-121. The quality assurance (QA) section has primary responsibility for
safety for all maintenance work performed on aircraft or their components.
However, everyone in the unit has responsibilities in the unit's maintenance
safety and aviation accident prevention programs. General responsibilities
for key personnel are outline below. Appendix A contains additional
information.
UNIT COMMANDER
8-122. Commanders ensure that all unit activities are conducted according to
established safety rules and regulations. These regulations include ARs 385-
40 and 385-95, DA Pam 385-40, and local directives. Commanders also
determine the cause of accidents and ensure that corrections are made to
prevent recurrence. When deviation from an established safety rule is
desired, commanders obtain permission from the appropriate higher
commander.
SUPERVISORS
8-123. Effective supervision is the key to accident prevention. Supervisors
must apply all established accident prevention measures in daily operations.
They should frequently brief subordinates on safety procedures, get their
suggestions for improving safety practices, and announce any new safety
procedures. Recommended agenda items are listed below.
• The overall job and expected results.
• The how, why, and when of the job, and any ideas from the group on
ways to improve methods and procedures.
• The part each person contributes.
• Existing and anticipated hazards, and the action needed to resolve
these problems.
• The need for prompt, accurate reporting of all injuries, accidents, or
near accidents.
• Basic first aid procedures, training, and readiness.
• The need to search constantly for, detect, and correct unsafe practices
and conditions to prevent accidents and injuries.
INDIVIDUALS
8-124. All personnel must be aware of the safety rules established for their
individual and collective protection. Each person must read and follow unit
SOPs, instructions, checklists, and other safety-related information. They
must report safety voids, hazards, and unsafe or incomplete procedures. Each
soldier must follow through until the problem is corrected.
SAFETY
8-125. The U.S. Army Safety Center (USASC) publication, Guide to Aviation
Resources Management for Aircraft Mishap Prevention, is one publication
that outlines safety procedures. Aviation Resource Management Surveys
(ARMS) Commander's Guide is available at the following worldwide web
8-21
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
8-22
Appendix A
Risk Management
Risk management is the process of identifying and controlling hazards to
protect the force. It is the Army’s principal risk-reduction process. The
intuitive management of risk in conducting military training and
operations is old, but its systematic application, as part of Army doctrine,
is relatively new. Therefore, this appendix presents a summary of how-to-
do-it information based on FM 5-0 (FM 101-5) and FM 5-19 (FM 100-14).
Note: Key risk management terms are defined at the end of this appendix.
APPLICATION
A-1. Risk management is applied to reduce the risk of the full range of
METT-TC hazards, including enemy action. It is integrated into the MDMP
as indicated in Figure A-1.
* FM 101-5 31 M ay 1997
A-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
RESPONSIBILITIES
A-2. Leaders at every echelon are responsible for risk management.
Commander
A-4. The commander has overall responsibility. The commander—
• Provides risk guidance.
• Selects hazard-control options.
• Makes the risk decision for COA.
• Enforces and evaluates controls.
Executive Officer
A-5. The XO has staff coordination responsibility. The XO—
• Supervises risk management integration across the entire staff.
• Ensures that hazard identification and controls are integrated into
plans and orders.
• Ensures that the staff monitors and enforces controls during
execution.
Staff Officers
A-6. Staff officers have responsibility in their own functional areas. Staff
officers—
• Identify hazards most likely to result in loss of combat power (that is,
hazards that are not adequately controlled).
• Develop control options that address reasons for hazards.
• Integrate hazard identification and selected controls into functional
area paragraphs, graphics, and annexes of the OPORD.
A-2
Appendix A
Implement Controls
Develop Controls &
Identify Hazards
Assess Hazards
Supervise &
Make Risk
Decisions
Evaluate
Troop Leading Steps
1. Receive Mission X
-Perform initial METT-T-C a nalysis X
2. Issue a warning order X
3. Make a tentative plan X X
a. Make an estimate of the situation X X
b. Conduct a detailed mission analysis X X
c. Develop situation and courses of action: X X
-Enemy situation ( enemy COA) X X
-Terrain and weather (OCOKA) X X
-Friendly situation (troops and time available) X X
-Course of action (friendly) X X
d. Analyze courses of action - war game X X
e. Compare courses of action X
f. Make decisions X
g. Expand selected COAs into a tentative plan X
4. Initiate movement X
5. Reconnoiter X
6. Complete the plan X
7. Issue the order X
8. Supervise and refine the plan X
A-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
IDENTIFY HAZARDS
A-10. Collect METT-TC factors for each COA for the mission or task (See
Figure A-4).
Sources
A-11. Sources include the following:
• Mission order/task instructions.
• CCIR.
• Mission planning systems.
• Tactical SOP.
• Unit accident history.
• Reconnaissance.
• Experience.
A-4
Appendix A
• MISSION:
- AIR ASSAULT INFANTRY PERSONNEL
- INSERT NLT 042100 SEP, ROVER BEACH LZ
- PREPARE TO EXTRACT NLT 042200 SEP, SAME LZ
• CONDITIONS
- ONE COMPANY UH-60, 2 CH-47s, 2 AH-64s
- LOAD: 14 FULLY EQUIPPED SOLDIERS, 540 POUNDS SPECIAL
EQUIPMENT
- BLACKOUT CONDITIONS
- LZ: 114 MILES FROM DEPARTURE POINT, 100 YARDS WIDE, SAND/
DIRT/GRASS
- WX: RESTRICTED VISIBILITY EN ROUTE AND AT LZ (ILLUMINATION,
RAIN, FOG, LOOSE SAND)
• SITUATION:
- CREW: FULLY QUALIFIED, EXPERIENCED, SUPERB TEAMWORK
- MISSION BRIEF AT 041530 SEP (CREW AND PERSONNEL)
Review Factors
A-12. Review METT-TC factors to identify hazards most likely to cause loss
of combat power. That is, identify those hazards that are not adequately
controlled at this or the next lower echelon of command. To do this, answer
the questions in the matrix below (Figure A-5) to determine if the hazard
needs to be risk managed.
Adequate
NO YES
Support - Is the type amount/capability/condition of
support adequate to control hazards?
- Personnel - Equipment and materials
- Supplies - Services/facilities
A-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
Record
A-13. Hazards determined to require risk management are identified to the
SO/NCO, who enters them in Block 5 on the worksheet.
ASSESS HAZARDS
A-14. Once a hazard has been identified, it must be evaluated for control.
Risk Level
A-15. Determine the risk level of each hazard that is not adequately
controlled. Use Figure A-6 and your best judgment to select the risk level.
Risk Level:
E - Extremely High
H - High HAZARD PROBABILITY
M - Moderate
L - Low Frequent Likely Occasional Seldom Unlikely
s Catastrophic E E H H M
e
v
e Critical E H H M L
r
i Marginal H M M L L
t
y Negligible M L L L L
Record
A-16. Provide the risk level for each hazard to the SO/NCO. The SO/NCO
enters this information in Block 6 of the risk management worksheet as the
initial risk level for each hazard (Figure A-7).
DEVELOP CONTROLS
A-17. Develop one or more controls to eliminate each hazard or to reduce its
level of risk. Controls should address the reasons that the hazard needs to be
risk managed. Provide controls to the SO/NCO, who enters them in Block 7 of
the risk management worksheet (Figure A-8).
A-6
Appendix A
Record
A-20. Provide the residual risk level for each hazard to the SO/NCO, who
enters it in Block 8 of the risk management worksheet (Figure A-10).
A-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
Risk Level:
E - Extremely High
H - High HAZARD PROBABILITY
M - Moderate
L - Low Frequent Likely Occasional Seldom Unlikely
s Catastrophic E E H H M
e
v
e Critical E H H M L
r
i Marginal H M M L L
t
y Negligible M L L L L
A-8
Appendix A
Report
A-24. SOs/NCOs present hazards, controls, and risks during commanders’
decision briefings. Risk management worksheets may be used for this
purpose.
A-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
Decision Process
A-26. Commanders select the COA and decide whether to accept the COA’s
risk level. They decide what level of residual risk they will accept and
approve control measures that will result in that level or a lower level of risk.
They obtain the higher commander’s approval to accept any level of residual
risk that might imperil the higher commander’s intent or is not consistent
with risk guidance. In Block 10, SOs/NCOs enter the name, rank, and duty
position of the commander accepting the COA’s risk level (Figure A-11).
IMPLEMENT CONTROLS
A-28. Based on the commander’s decision and risk guidance, the staff
determines how each control will be put into effect or communicated to the
personnel who will make it happen; for example, FRAGO, OPORD, SOP,
mission briefing, or rehearsals. SOs/NCOs enter this information in Block 11
of the risk management worksheet (Figure A-11). The staff coordinates
controls, integrates them into the FRAGO and/or appropriate paragraphs and
graphics of the OPORD, and confirms understanding by subordinate units
during the rehearsal.
SUPERVISE
A-29. The staff determines how each control will be monitored or enforced to
ensure that it is effectively implemented; for example, command presence,
direct supervision, precombat inspection, precombat checks, SITREP, spot
check, radio net monitoring, cross talk, and back brief. The staff provides
control supervision methods to the SO/NCO, who enters them in Block 12
(Figure A-12).
Evaluate Controls
A-31. Staff members evaluate the effectiveness of each control in reducing
the risk of the targeted hazard. They provide a “yes,” if effective, or “no,” if
not, to the SO/NCO, who enters this information in Block 13.
A-10
Appendix A
A-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
Ineffective Controls
A-32. For each control judged not effective, staff members determine why it
was not effective and what to do the next time the hazard is identified; for
example, change the control, develop a different control, or change the
method of implementation or supervision. They provide this information to
safety personnel, who report it during the AAR.
Report
A-33. The SO, with the safety NCO, evaluates the unit’s risk management
performance and reports during the AAR. The matrix below (Figure A-13)
may be used for this report.
A-12
Appendix A
GO NO-GO
Identified the most important hazards.
* Available facts for each METT-TC factor gathered and
considered.
* Hazard (enemy and accident) most likely to result in loss of
combat power identified?
Assessed risk level of each hazard.
* Valid method/tool used to assess initial risk levels?
Developed appropriate control options and determined residual risk.
* Each control addressed hazard reason(s)?
* Residual risk level realistic for each hazard?
* Valid method/tool used to determine the residual risk level
for each COA?
* Residual risk level for each COA entered on decision matrix?
Made risk decision for selected COA.
* Valid procedure/guidance used for determining risk decision
authority?
Hazards and controls clearly communicated to responsible unit/leadership.
* Controls integrated into appropriate paragraphs and graphics
of the OPORD/FRAGO and rehearsals?
Implemented and enforced controls.
* Effective methods used to supervise/enforce controls?
DEFINITIONS
A-34. The following terms are defined as they are used in the risk
management process.
CONDITIONS
A-35. Conditions are the readiness status of personnel and equipment with
respect to the operational environment during mission planning, preparation,
and execution. Readiness that is below standard leads to human error,
material failure, and inadequate precautions for environmental factors,
which may cause accidents, fratricide, and mission degradation.
CONTROLS
A-36. Controls are actions are taken to eliminate hazards or reduce their
risk.
HAZARD
A-37. A hazard is an actual or potential condition that can cause injury,
illness, or death of personnel; damage to or loss of equipment or property; or
mission degradation.
A-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
PROBABILITY
A-38. The levels of probability that an event will occur are the following:
• Frequent: Occurs often, continuously experienced.
• Likely: Occurs several times.
• Occasional: Occurs sporadically.
• Seldom: Unlikely, but could occur at some time.
• Unlikely: Can assume it will not occur.
RESIDUAL RISK
A-39. Residual risk is the level of risk remaining after controls have been
selected for hazards. (Controls are identified and selected until residual risk
is at an acceptable level or until it is impractical to reduce further.)
RISK
A-40. Risk level is the probability of exposure to injury or loss from a hazard
expressed in terms of hazard probability and severity.
RISK ASSESSMENT
A-41. Risk assessment is the identification and assessment of hazards (the
first two steps of the risk management process).
SEVERITY
A-42. The level of severity is the expected consequence of an event in terms
of degree of injury, property damage, or other mission-impairing factors.
These levels are the following:
• Catastrophic: Death or permanent total disability, system loss, major
damage, significant property damage, or mission failure.
• Critical: Permanent partial disability, temporary total disability
exceeding three months, major system damage, significant property
damage, or significant mission degradation.
• Marginal: Minor injury, lost workday accident, minor system damage,
minor property damage, or some mission degradation.
• Negligible: First aid or minor medical treatment, minor system
impairment, or little or no impact on mission accomplishment.
A-14
Appendix B
BENEFITS
B-2. The benefits of SOPs include the following:
• Simplified, concise combat orders.
• Enhanced understanding and teamwork among commanders, staffs,
and units.
• Established, synchronized staff drills.
• Established, abbreviated, or accelerated decision-making techniques.
RESPONSIBILITY
B-3. The S3, with input from other staff sections, is responsible for
preparing, coordinating, authenticating, publishing, and distributing the
command’s tactical SOP.
SIMPLICITY
B-5. Simple, easy-to-read and easy-to-execute procedures are critical to
tactical SOP application. Critical items of procedure should be presented in
as few words and graphics as possible. Task organization changes can occur
rapidly, but effective task organization requires each of the units attached or
placed under OPCON to be able to operate with efficiency. A 200-page SOP is
a daunting document to absorb when the unit is attached in the morning for
an operation that afternoon.
DOCTRINE
B-6. A tactical SOP cannot deviate from doctrine. The more a tactical SOP
parallels doctrine, the easier that it will be to learn and execute.
B-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
COMMONALITY
B-7. Standardization of tactical SOPs is essential within a division and
should probably extend to all units within a corps. Attack, assault, air
reconnaissance, GS, heavy helicopter, and even UAV units could have
difficulty operating together unless each unit operates from a common SOP.
That standardization effort should include reinforcing units and, especially,
reserve component units. Just as aviation units today conduct worldwide and
local standardization conferences for flight operations, units within a division
and a corps should consider conducting tactical SOP conferences to ensure
standardization of tactical procedures.
AVAILABILITY
B-8. With the growth of the Internet, SOP sharing and transmission of
tactical SOPs are easy. Many good tactical SOPs are available to provide a
base outline for units. The challenge is to develop and publish a standardized
tactical SOP within the division and the corps.
TRAINING
B-9. No tactical SOP will produce the desired results unless it is constantly
reviewed and tested. The tactical SOP should be a topic in every pilot’s
briefing. The tactical SOP should also be a point of discussion in every
OPORD and plan—and during every tactical exercise after-action review.
Standardized and internalized tactical SOPs make training easier to
supervise and execute while making battles less costly to win.
B-2
Appendix C
Deployment
SECTION I – DEPLOYMENT FUNDAMENTALS
GENERAL
C-1. This appendix addresses deployment of ground vehicles, equipment, and
aircraft. The capability to quickly deploy aviation assets from CONUS or
forward-deployment sites to another theater is an important aspect of U.S.
forces’ rapid deployment. Units that plan, train, and validate their movement
plans greatly increase their chances for success.
C-2. Units may be required to move from any location to railheads, seaports
of embarkation (SPOE), or aerial ports of embarkation (APOE) from which
they will be transported to the theater of operations. Movement to the SPOE
or APOE may involve a combination of modes. Aircraft are generally flown to
the port. Vehicles, depending on distance, may convoy or be shipped via rail.
C-3. Units also must be prepared to self-deploy aircraft, limited personnel,
and selected equipment to almost anywhere in the world.
COMMANDER
C-4. The commander is responsible for unit movement. He directs
preparation of SOPs, movement orders, and load plans. He validates SOPs
and orders through periodic training exercises.
C-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
C-2
Appendix C
MOVEMENT
C-13. Upon receiving the order, units ferry their aircraft and move ground
vehicles along preselected routes to the POE. Units that can perform depot-
level maintenance normally operate at these embarkation points. As the
units arrive, a dedicated depot support team assists in preparing the vehicles,
equipment, and aircraft for deployment. Preparation includes required
maintenance and installation of ferry equipment.
C-14. Air and sea deployment modes terminate at aerial and sea ports of
debarkation (APOD/SPOD). Depot or AVIM facilities should be available
there or elsewhere in the theater. Personnel at these facilities remove ferry
equipment, install mission equipment, and perform required maintenance
and inspections to prepare the equipment for the mission. They also
coordinate the immediate backhaul of designated support teams and ferry
equipment. On receipt of the deployment order, AVIM commanders dispatch
preselected facility teams. Deployment headquarters staff members should
locate command facilities at each termination site to facilitate the integration
of aircraft, vehicles, and personnel into the theater force structure.
TASK ORGANIZATION
C-15. Arriving elements task organize and reconfigure vehicles and aircraft
as appropriate for the mission. CSS efforts are prioritized to build combat-
capable units and C4I architecture.
FORCE PROTECTION
C-16. Aviation forces are particularly vulnerable during the buildup phase
when the unit is not at full strength and aircraft and vehicles may not be
fully assembled for combat. The security plan must be understood and
executed from the moment that the first unit arrives. This plan should
include passive and active measures to combat air and ground threats.
C-17. Aviation forces often are among the first units to arrive in theater.
They may have to provide reconnaissance, security, and attack operations to
secure a lodgment before more forces arrive in theater. This situation may
require aviation units to conduct immediate and continuous operations from
offshore or remote locations while the main body moves into the lodgment
area.
C-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
TRAINING
C-19. Local area orientations, test flights, or other requirements that could
not be executed in advance may be required. Commanders should attempt to
phase the arrival of personnel—such as instructor pilots, test pilots, and key
leaders—to begin before the entire unit arrives. If units are already present
in country, these key personnel should deploy as early as possible to train
with those units. The advance party should be briefed on these requirements
and the plan for their execution so that they can identify and coordinate
required external support.
C-20. Acclimation training may be required. Many units that move from one
environmental extreme to another need a period of adjustment to the new
climate. The unit commander or S3 should arrange training and conditioning
to accelerate acclimation.
C-21. Most deployments will involve operating in a joint or multinational
environment. Early-arriving units may be able to schedule training with
other services. Liaison elements should be designated to ensure smooth
coordination.
GENERAL
C-22. Self-deployment is an alternative method to rapidly move aircraft. AH-
64, UH-60, and CH-47D helicopters with auxiliary tanks can carry enough
usable fuel to self-deploy to many locations.
C-23. Commanders should avoid self-deployment over large bodies of water
except in an emergency when other methods are not available. This method is
risky because aircrews face the challenge of a possible ditching at sea.
C-24. Units should not plan to deploy combat troops on self-deploying
aircraft. Available space is typically used to accommodate those supplies,
tools, parts, survival equipment, and limited support personnel necessary to
make the flights self-sustaining during the deployment.
C-25. Configuring some aircraft to self-deploy long distances may require
alternate transport of some weapons systems, equipment, and baggage.
Maintenance and armament personnel must reconfigure these aircraft before
the unit can commit them to combat.
C-26. The commander, with the S3 and SO, develops a preaccident
contingency plan before self-deployment. The S1 identifies available medical
treatment facilities along the route and advises the S3.
C-27. Unit staff members plan procedures for downed aircrew and aircraft
recovery.
C-4
Appendix C
C-28. Staff members conduct risk analysis and consider alternatives. For
extensive legs of flight over water, plans should include Naval assets along
the flight route to provide intermediate fuel stops or SAR.
C-29. Ground support teams should be prepositioned at stopover points along
self-deployment flight routes. Ground support teams include personnel,
equipment, and repair parts to provide limited services. These services
include POL products, supply, health service support, communications,
weather forecasting, and flight planning.
PERSONNEL
C-30. Aircrews and passengers may require passports and visas for each
country of intended landing. The mission may require crew members or other
support personnel with specific foreign language proficiency for those
countries in which refueling or extended stopovers are planned.
C-31. Extensive distances may require aircrews to fly many hours. The
challenge is to ensure that crews are able to fight when they arrive in
theater. Commanders should adjust work and rest schedules before and
during deployment. Commanders must plan to rotate crews through pilot
duties whenever possible. Deploying units could carry backup crews from
nondeploying units on CH-47 and UH-60 aircraft.
INTELLIGENCE
C-32. S2s obtain threat intelligence information about those countries that
are overflown and those where landings are planned. Terrorist threats,
counterintelligence, and specific force protection concerns are important to
aircrews for planned and potential stops.
TRAINING
C-33. Commanders should place emphasis on predeployment training
including sea survival, fuel system management, high gross-weight
operations, route flight checks, International Civil Aviation Organization
(ICAO) flight planning, navigation equipment, communication requirements,
shipboard operations, and rescue operations.
C-34. En route and destination environmental considerations—such as high
altitude, mountainous and jungle terrain, and over-water flight—are
considered. Crews must be trained for survival in the environment and the
use of special equipment required for each environment.
C-35. Theater-specific ROE, status of forces agreements (SOFAs), local
customs, language training, and OPSEC requirements that can be
anticipated should be performed at home station, if possible.
LOGISTICS
C-36. Self-deploying and supporting units request and coordinate
maintenance and crew-rest facilities, fuel, transportation, security, and
messing for stopover-point teams and self-deploying aircrews. If U.S. ground
support teams are not available, units coordinate with friendly nations to
C-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
provide the required services. The S5 is the point of contact for staff officers
who deal with host nations. If no S5 is assigned, the S3 performs this
function.
C-37. When aviation units deploy to destinations lacking fixed-base facilities,
prepositioned ground support teams perform those functions. S4s of self-
deploying and supporting units are responsible for logistics requirements
along the self-deployment route. Aviation maintenance officers organize a
maintenance support operation to prepare aircraft for self-deployment and to
meet maintenance requirements along the route.
C-38. Staff members verify availability and quantity of fuel at en route fuel
stops, rather than depending solely on Department of Defense Flight
Information Publications (DOD FLIP). An appropriate agency verifies fuel
quality at each location before refueling.
C-39. Contracting officers or Class A agents, if required at stopover sites,
should be in the advance party.
C-40. The unit should issue appropriate survival equipment and clothing for
the climate that it expects to encounter.
C-41. To facilitate mission readiness, movement planners, logisticians, and
maintenance personnel carefully war game the arrival of units and
equipment into the theater.
C-6
Appendix C
COMMUNICATIONS
C-47. Units—
• Must coordinate frequencies for internal flight following throughout
the trip.
• Must coordinate and verify compatibility of specific frequencies for
supporting Naval vessels and SAR elements.
• Take SATCOM sets if available; SATCOM enables each flight to
communicate its status to home station and the theater of operations.
EQUIPMENT
C-48. Survival vests, rafts, hot-cold-weather survival kits, rescue hoists,
survival radios, food, and water are essential mission equipment.
C-49. Each flight should have multiple aircraft with extra survival
equipment that can be dropped to downed crew members.
WEAPONS
C-50. Individual and crew-served weapons should normally remain out of
sight during flight and ground operations.
C-51. The controlling headquarters issues ROE when deploying units carry
weapons and ammunition.
C-52. Aircraft equipped with ferry tanks can self-deploy over long distances.
The following Atlantic routes (Figures C1 through C3) support general
planning. Additional stopover points, land or sea based, may be required
because of variables. Coordination of friendly ships with landing and
refueling capability may allow less deviation. There are no published Pacific
routes.
C-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
C-8
Appendix D
GENERAL
D-1. An AA is a location where units prepare for future operations, issue
orders, perform maintenance, and accomplish resupply. Aviation unit AAs
may vary from fixed-base airfields to remote field sites. Regardless of the
type of AA that the unit occupies, the commander and staff adhere to certain
principles to ensure unit survivability. AAs usually locate in the corps or
division rear area or near the higher headquarters AA. Aviation AAs usually
locate out of the range of enemy medium artillery and are large enough to
adequately disperse subordinate units.
ASSEMBLY AREAS
D-2. The AA security and maintenance of OPTEMPO must be balanced. It is
very difficult for aviation units to secure their own AAs and maintain high
OPTEMPOs; therefore, additional security must be requested from higher
headquarters. An AA must provide—
• Security through location, self-defense, and integration into defensive
schemes of adjacent units.
• Concealment for aircraft.
• Cover and concealment for ground elements.
• Accessibility to adequate roads and MSR.
• Proximity to friendly units to assist communications, coordination,
and logistics.
• Suitable ground and aircraft ingress/egress routes.
• Distance from projected enemy avenues of approach.
D-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
locate in the FAA. Considerations for selecting FAAs are the same as for
selecting AAs. The FAA should locate out of range of enemy medium artillery.
EXECUTIVE OFFICER
D-7. The XO performs the following AA duties:
• Establishes timelines for AA moves.
• Develops triggers, based upon a DST, that cue the need to displace the
AA.
• Rehearses AA occupation and movement.
OPERATIONS OFFICER
D-8. The S3 performs the following AA duties:
• Selects future main CP sites.
• Selects site for the TOC within the main CP.
• Coordinates ISR plan development with the S2.
• Establishes a jump, or temporary, TOC, if necessary, until the TOC is
established at the main CP site.
• Develops plans and orders for moving to the AA.
• Plans air routes and coordinates A2C2 for air routes to the new AA.
• Plans fires supporting the AA move.
• Develops plans to reconnoiter movement routes and new AA location.
• Plans and requests support, if necessary, for MEDEVAC assets to
assist during the move.
• Coordinates with higher or adjacent units for land to establish the AA
and integrates into their defensive plans.
• Requests engineer support to assist in AA improvement.
• Coordinates and requests AD support for the AA.
INTELLIGENCE OFFICER
D-9. The S2 performs the following AA duties:
• Develops an event template and the DST for the AA, resulting in DPs
necessary to plan and execute AA displacement.
• Develops NAI near the AA.
• Develops the ISR plan, with the S3, for the AA.
D-2
Appendix D
LOGISTICS OFFICER
D-10. The S4 performs the following AA duties:
• Develops march tables for the vehicle convoy to the new AA.
• Selects the location for the ALOC.
COMMUNICATIONS-ELECTRONICS OFFICER
D-11. The S6 performs the following AA duties:
• Analyzes potential AA sites and determines their suitability in terms
of providing communications for the task force.
• Establishes a retransmission site, if required, to assist during unit
moves.
• Analyzes potential AAs for their proximity to MSE nodes.
D-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
ROUTE RECONNAISSANCE
D-15. Units conduct a route reconnaissance of convoy routes before the
quartering party moves to the new AA location. Commanders may conduct
separate reconnaissance using aircraft or vehicles or both or may reconnoiter
concurrently just in front of the convoy. The purpose of this reconnaissance:
• Verifies the suitability of the convoy route.
• Locates areas along the route that could delay the convoy.
• Determines how much traffic is on the route.
• Looks for potential enemy ambush sites along the route or evidence of
enemy activity.
AREA RECONNAISSANCE
D-16. The unit accomplishes an area reconnaissance of the AA location and
the surrounding terrain as soon as possible after selecting the AA site. The
unit conducts this area reconnaissance by air or ground or both. If conducting
the reconnaissance by air, aircrews should land and allow the reconnaissance
party to physically walk and observe the layout of the terrain. Items to look
for include suitability of the area’s size and slope and vehicle accessibility
from a ground stability and drainage standpoint. The commander considers
an NBC survey and examines defensibility of the site to include available
cover and concealment for ground elements, fields of fire, dead zones, and
likely enemy infiltration and attack routes. Look for ground units operating
nearby to ascertain whether ground tracked vehicles may transit through the
area selected.
AREA RECONNAISSANCE
D-18. The reconnaissance element conducts an initial area reconnaissance
(including NBC survey, if appropriate) of the FAA and the surrounding
terrain. Upon completion, the reconnaissance element briefs the commander
or S3 and keeps the new position under constant observation until the main
body arrives.
D-4
Appendix D
SECURITY
D-20. Security of the FAA depends on the unit’s capability to detect threats
and move aircraft to another location before being attacked. After
establishing FAA security, aircrews complete thorough aircraft preflight
inspection and prepare for rapid departure by going through checklists
leading up to engine start. The priority of tasks for each unit is to—
• Establish local security.
• Establish wire communications with the tactical CP.
• Prepare aircraft for immediate launch.
• Continue to plan missions.
SECURITY
D-23. Initially, security may consist of establishing OPs along likely avenues
of approach in a position to maintain overwatch of the AA. Therefore, the size
of the quartering party must support initial security requirements.
ADVANCE PARTY
D-24. The quartering party guides the advance party into its new locations.
The advance party then—
• Enhances local security.
• Establishes additional OPs and a dismount point.
• Establishes communications with the TOC in the AA.
• Determines locations of the TOC, ALOC, unit elements, and FARP.
D-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
GROUND ARRIVAL
D-26. Members of the advance party meet the ground vehicles as they arrive.
The advance party guides ground vehicles along selected routes to each unit’s
position. The following are the priority of tasks upon main body closure.
Establish Security
D-27. The type and amount of security depend on the factors of METT-TC
and may range from establishing OPs along most likely avenues of approach
to full perimeter security.
AIR ARRIVAL
D-31. Aircraft arrive after the ground segments of the battalion main body.
During AA movement, the brigade maintains communications with
D-6
Appendix D
OBSTACLES
D-34. Units block with obstacles and cover with overlapping fields of fire any
nonessential roads leading into the AA. Obstacles may be natural or man-
made. Battalions coordinate with the brigade for engineer assistance in
planning, preparing, executing, and completing tasks in defense of the AA.
Engineer support can construct, repair, and maintain tactical obstacles,
defensive positions, and logistics field sites. Units must exploit naturally
protected positions for CPs, aircraft parking, FARPs, and maintenance
facilities.
FIGHTING POSITIONS
D-35. The battalions and companies establish crew-served weapon fighting
positions to cover most likely enemy avenues of approach. Personnel
occupying these positions have a key role in securing the AA.
OBSERVATIONS POSTS
D-36. The battalions may establish OPs to provide early warning of anyone
approaching the AA. Units place OPs along the most likely enemy avenues of
approach and far enough away from the AA to provide adequate warning of
impending attack. The OP must maintain communications with the TOC.
DISMOUNT POINT
D-37. The battalions establish dismount points to control the flow of traffic
in the AA. The battalions block other roads into the AA with downed trees
and parked vehicles or berms if engineer support is available. The dismount
point controls traffic flow in and out of the AA and makes suspect any vehicle
that approaches on other than established AA routes to the dismount point.
D-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
INDIRECT FIRE
D-38. The battalions plan indirect fires near the AA. Units plan final
protective fires to protect the task force during displacements caused by
enemy attack. OPs may also be responsible for FS targets within their area.
When planning AA indirect fires, the commander develops an observer plan.
SURPRISE DISPLACEMENT
D-42. In case of surprise attack, units may conduct immediate displacement.
Aircraft depart individually if the situation allows. For survivability, flight
crews may remain in individual fighting or survivability positions until the
immediate threat passes before executing the displacement. After departing
the AA, aircrews fly to designated HAs or rally points, conduct a
reconnaissance, establish security, establish communications with the TOC
or command group, and transmit a situation report to the commander.
D-8
Appendix D
may be able to evacuate in the fog by hovering along known roads. Aircraft
gun systems can defend against the attack if hover in the AA is possible.
D-48. Aviation units may need to move long distances to position for future
operations. Both brigade and battalions plan this type of movement, called a
road march. The main purpose of the road march is to relocate rapidly. Units
conduct road marches at fixed speeds and timed intervals. This section
examines tactical procedures and considerations for the road march.
OPEN COLUMN
D-50. Units use the open column technique for daylight marches and at
night with blackout lights or night-vision devices. Distance between vehicles
varies, normally 50 to 200 meters, depending on light, dust, and weather
conditions.
D-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
CLOSE COLUMN
D-51. Units use the close column technique for marches during limited
visibility. Units base the distance between vehicles on the ability to see the
vehicle ahead. This distance is normally less than 50 meters, requiring
slower speeds.
INFILTRATION
D-52. The infiltration technique involves moving small groups of personnel
and vehicles at irregular intervals along multiple routes. Units use this
technique when available time and routes allow units to maximize security,
deception, and dispersion. Of the three road-march techniques, infiltration
provides the best possible passive defense against enemy observation and
detection. It also increases likelihood of lost vehicles and slows closure at new
AAs.
PLANNING CONSIDERATIONS
D-53. Standard tasks that the unit commander (and subordinate leaders, as
necessary) may perform before a tactical road march include the following:
• Designate marshalling areas, as required, to organize the march
column and conduct final inspection/briefing; well-trained units with
good SOPs can move directly from AA positions into march formation.
• Conduct a METT-TC analysis to determine the enemy situation,
including the probability of air or ground attack.
• Establish detailed security measures.
• Designate movement routes, including the start point, required
checkpoints, and the RP; establish additional control measures to
identify critical areas, possible ambush and choke points, and
rest/maintenance stops.
• Organize, brief, and dispatch the quartering party.
• Specify march speed, movement formations, vehicle and serial
intervals, catch-up speed, lighting, and times of critical events.
• Plan indirect FS and contingency actions, and rehearse actions on
contact; contingency plans should cover vehicle breakdowns, lost
vehicles, and accidents.
• Coordinate for CSS, including refueling, mess operations, vehicle
recovery, local police assistance, and medical evacuation.
QUARTERING PARTY
D-54. The unit’s quartering party precedes the unit into a new AA.
Dispatched before the main body departs, the quartering party is responsible
for reconnoitering the route of march. It conducts reconnaissance of the AA
and the feeder route from the RP to the proposed AA. If either the route or
AA proves unsatisfactory, the quartering party recommends changes to the
commander.
D-55. Once the road march begins, quartering party members serve as
guides along the feeder route and in the AA. The unit SOP outlines the
D-10
Appendix D
party’s size and composition, but specific tactical requirements may dictate
changes.
CONTROL MEASURES
D-56. Commanders use road-march control measures to assist unit control.
GRAPHICS
D-57. Road-march graphics show the start point, RP, and route.
Characteristics and other graphics may include the following:
• Marshalling areas are where the quartering party and main body can
organize march columns and conduct final inspections/briefings.
• The start point represents the beginning of the road march route
(easily recognizable man-made or terrain feature).
• The start point is far enough away from the unit’s initial position to
allow individual elements to organize into march formation at the
appropriate speed and interval.
• The time required to move to the start point is in the movement order.
• The route is the path of travel connecting the start point and RP.
• The RP marks the end of the route of march (an easy-to-recognize
man-made or terrain feature). Elements do not halt at the RP; they
continue to their AA with assistance from guides, waypoints, or other
graphic-control measures.
CRITICAL POINTS
D-58. Critical points are established where terrain or other factors may
hinder movement or where timing is critical. The start point, RP, and
checkpoints are critical points.
STRIP MAPS
D-59. Units use strip maps to assist navigation. Units—
• Include the start point, RP, checkpoints, marshalling areas, and
refuel-on-the-move (ROM) sites and distances between these points.
• Use detailed sketches showing marshalling areas, scheduled halt
locations, ROM sites, and other potentially confusing places.
• Include strip maps as an annex to the movement order; if possible,
provide a copy to all vehicle drivers.
VISUAL SIGNALS
D-60. When observing radio listening silence during a road march, units
employ hand-and-arm signals, flags, and lights as primary means of passing
messages between vehicles and between moving units.
TRAFFIC CONTROL
D-61. The headquarters controlling the march may post road guides and
traffic signs at designated traffic control points. At critical points, guides
assist in creating a smooth flow of traffic along the march route. MP or
D-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
organic personnel designated from the quartering party may serve as guides.
They should have equipment or markers that allow march elements to
identify them in the dark or other limited-visibility conditions.
RELEASE POINT
D-62. There is normally an RP for every echelon of command conducting the
road march. For instance, there will be a battalion RP, followed by a company
RP. Rehearse actions at the RP to reduce traffic problems.
HALTS
D-65. While taking part in a road march, battalions prepare to conduct both
scheduled and unscheduled halts.
Scheduled Halts
D-66. Units conduct scheduled halts to permit maintenance, refueling, and
personal relief activities and to allow other traffic to pass. Units establish the
time and duration of scheduled halts in the movement order. The unit SOP
specifies actions to be taken during halts. Units make a 15-minute
maintenance halt after the first hour of the march, with 10-minute halts
every two hours thereafter.
D-67. In combat, the first halt priority is to establish and maintain local
security. March leaders may plan scheduled halts to secure potential ambush
sites if prior reconnaissance and known threat activity cause leaders to
suspect that an ambush could occur at a particular location. This action may
involve actual dismounting to secure overwatching terrain, alerting vehicle
personnel to orient weapons on particular areas as the convoy passes, and
sending vehicles through the area in smaller groups.
D-68. During peacetime administrative marches, the first halt priority is
safety. Even combat marches must consider that accidents may cause more
D-12
Appendix D
casualties than combat action during the march. March leaders plan halt
locations that safeguard personnel and vehicles from traffic and threats.
Refueling Halts
D-69. During long marches, units may conduct ROM operations. The ROM
site composition depends on both OPSEC considerations and refueling
capability of ROM site assets. The OPORD must specify the amount of fuel or
time at the pump for each vehicle. It also outlines instructions for OPSEC at
the ROM site and at staging areas where vehicles move after refueling.
Unscheduled Halts
D-70. Units make unscheduled halts if they encounter unexpected obstacles,
contaminated areas, or disabled vehicles blocking the route. As unscheduled
halts occur in combat, units dismount and establish security and don NBC
protective equipment if applicable. In administrative movements, safety is
paramount. Units train drivers to pull off the road, if possible, and instruct
all but designated personnel to remain in vehicles. Drivers instruct one
messenger to carefully dismount and move to the front of the convoy away
from any traffic. The messenger obtains or provides information on the
reason for the halt and receives directions from the march leader. The march
leader determines and eliminates the cause of the halt.
Disabled Vehicle
D-71. Units must not allow disabled vehicles to obstruct traffic for lengthy
periods. Train drivers to move the vehicle off the road as problems develop.
Trail elements take charge to assist disabled vehicles, report the problem,
establish security, and post guides to direct traffic. If possible, they make
repairs and rejoin the rear of the column later. Vehicles that drop out of the
column return to their original positions only after the column halts. Until
then, they move just ahead of the trail element, which usually comprises the
maintenance team and some type of security. If the crew cannot repair the
vehicle, the trail element wrecker recovers the vehicle.
HALT SECURITY
D-72. Halt security normally involves dispersing vehicles, establishing a
close-in perimeter, and securing terrain that dominates the march halt.
D-13
Appendix E
Communications
This appendix outlines the communication tools and generalized TTP to
ensure effective C2 of aviation ground and flight operations. Chapter 3
provides additional detail on C2 issues.
E-0
Appendix E
SINCGARS and other radio systems. The combat training centers have noted
common problems with time drift and the need to perform over-the-air
rekeying as missions progress.
HAVE QUICK II
E-6. The AN/ARC-164 is a common UHF-AM radio employed by joint
aircraft. It provides aviation brigade subordinate units with a means of
communicating internally on company battle nets. It also allows interface
with sister-service aircraft during JAAT and other joint flight operations. Its
frequency-hopping mode of operation counters enemy jamming efforts. Like
SINCGARS, it is a LOS system with limited range at terrain flight altitudes.
E-7. The AMPS, when available, provides simplified setup of Have Quick II
time of day (TOD) and word of day (WOD) for AH-64D and OH-58D aircraft.
E-8. Units must use Have Quick II in the frequency-hopping mode during
training to ensure effective communication during actual operations. WOD
loading is not difficult, but TOD can be problematic if aircraft lack a Have
Quick II/GPS interface. Aircraft without GPS interface can request and
accept a GPS TOD from other unit aircraft. In addition, on long operations
beyond four hours, the TOD begins to drift. A single aircraft, such as the UH-
60 C2 aircraft, are then designated as the base point for TOD updates as unit
aircraft begin to drop out of the net because of drifting TOD.
E-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
E-13. Secure voice is the primary method of operation for the HF radio in
ALE, manual, and frequency-hopping modes. In poor conditions—such as low
magnetic flux number, night operations when the ionosphere dissipates, and
thunderstorms—aircrews should employ secure data at 300 bits per second.
Data transmission increases aircrew workload during flight; the radio stores
up to 10 messages in memory, allowing the crew to preload a set of
anticipated messages before flight.
E-14. For identical messages with changing location, it often is easier to edit
in the new location in an existing memory message than to initiate a whole
new entry. In addition, a reduced workload results when commanders use the
control display unit’s feature permitting HF transmittal of current position
with one button press.
E-15. If brigade units have not used HF radios habitually in training before
operations, the brigade S3 should direct HF radio exercises before operations
to ensure that units use HF to its best advantage.
E-2
Appendix E
E-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
2
Figure E-1. UH-60 C Aircraft Configuration
AIRBORNE RELAY
E-23. Some operations in deep areas have the priority to justify
communications relay as a means of overcoming difficulty in communicating.
If allocated, the C-12 may perform HF relay or even SINCGARS and Have
Quick II relay if the threat permits flight within range of those radio systems.
The AWACS, E-8 JSTARS, C-130 airborne battlefield C2 center, EA-6,
airborne forward air controllers, participating deep JAAT and air
interdiction, or other joint aircraft may be available to relay HF, Have Quick
II, and in some cases, SINCGARS communications. Enhanced Position
Location Reporting System (EPLRS) capabilities on the A2C2S aircraft allow
automated relay of data communications. In addition, future UAVs may have
retransmit mission capabilities for FM command nets. Table E-1 illustrates
the potential for relay with higher-flying aircraft if coordinated by staff
members in advance.
E-4
Appendix E
JSTARS
AWACS
ABCCC
EA-6B
C-130
JAAT
COMMS/
E-8C
C-12
UAV
FAC
E-3
AI/
RELAY CAPABLE
SINCGARS X X X X X X
Have Quick II X X X X X X X
High Frequency X X X X X X X
X
EPLRS X X X F16
Block
30
X
Improved Data
X X F16C
Modem
F16D
E-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
UH-60A/L
OH-58D
AH-64D
AH-64A
CH-47D
HH-60L
Tactical Aircraft
Communications
X (same
antenna for
AN/ARC-186 VHF-
X VHF-AM X X X
AM/FM
and FM 2
commo
AN/ARC-201 VHF-
X (2) X (1) X (1 or 2) X (2) X (1) X (2)
FM (SINCGARS)
AN/ARC-220 (High
X X X
Frequency)
AN/ARC-164 (Have
X X X X X X
Quick)
AN/ARC-222 VHF-
X
AM/FM
MD-1295/A
(Improved Data X X X
Modem)
OVERVIEW
E-26. This section discusses means of communicating from ground CPs.
WIRE
E-27. When feasible, wire communication should be the primary means of
communicating within the TOC areas. Subordinate and attached battalion
main CPs should run wire to the aviation brigade main CP. Wire should cross
roads either overhead or through culverts and should be buried as soon as
feasible to hinder enemy tapping.
E-6
Appendix E
generation Have Quick systems and with non-Have Quick UHF-AM radios. It
is compatible with Air Force, Navy, and Marine Corps Have Quick II
systems, but LOS constraints may hinder communication with joint systems
from the ground.
E-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
E-8
Appendix E
AN/PRC-127 (WALKIE-TALKIE)
E-43. This nontactical walkie-talkie operates in the 138- to 160-megahertz
FM range. The frequency is set from an integral keypad. Fourteen channels
are available. This system provides personnel with a nonsecure low-power
means of localized communication.
E-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
MESSENGER
E-46. Ground and air messengers may transport hard-copy messages and
larger documents as part of a regularly scheduled shuttle between CPs,
trains, and higher and lower headquarters. An alternative to dedicated
messengers is delivery with ground and aerial delivery of supplies such as
meals delivered to a tactical CP. Messengers may deliver combat plans and
orders, written coordination and control measures, graphics, logistics
requests and estimates, or other extensive documents that would consume
excess time to send electronically.
GENERAL
E-47. Aviation units have more complex communications requirements than
ground forces. Greater distances between brigade CPs and subordinate
battalions and their widely dispersed aircraft require additional radio
systems beyond the normal SINCGARS combat net radio. Communications
systems must support the larger battle space of aviation brigades that may
conduct simultaneous shaping operations, reconnaissance, and UH-60 A2C2S
support in decisive operations and aerial resupply as part of sustaining
operations.
E-10
Appendix E
BATTALIONS
E-49. Battalions typically operate a C2 network and O&I and A&L networks
all using SINCGARS. Battalions also operate an internal air battle network
using Have Quick II. The high-frequency radio is a secondary means of
secure tactical communication to overcome SINCGARS and Have Quick II
LOS constraints. The AN/ARC-186 VHF-AM radio is normally for
administrative ATS but may function as a platoon internal net. The battalion
TOC may also have access to MSE and SATCOM for communicating with
higher headquarters.
AVIATION BRIGADES
E-50. MSE is the primary means of communications with higher
headquarters, especially in large AOs. Brigades have SINCGARS C2 and O&I
and A&L networks and are Have Quick II-capable. HF radios provide a
secondary means of communication. SATCOM may also be prevalent at
brigade level.
COMMAND NETWORK
E-52. The brigade commander, XO, S3, and battalion commanders operate
on the brigade command network. The battalion commander, XO, S3, and
company commanders operate on the battalion command network. Because
SINCGARS may lack the range necessary to control forward operations, a
tactical CP may temporarily operate forward at brigade or battalion level.
Ground retransmission stations may be set up to facilitate command net
communication. The HF radio is a secondary means of command net
communication. Relay of command information is a third option.
E-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
E-12
Appendix E
GENERAL
E-61. This section addresses how aircrews communicate internally and
externally with aircraft and ground communication systems.
E-62. SINCGARS is the primary combat net radio. Airborne commanders
operate on the command net. Reports are sent on the O&I network.
Logisticians and FARPs operate on the A&L net. Have Quick II supports
internal communication between aircraft at the company level and provides a
means of communicating with any joint air systems that may be participating
in the mission. HF communications enhance terrain flight communications
with distant CPs. If UH-60 C2 system-equipped or A2C2S aircraft are
available, SATCOM provides another long-distance communication option.
Units minimize voice communications by employing brevity codes and digital
data communications.
E-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
E-14
Appendix E
E-15
Appendix F
SECTION I – INTRODUCTION
DEFINITION
F-5. A FARP is a temporary arming and refueling facility organized,
equipped, and deployed within the aviation unit’s AO. FARPs are transitory
and support specific mission objectives. Some FARPs do not have cavalry or
attack arming points. However, they do have ammunition for all weapons
carried by utility and heavy helicopters. FARPs are task-organized according
to METT-TC.
PURPOSE
F-6. FARPs promote increased aircraft time on station by reducing
turnaround time associated with refueling and rearming. Units employ
FARPs when flight time to unit trains is excessive and mission demands
require longer time on station. FARPs also support operations in deep areas
F-0
Appendix F
or other operations when mission distances exceed normal aircraft range and
when target size requires rearming. During exploitation and other rapid
advances, FARPs support aviation forces when field trains are unable to keep
pace.
F-7. The key to effective FARP support is simultaneous arming and
refueling. Ideally, FARPs service each company as a unit, with each aircraft
within that unit simultaneously receiving fuel and ammunition.
PERSONNEL
F-8. Personnel allocations for the FARP include MOSs 77F, 89B, 15J, 15X,
and 15Y. Petroleum specialists, MOS 77F, transport Class III and fuels
aircraft. Ammunition specialists, MOS 89B, transport, unpack, maintain, and
account for ammunition. Aircraft armament repairers, MOSs 15J/X/Y, repair
fire control systems and arm OH-58D, AH-64A, and AH-64D aircraft,
respectively. As required, commanders augment the FARP with other
medical, BDA/maintenance teams, and security forces. At division or major
base camp rapid refueling point supporting SASO, the increased operational
tempo or density of traffic may require ATS assets.
PLANNING FACTORS
GENERAL
F-9. The mission and operational tempo determine FARP supply priorities.
Exploiting ATKHBs may expend Class V faster than Class III. Conversely,
reconnoitering air cavalry squadrons expend more Class III than Class V.
DISTANCE
F-10. Units often establish FARPs if distances between the fight and the
logistics trains exceed 30 kilometers. FARPs that are located too far forward
are at risk of artillery engagement and increase turnaround time for slower
supply vehicles. However, flight time to and from FARPs positioned too far in
the rear reduces available time on station. The threat, availability of cover
and concealment, road conditions, availability of higher echelon throughput
of Class III/V, and distance to Class III/V distribution points affect how close
FARPs can locate to the fight for sustained support.
THREAT
F-11. The threat can neutralize aviation force effectiveness by preventing
aircraft from rearming and refueling. Therefore, the FARP may be a high-
priority target for the enemy. Enemy forces may subject FARPs to NBC,
ground, TACAIR, air assault, and artillery attacks. Local sympathizers and
insurgents may harass FARP operations.
F-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
DISPLACEMENT
F-12. FARP survivability requires frequent displacement. Few FARP
locations permit rearming and refueling more than three times. A good
planning figure for FARP duration is three to six hours. Units employ more
than one FARP for longer missions with displacing silent FARPs waiting to
assume the mission at preplanned times. Careful site selection, effective
camouflage, and minimum personnel and equipment lead to survivable,
mission-capable FARPs.
COMMANDER
F-14. The commander is responsible for overall FARP success. Based on the
factors of METT-TC, he decides how FARPs will support missions.
S3
F-15. The S3 formulates a FARP plan that supports the commander’s
tactical plan. The S3 consults with the S4 and the HHC commander to ensure
that the plan is logistically supportable.
S4
F-16. The S4 calculates mission Class III/V requirements and plans supply
distribution. He coordinates these needs with higher headquarters.
AIRCRAFT CONTROL
F-18. Aircraft control within the FARP is critical to safety and efficiency. The
FARP’s proximity to the battlefield restricts use of electronic means for
positive aircraft control. The most effective control mechanism is a thorough
briefing based on a well-written and -rehearsed SOP that outlines FARP
procedures for aircrews and FARP personnel. For rapid refueling points in
rear areas, offset, low-output nondirectional radio beacons (NDBs) may be a
low-risk means to identify refuel points. In addition, units may use various
signaling methods to maintain procedural aircraft control.
F-2
Appendix F
VISUAL SIGNALS
F-21. Examples of visual signals include hand-and-arm signals, smoke,
signal flags, flash cards, and light signals. Ground guides normally control
aircraft movement within the FARP. Because ground guides may direct allied
aircraft, they must use standard hand-and-arm signals (Section VIII).
Smoke
F-22. Smoke is not a preferred visual signal, but it has some advantages. It
indicates wind direction. Different colors can indicate the current FARP
situation and Class III/V availability. Smoke also has disadvantages; its use
is day restricted, and it can compromise the FARP location.
SIGNALS
F-25. In peacetime, aircrews turn off the anticollision light to signal the
ground crew to begin arming. As an alternate combat signal, aircrews may
employ hand-and-arm signals during the day and cockpit navigation lights at
night to signal the start of arming. Ground personnel can talk via intercom to
F-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
TRAFFIC LAYOUT
F-26. Standard marker panels on departure and arrival points improve the
control of aircraft. FARP personnel use secured engineer tape, chemical
lights, or beanbag lights at night to indicate desired aircraft movement or the
location of ground guides. After servicing, the ground guide directs aircraft
toward the departure end of the FARP.
CAUTION
If used, properly secure marker panels and engineer
tape to avoid foreign object damage.
F-27. Figure F-1 shows an example of traffic layout. Figure F-2 shows an
example of layout for simultaneous operations.
F-4
Appendix F
F-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
RADIO COMMUNICATIONS
F-29. FARP personnel avoid radio transmission to reduce enemy capability
to detect and target electronic emissions. However, each FARP (active and
silent) requires at least two FM radios for monitoring. This allows
simultaneous monitoring of both the command and A&L nets. FARP
personnel monitor the command net to determine when units are inbound
and when the FARP needs to displace. FARPs communicate on A&L to
inform the S4 of their own supply needs.
F-30. Because FM radios are limited by LOS and range, the distance or
location of the FARP may prevent FARP personnel from monitoring or
transmitting on the designated command frequency. Aircraft retransmission
or relay is an option. Critical messages that may require airborne relay
include when the FARP—
• Is under attack.
• Relocates or ceases operations.
• Is not operational at the scheduled time.
• Requires resupply.
• Has a change in status.
F-31. Aircrews use radios only after aircraft have left the FARP. This
procedure helps prevent the enemy from electronically pinpointing the
FARP’s location. Aircrews can relay less time-sensitive FARP reports and
other communications in person after mission completion.
LOCATION
F-32. FARPs locate as close to the AO as the tactical situation permits. They
may locate as far forward as 18 to 25 kilometers, dependent upon METT-TC;
behind the FLOT; and within a committed brigade’s AO. This distance
increases aircraft time on station by reducing travel times associated with
refueling. If possible, the FARP remains outside the threat of medium-range
artillery. Figure F-3 shows typical ranges of threat medium-range artillery.
F-6
Appendix F
MISSION
F-34. FARPs support deep, close, and rear areas (Chapter 2). In many
circumstances, vehicle-emplaced FARPs within the close area can also
support aircraft returning from deep areas and reaction elements assigned to
counter Level III rear threats. Units also may employ air-emplaceable jump
FARPs to support rear or deep areas or to reinforce FARPs supporting
decisive and shaping operations. The following discussion explains how
F-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
FARPs support the three basic mission types in the context of decisive,
shaping, and sustaining operations (Chapter 2).
Decisive Operations
F-35. Ground and air maneuver forces strike decisive blows. Ammunition
palletized loading system (PLS) trucks with mission-configured loads push
supplies down to the close area where FARP elements meet them at logistics
RPs. When possible, the Class III/V platoon leader coordinates for direct
delivery to the silent FARP to avoid transloading. Units travel to supply
points for fuel or receive throughput from higher echelon 5,000-gallon
tankers for transloading. Air-emplaced jump FARPs support limited resupply
behind enemy lines and support mobile strikes involving major air assaults.
Shaping Operations
F-36. Cavalry, operations in deep areas, special operations, and air assaults
characterize these operations. Corps AH-64 aircraft conduct operations in
deep areas using extended-range fuel tanks so that only Class V FARP
support may be necessary behind enemy lines. Special operations aircraft
also may require Class V support. Air assault mission aircraft often employ
extended-range fuel tanks but may need limited Class V support for armed
aircraft providing assault security.
Sustaining Operations
F-37. Air-emplaced jump FARPs support corps and division reaction aviation
forces as they attack Level III rear threats to sustainment. Airheads and
base camps support SASO and initial deployment aviation needs at
intermediate support bases. CH-47D and UH-60A/L aircraft conduct air
movement to supplement ground-emplaced FARP activities and emplace
jump FARPs supporting aerial resupply of ground forces in shaping
operations in deep areas.
ENEMY
F-38. The S2 determines the threat that the FARP is likely to encounter.
This determination includes the enemy’s capabilities, posture, and weapon
systems. For example, a FARP located in the close area may encounter an
enemy reconnaissance element. A FARP in the rear area may be the target of
enemy SOF. The S2 also determines the type of intelligence-gathering
devices and sensors that the enemy has oriented on the proposed FARP
location.
F-8
Appendix F
TIME AVAILABLE
F-41. Mission duration is a critical planning factor. Longer missions require
either multiple FARPs for different phases of the mission or a midmission
FARP displacement combined with Class III/V throughput to a new FARP
location. Planners must consider driving or flight time to proposed FARP
sites. Planners—
• Allow sufficient time for FARP setup.
• Consider how far the FARP is from the supply points, and either plan
supply throughput or arrange for a second silent FARP to go active to
support the next phase of the mission.
F-42. The FARP supports rearming and refueling operations for a specific
mission. When that mission is complete, the air assets make the transition to
the rear AA to reconfigure ammunition loads, refuel, and perform required
maintenance in preparation for other missions. Figures F-4 and F-5 show
typical dispositions of the division aviation brigade and its support assets.
F-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
Figure F-5. Typical Disposition of the Division Aviation Brigade and Support Assets
F-10
Appendix F
EMPLACEMENT
F-45. FARPs can be emplaced by ground or air. The means of emplacement
depends on where and when the FARP is to be set up and how much Class
III/V that the mission requires. The FARP should be designed so that a
trained team can quickly place it into operation. This team should be able to
load and move without leaving behind any debris, fuel, ammunition, or
equipment; therefore, the FARP employs only those assets that it needs for
the mission. Section VII covers FARP emplacement.
Air Emplacement
F-47. Emplacing FARPs by air offers three major advantages. The first is
that a FARP can move about the battlefield much faster by air than by
ground. The second advantage is that nearly every open field becomes a
potential FARP site. Third, it is generally more practical, from a threat
perspective, to air emplace FARPs in support of shaping operations in deep
areas.
F-48. Air-emplaced FARPs also have disadvantages. Aerial emplacement
depends on availability of supporting aircraft. If the enemy is advancing and
no utility or heavy helicopters are available for FARP displacement, the
entire FARP can be lost.
F-49. Aerial resupply of the FARP requires multiple loads to move bulk
quantities of Class III/V. This additional air traffic can compromise the FARP
location, increasing likelihood of enemy attack. Aircraft that sling load
F-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
equipment and supplies cannot fly NOE. They are more visible to enemy
sensors and missiles. Although materiel handling equipment (MHE) is often
essential in a FARP, it may be impractical to sling load rough-terrain
forklifts. The absence of MHE can seriously degrade ammunition handling.
MOVEMENT PLAN
F-51. FARP movement plans should cover advance parties, march tables, a
route reconnaissance, and alternate site locations. Detailed movement
planning improves the accuracy of the FARP’s operational time. Planning
should include load plans for individual vehicles and trailers. Standard load
plans do not exist for current equipment because equipment varies in each
unit’s MTOE. In addition, varying Class V requirements for different
missions greatly affect vehicle load plans.
F-52. An advance party/security team, equipped with NBC detection
equipment, reconnoiters the planned route and proposed FARP site. If the
site is unsuitable, the team explores alternate FARP locations. If the site is
usable, the advance party identifies areas for placing equipment. When
remaining FARP personnel and equipment arrive, the advance party guides
each vehicle to its position.
SECURITY
F-53. FARPs need enough organic security to thwart anticipated threats.
Excess security equipment hinders movement. Inadequate security risks
valuable assets. The advance party may include Stinger assets, NBC teams,
and crew-served weapons. The lead vehicle employs NBC attack monitoring
and warning equipment. Monitoring equipment locates upwind of the FARP
site. Light antitank weapons protect against enemy armored scout vehicles. If
available, FARPs place electronic early warning systems along likely avenues
of approach not covered by listening or OBs. Armed helicopters in or near the
FARP may act as quick-reaction forces. Units also can employ nonflying
soldiers as UH-60-transportable quick-reaction teams.
F-54. The FARP coordinates with the brigade responsible for the sector in
which the FARP locates and integrates into the air and ground security plan
of nearby friendly forces. If a FARP is designated a priority target, division
AD assets may employ near the FARP. These AD assets may cover friendly
ingress and egress routes. Units establish checkpoints that allow positive
identification for friendly aircraft using the FARP.
F-12
Appendix F
RELOCATION
F-56. Several guidelines determine the relocation of a FARP. By definition,
the FARP should be temporary, not staying anywhere longer than three to
six hours unless it is hardened and located in a secure area such as an
airhead. When the battle lines are changing rapidly or when the rear area
threat dictates, the FARP must move often. Where air parity or enemy air
superiority exists, the FARP must move often.
F-57. A FARP may relocate for any of the following reasons:
• It comes under attack.
• It receives the order to relocate.
• A preplanned relocation time has been set.
• A specific event occurs; for example, when the FARP has serviced a
specific unit or a specific number of aircraft.
• A decision or trigger point is reached.
F-58. The message to relocate a FARP is passed in FRAGO format and
should contain, as a minimum—
• Eight-digit grid coordinates of the next site and alternate site.
• Time that the FARP is to be mission ready.
• Fuel and ammunition requirements.
• Passage-of-lines contacts, frequencies, call signs, and ingress and
egress points.
• Enemy situation at the next site.
• March table or movement overlay.
• A logistics release point (LRP) to the FRAGO.
ADVANCE-PARTY ACTIONS
F-59. The advance party breaks down one section, consisting of one heavy
expanded mobility tactical truck (HEMTT) or one FARE. Next, it rolls up and
packs hoses and refuels the tanker if fuel is available. The advance party
then transports, when possible, enough ammunition for two mission loads per
aircraft, rolls up the camouflage nets, and sets up a convoy.
F-60. When the new site is deemed suitable, the advance party—
• Determines landing direction.
• Determines and marks refuel and rearm points, truck emplacements,
and ammunition emplacements.
• Sets up equipment.
F-61. Remaining elements break down the FARP in the same way and
sequence as described above. When personnel arrive at the new site, they
move into new locations, as directed by the advance party, and set up arming
and refueling points.
F-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
SITE PREPARATION
F-62. FARP personnel—
• Police the FARP site before operational use.
• Prevent rotor wash from injuring personnel or damaging equipment,
remove sticks, stones, and other potential flying objects.
• Clear scrub brush, small trees, and vegetation from landing and
takeoff areas.
• Predesignate landing, takeoff, and hover areas to minimize accidents
and injuries.
• Clear the areas around the rearming and refueling points and the
pump assemblies, removing dried grass and leaves to avoid fires.
F-63. Aircraft may sink in wet, snow-covered, thawing, or muddy ground.
Reinforce unstable ground with staked, pierced steel planking or other
suitable material.
F-14
Appendix F
F-71. This section discusses the FARE, the Advanced Aviation Forward Area
Refueling System (AAFARS), site layout, support equipment, personnel
refueling requirements, and refueling methods.
F-15
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
F-16
Appendix F
or valleys. Fuel vapors are heavier than air and flow downhill. In addition,
fuel sources should be downwind of the aircraft’s exhaust to reduce explosion
hazard. These considerations apply to any FARP setup with the FARE, 5,000-
gallon tanker, or HEMTT.
F-77. The FARP layout in desert, dust, and snow environments should not
require hovering where wind and rotor wash may cause brownout or
whiteout. Special considerations are necessary when aircrews operate with
night vision devices (NVD).
SUPPORT EQUIPMENT
F-78. FARE or FARP personnel perform the following procedures:
• Locate a fire extinguisher at each refueling nozzle and at the pump
and filter assembly.
• Place a water can at each refueling point; the water enables operators
to wash fuel from skin and clothes and dirt from fuel nozzles.
• Place a waste fuel pan next to each nozzle to contain fuel spillage.
REFUELING METHODS
F-80. Units conduct hot or rapid refueling while aircraft engines are running
and rotors are turning. Cold refueling occurs when aircraft engines have been
shut down. In a field environment, units normally use the hot refueling
method. There are two types of hot refueling: open-port and CCR.
Open-Port
F-81. Units open-port refuel with an automotive type of nozzle, inserted into
a fill port of larger diameter. It is not as fast or as safe as CCR. The larger
port allows fuel vapors to escape. In addition, dust, dirt, rain, snow, and ice
can enter the fill port during refueling, risking fuel contamination. Spills
from overflowing tanks also are more likely. Units should use the open-port
rapid refueling method only during combat or vital training. In these cases,
the unit commander makes the final decision. Units conduct simultaneous
arming and open-port refueling activities only when the combat situation and
benefits of reduced ground time outweigh the risks.
F-17
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
WARNING
As aircraft move through the air, they build up
static electricity. Static electricity also builds up
on refueling equipment as fuel passes through the
hoses. The refueler must ground the aircraft, fuel
nozzle, and pump assembly to prevent sparks and
explosions. Static electricity buildup is greater in
cool, dry air than in warm, moist air.
Closed-Circuit
F-82. CCR is accomplished with a nozzle that mates with and locks into the
fuel tank. This connection prevents fuel spills and vapors from escaping at
the aircraft fill port and reduces the chances of fuel contamination.
AMMUNITION OPERATIONS
F-83. This section discusses ammunition and arming operations, aircraft
flow and mix, and training.
AMMUNITION STORAGE
F-84. The ready ammunition storage area (RASA) contains the ammunition
to support aircraft arming. Ready ammunition is that quantity required to
support the mission beyond one load. The RASA requires separate areas for
the assembly and disassembly of rockets, aircraft flares, and malfunctioned
ammunition. AR 385-64 and TM 9-1300-206 contain more information.
F-85. The basic load storage area (BLSA) contains the specific quantity of
ammunition required and authorized to be on hand at the unit to support
three days of combat. A basic load includes a variety of ammunition such as
small arms, grenades, and mines, in addition to aircraft-specific ammunition.
F-18
Appendix F
F-19
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
ARMING OPERATIONS
PERSONNEL REQUIREMENTS
F-95. The weight of the ammunition containers and Hellfire missiles
requires that at least two people load each aircraft. Two personnel arm the
turret system to ensure link removal and less jamming during uploads.
Rocket ammunition requires multiple personnel and tools just to remove and
prepare it before loading.
F-20
Appendix F
LIMITATIONS
F-96. Several factors can degrade efficiency and increase turnaround times.
These factors include crew size, night operations, NBC environment, weapons
and ordnance mix, attrition, and maintenance problems.
Personnel
F-97. For rapid turnaround times, FARPs need sufficient personnel to
service aircraft. Each point should be staffed by one supervisor, one refueler,
and two armament personnel. Each Class III HEMTT requires one person to
F-21
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
Night Operations
F-98. When arming turret weapons at night, personnel need NVD or
supplemental lighting such as flashlights. In addition, arming times will be
three to eight minutes longer at night, especially under low-light conditions.
Armament Maintenance
F-101. Aircraft with armament maintenance problems may interrupt the
flow of FARP operations. These aircraft should be positioned away from the
arming and refueling area to keep the flow of aircraft constant.
F-22
Appendix F
Terrain
F-105. A four-point FARP requires an area larger than a football field.
Finding a single cleared, concealed, level area for eight service points may
prove difficult. If terrain dictates, consider splitting away part of the FARP to
a nearby area.
F-106. FARPs may be divided into two sections, up to one kilometer apart,
supporting two to four points each. This layout imposes C2 and security
challenges and prevents personnel who finish servicing their aircraft from
assisting others a kilometer away. However, it supports company integrity
and dispersion, making it harder to target the FARP with artillery. Figure F-
9 depicts a FARP split into two areas for dispersion. Figure F-10 depicts a
FARP concealed in urban terrain.
Personnel
F-107. A FARP with eight service points theoretically requires at least 10
refuelers: 8 to refuel aircraft and 2 manning the emergency shut-off valves. It
also requires 12 arming personnel (2 per service point). This requirement can
overextend the III/V platoon because there is a need for a second silent or
resupplying FARP.
F-108. One solution is cross training personnel to assist in multiple FARP
functions. Units can train 89Bs, 77Fs, and copilots to assist in arming
functions. At a 50-gallon-per-minute rate, a 77F can finish refueling in as
little as six minutes and then assist in arming.
F-109. If in the FARP up to 40 minutes, pilots and copilots may stretch by
alternately leaving the aircraft. They can assist some arming functions such
as lifting Hellfire missiles and loading rockets. Units also can arrange UH-60
transport of FARP personnel, minus drivers, to newly opening FARPs.
F-23
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
F-24
Appendix F
Equipment
F-110. At least one HEMTT tanker and two FAREs or one AAFARS must
support each four-point FARP. More typical would be two HEMTT tankers,
given a less-than-routine availability of UH-60 aircraft to transport 500-
gallon drums. Even greater numbers of HEMTTs and heavy expanded
mobility ammunition trailers (HEMATs) must support each FARP. Again, as
with personnel constraints, it is difficult to operate more than one FARP with
available equipment. In addition, there is the time-consuming challenge of
resupplying HEMTT tankers and HEMATs to support ongoing and future
FARP operations.
F-111. A solution may be coordinated throughput of mission-configured loads
using PLS trucks from supporting ammunition units. These PLSs reduce
MHE needs by hydraulically placing entire pallets onto the ground for
manual access to ammunition. The S4 and III/V platoon leader can
coordinate palletized ammunition throughput directly to silent FARP
locations and near projected future armament pads.
AIRCRAFT MIX
F-112. If a Longbow unit splits into two platoons or three teams, the FCR
aircraft usually is the scout and may have more gun and rocket ammunition.
FARP personnel identify the FCR aircraft and direct it to supply points that
specialize in loading more of that kind of Class V.
F-113. Scout aircraft may expend little ammunition and may primarily need
refueling, which is not as time intensive. They may overwatch until another
aircraft completes servicing and can assume the overwatch role.
Continuous Attack
F-115. This is a primary driver for maintaining company integrity in the
FARP. In this technique, battalions rotate companies through the FARP.
Units cannot afford to have a backlog waiting on companies before them.
Phased Attack
F-116. To give the commander more time operating with two companies in
the attack, he can operate two FARPs simultaneously. The normal silent
FARP can go active to allow servicing of two companies at the same time.
Maximum Destruction
F-117. Units often employ this technique in a target-rich environment.
Aircraft may employ extended-range tanks to reach the objective area and
return on one fuel load. If the target is large and one ammunition load is
insufficient, given one pylon’s loss to an extended range fuel tank, units may
air emplace a jump FARP with limited Class V only.
F-25
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
TRAINING
F-119. A successful FARP operation is the final product of a series of
progressive, skill-building programs to include the cross training of assigned
and attached personnel. Coordinated operations are achieved by integrating
team training with programs that emphasize personal skill development.
Training progresses as individuals integrate into operational teams.
F-26
Appendix F
within the corps or division aviation brigade and its relative location on the
battlefield also determine support.
F-126. Some CSS elements employ supply point distribution. FARP tankers
and trucks must drive to separate Class III and V supply points for transload.
Other CSS units employ supply throughput using PLS trucks with mission-
configured combat Class V loads and Class III fuel semitrailers that link up
with FARP elements at more forward logistics RPs. CSS units support
around-the-clock operational capability.
F-127. As missions change, FARP CSS resupply needs change. Transport
and MHE requirements may exceed III/V platoon equipment and personnel
capabilities, especially when units operate multiple FARPs. Transport
vehicles may exceed their cargo-carrying capacity (cube out) before exceeding
their weight limitations. Table F-3 shows cargo capacities for various vehicle
types.
Table F-3. Cargo Capacity Comparison in Rounds
Munition HEMTT HEMAT 5-ton short bed 5-ton long bed 1-½-ton trailer
Hellfire 36 36 27 45 9
Stinger 54 72 36 54 9
Hydra 2.75” 240 240 180 300 60
30-mm 10,368 10,368 10,560 10,560 2,640
F-128. Available MHE unloads ammunition. This MHE may be the TOE-
authorized forklift or the HEMTT-mounted crane. Transporting the variable
reach forklift may require a flatbed trailer, an item not readily available to
the unit. Without the forklift or crane, ammunition pallets must be manually
broken down while on the bed of the transport vehicle, which can be a
laborious and time-consuming operation.
RESUPPLY
F-129. Resupply operations must match the pace of battle. The same vehicles
that support active FARPs must periodically return to Class III and V supply
points. Units overcome this lull in FARP capability by operating multiple
FARPs and coordinating throughput to the next projected FARP location.
F-130. The Class III/V platoon leader processes periodic bulk POL status
reports through the S4 to the MMC to forecast user needs. The corps delivers
Class III supplies, using throughput distribution, as far forward as the BSA.
However, delivery may occur to the battalion AA or FARP, in specific
situations. The aviation unit uses its vehicles to transport the fuel from the
transfer point to the FARP. Aviation units in the corps rear area receive
Class III from the corps support area (CSA) transfer point.
F-131. If demand exceeds unit resupply capability, limited aerial resupply
may be available from other division or corps heavy or utility helicopters.
Figure F-11 shows the flow of Class III supplies.
F-27
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
F-28
Appendix F
CLASS V REQUIREMENTS
F-135. The battalion S4 is responsible for calculating the amount of
ammunition needed for the mission. He bases his figures on the S3’s plan.
Table F-4 shows an example of the total Class V requirements needed by an
ATKHB for one day. Generally, one armament HEMTT with HEMAT is
required for every four OH-58D or three AH-64 aircraft.
Table F-4. Example of Munitions Requirements for One Day
AH-64D ATKHB
Weapon Rounds
Hellfire missiles 576
2.75” rockets 1,512
30mm chain gun 36,000
F-29
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
GROUND VEHICLES
F-138. Small, maneuverable, easy-to-conceal ground vehicles, such as the
HMMWV, can emplace the FARE platform. The disadvantage is that
HMMWVs may not be available or may be needed for other FARP missions.
F-139. The 3/4-ton trailer is an option for FARE transport. Planners should
consider bolting the FARE system (pump and filter/separator) to the trailer
frame. The trailer is light enough to transport by HMMWV or sling load by
UH-60. To complete the FARP package, units can air or ground emplace fuel
and ammunition.
F-140. Another HMMWV or 3/4-ton trailer capability is transport of
ammunition from the cargo truck to the armament pad. It can also move the
500-gallon collapsible fuel drums around the FARP if the collapsible fuel-
drum tow assembly is available.
F-141. The M977 HEMTT and M978 HEMTT tanker are the primary movers
of Class III/V supplies to the FARP (Figure F-13). The M977 can carry 22,000
pounds of cargo. Its onboard crane has a 2,500-pound lift capability. The
crane enables the HEMTT to load and offload ammunition without other
materiel-handling equipment.
F-142. The M978 tanker holds 2,500 gallons of fuel and provides two
refueling points. When paired with the Hot Tactical Aircraft Refueling
System (HTARS), the M978 can simultaneously refuel four aircraft.
F-143. The M977 or M978 are prime movers for the HEMAT (M989). It
carries up to 22,000 pounds of ammunition, four 500-gallon collapsible
drums, or two 600-gallon fuel pods. Generally, one armament HEMTT with
HEMAT can support up to four OH-58D or three AH-64 aircraft.
F-30
Appendix F
HELICOPTERS
F-31
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
cover. In a second lift, the UH-60s can transport two more fuel drums and
additional mission ammunition. Aircraft can sling load three Hellfire pallets
at once for 27 total missiles.
FAT COW
F-147. The CH-47’s ERFS, commonly known as Fat Cow, is a modular,
interconnectable system, composed of up to four 600-gallon noncrashworthy
tanks, four electrically operated fuel pumps, and a vent system. It mounts on
the left side of the aircraft cargo area; exact placement depends on aircraft
center-of-gravity limits. This system provides up to 2,320 gallons to refuel
other aircraft.
F-148. With the ERFS, space for cargo and passengers is extremely limited.
The aircraft can seat four people on each side. Figure F-16 shows the proper
placement for remaining required equipment to include the FARE. With a
MACOM waiver, units can transport additional FARP or security personnel,
as in Task Force Hawk, in which 18 infantrymen provided security.
F-149. After the aircraft lands, FARP personnel can set up two refueling
points quickly. Figure F-17 shows how the refueling points may be set up.
The actual setup depends on the equipment available.
F-150. Advantages of the ERFS are the following:
• The system is ready for refueling within minutes after landing; this
makes Fat Cow especially useful for operations in deep areas.
• The system displaces quickly; after refueling and packing equipment,
the CH-47 takes off, clearing the site within minutes.
• The ERFS may be pressure refueled (a maximum of 35 per square
inch and 150 GPM for faster turnaround missions.
F-151. Disadvantages of the ERFS are the following:
• The ERFS is airworthy when installed, operated, and maintained as
described in TM 55-1560-307-13&P; however, fuel can leak into the
cabin, potentially causing a catastrophic incident during a hard
landing or accident.
• Aircraft can carry only essential personnel; these personnel must be
seated, wearing a lap belt, unless a MACOM waiver is granted.
• CH-47 door guns provide limited protection; planning should consider
escort reconnaissance or attack elements.
• Additional hazards exist if CH-47 rotors turn during refueling.
• Depending on FARP location, the CH-47 may require ERFS fuel.
• CH-47 signature makes operations vulnerable to detection and attack.
F-32
Appendix F
F-33
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
F-34
Appendix F
F-35
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
refuel and rearm four OH-58D aircraft in less than 15 minutes without sling
loading fuel or ammunition. The absence of an external load increases UH-60
survivability, reduces emplacement time, and limits enemy capability to
target the FARP. Normal operations consists of two External Stores Support
System (ESSS)-equipped UH-60 aircraft with full crew, three to four POL
personnel, a combat lifesaver/medic, security personnel, armament personnel,
and armament and refuel equipment to support the mission.
MARINE KC-130
F-157. The Marine Corps KC-130F/R/T/J models are equipped for airborne
refueling but also rapid ground refueling of Marine or, in this case, Army
helicopters and ground vehicles. Aircraft refuel from wing fuel and pods
mounted under the wings. They also can carry a 3,600-gallon stainless steel
tank inside the cargo compartment for additional fuel delivery. Older model
KC-130s require this cargo compartment tank for refueling and can only
transport 5,588 gallons in wing and wing-pod fuel tanks. The new KC-130J
can deliver up to 8,455 gallons from wing pods and wing fuel and an
additional 3,600 gallons from the cargo compartment tank. It can also refuel
without the cargo compartment tank, allowing palletized ammunition and
other supplies to be transported. It has its own pumps and hoses that can
dispense up to 300 GPM from each pod (Figure F-19).
F-36
Appendix F
Figure F-18. HTARS Configuration and Additional Components for CH-53 FARP
F-37
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
Figure F-19. HTARS Configuration and Additional Components for C-130 FARP
F-38
Appendix F
Figure F-20. HTARS Configuration and Additional Components for C-17 FARP
SITE CONSIDERATIONS
F-159. The KC-130 or C-17 can operate from small airfields with limited
supporting infrastructure. The airfield runway must be 3,000- to 5,000-feet
long and 90-feet wide.
F-160. The KC-130 and C-17 do not require paved runways. Graded and
compacted gravel or clay will suffice. However, if KC-130 or C-17 resupply
becomes a primary means of resupply for a forward operating base or base
camp airfield—such as occurred in Afghanistan—runway repair
requirements will increase, dictating engineer augmentation.
F-161. The CH-53 TBFDS does not require a runway but a large relatively
flat area similar in size to that required for CH-47 Fat Cow refueling.
F-39
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
EQUIPMENT LAYOUT
F-162. The CH-53 TBFDS has enough hoses to refuel two aircraft or refuel
vehicles located 200 feet away. Hoses run out of the cargo compartment in
the form of a “V” in the same manner as a CH-47 Fat Cow. The TBFDS uses
the standard D-1 nozzle compatible with Army and other joint aircraft. Army
aircraft must approach Marine Corps refueling points hovering at a 45-
degree angle with the aircraft fuel port facing the nozzle.
F-163. Marine KC-130s have organic refuel equipment and compatible D-1
nozzles as they perform the same ground mission for Marine helicopters and
fixed-wing aircraft. Fuel in the wing-mounted external fuel tanks and
internal 3,600-gallon stainless steel tank (if installed) can be dispensed for
rapid ground refueling. The aircraft external fuel pods use ram-air turbine-
driven fuel boost pumps in each pod.
F-164. For the C-17, required equipment includes the HTARS, two 100-GPM
filter separators, five fire extinguishers, four water cans, and spill containers.
Postoperation evacuation of fuel lines requires a 100-GPM pump. FARP or
FARE personnel configure the HTARS and additional components as Figure
F-20 shows. They lay out the system to achieve minimum safe distance
between aircraft.
F-40
Appendix F
• Connect the clip of the nozzle grounding wire to the ground rod at
each point.
• Place a fire extinguisher, a spill container, and a five-gallon can of
water at each point.
• Place a grounding rod at the filter/separator, and connect using the
filter/separator grounding wire.
• Place a fire extinguisher at the filter/separators.
OPERATION
F-168. One critical aspect of refueling operation with other service aircraft is
that their rules and regulations differ from and supersede the Army’s. For
instance, Marine doctrine prohibits simultaneous arming and refueling and
requires a separation distance of at least 300 feet from separate arming and
refueling activities. In addition, while hot refueling is permissible, hot
refueling with explosive ordnance on board is not authorized unless approved
by Headquarters, U.S. Marine Corps, and Naval Air Systems Command.
F-169. In wartime, attack units may be authorized to refuel while armed. In
peace and lesser contingencies, units must dearm, then refuel, then rearm.
This restriction effectively requires aircraft to shut down after refueling to
preserve onboard fuel. Marine Corps aircraft use JP5 fuel. The Air Force and
Army use JP8. This disparity poses no problem for Army aircraft.
F-170. Unless Marine Corps or Air Force regulations supersede the Army’s,
operate the system in compliance with safety procedures and follow these
steps:
• The refuelers guide aircraft into position using coordinated signals;
they check with the pilot to ensure that all armaments are on safe.
• Aircrew members, except the pilot, should assist with refueling or as
fire guards.
• The refuelers place fire extinguishers near the aircraft and within
reach of fuel fill points.
• The refuelers ground the aircraft.
• The refuelers bond the nozzle to the aircraft; they insert the bonding
plug into the aircraft plug receiver or attach the nozzle bonding cable
clip to bare metal on the aircraft.
• After bonding the nozzle, the refuelers remove the nozzle dust cap and
open the fill port.
• The refuelers verify that all valves are open.
• Refuelers signal the refueling supervisor that the point is ready to fuel
and open the nozzle and refuel; they do not leave the nozzle at any
time during the refueling; they stop the flow of fuel if there is any
emergency at the refueling point.
• After the receiving aircraft is full, refuelers shut off the nozzle;
disconnect the nozzle from the aircraft; and replace the fuel fill port
cover and the nozzle dust cap.
• Refuelers unplug the nozzle-bonding plug and return the nozzle to the
nozzle hanger.
F-41
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
F-171. For C-17 refueling, refuelers use a FARE pump to evacuate fuel lines
and recover components as follows:
• Close the D-1 nozzle.
• Install the FARE pump 10 feet away from the SPR panel.
• Reverse the flow direction of each filter/separator.
• Start the pump, and run at idle.
• Recover hoses, starting at the refueling point.
• Stop the pump, and disconnect from the tanker aircraft.
ADVANTAGES/DISADVANTAGES
Advantages
F-172. The advantages of the CH-53 TBFDS, KC-130, or C-17 FARP
include—
• Ability to deliver bulk fuel to remote areas using small airfields with
unimproved runways (no runway for CH-53) and little supporting
infrastructure.
• Ability to provide substantial fuel and be set up and operational
quickly.
• Useful for selected operations in deep areas using intermediate
staging bases or forward operating bases.
• Ability of the CH-53 TBFDS to aerial refuel and rapidly return with
additional fuel.
• Ability of joint fixed-wing aircraft can also transport ammunition in
the cargo compartment for substantial resupply capability.
Disadvantages
F-173. The disadvantages of the CH-53 TBFDS, KC-130, or C-17 FARP
include—
• It requires diversion of these aircraft from other valuable missions.
• Because of other priorities and the ACO/ATO process, it may require
substantial time to request and get approval for such missions.
• The KC-130 or C-17 requires a 3,000-foot by 90-foot minimum runway
for landing; engineer requirements can be extensive if the runway is
dirt or clay and the unit anticipates repeated use.
• The aviation unit operating the FARP must transport personnel and
equipment to the FARP site; Marine CH-53s or KC-130s may wish to
provide their own refuelers/operators.
• Marine Corps’ aircraft refueling regulations prohibit simultaneous
arming and refueling activities.
F-174. UH-60 aircraft equipped with the Volcano system require arming in a
manner similar to attack helicopters. However, assault battalions and their
F-42
Appendix F
F-43
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
ARMING
F-178. Each launcher rack functions as a carrier and launcher platform for a
40-mine canister. Aircraft can mount up to four M139 dispenser racks, two on
each side of the UH-60. Loaders insert canisters into the 40 keyholes, rows 1
through 4 from bottom to top and columns 1 through 10 from left to right.
This loading sequence can be important if the rack carries less than a full
load of mines. As loaders insert the mine canisters, a green latch latches the
canister to the rack and a red latch arms the canister. The rack has two
electric receptacles—one for the power connector and one for the launcher
rack cable running to the dispensing control unit.
DISARMING
F-179. After mission completion, aircraft return to the arming point to
dearm. The users—
• Discard spent canisters at least 30 meters to the left or right rear of
the aircraft at the 4- and 8-o'clock positions.
• Return live canisters to ASPs for future use or repackaging.
• Place misfired canisters in the dud pit and contact EOD.
F-180. The FARP provides forward support for tactical operations. Its
organization includes the POL and ammunition section and a maintenance
contact team.
F-44
Appendix F
EQUIPMENT
SITE SELECTION
F-184. FARP personnel use tree lines, vegetation, terrain folds, and reverse
slopes to mask the FARP. Do not collocate the FARP with the TOC or unit
trains. The site must accommodate the number and type of aircraft that need
service. Units maintain the minimum spacing prescribed by FM 4-20.12 (FM
10-67-1). This manual requires 100 feet between refueling points for all
aircraft except the CH-47, which requires 180 feet for aircraft parked side by
side. Sites must allow adequate obstacle clearance for safe takeoff and
landing. Units designate HAs for waiting aircraft in view of the FARP but not
within it.
WORK PRIORITIES
SECURITY
F-185. FARP personnel—
• Establish a perimeter and prepare fighting positions and range cards.
• Set up crew-served and air defense weapons to protect the site.
• Sweep the site for NBC contamination and set up NBC equipment.
• Reconnoiter the site for appropriate refuel and rearm points.
COMMUNICATIONS
F-186. Upon arrival, the FARP NCOIC establishes communications with the
TOC, giving the closing report and anticipated time of operation. If possible,
he communicates on secure FM from a location other than the FARP. FARP
personnel use the FARP radio only under the following circumstances:
• Requesting resupply.
• Reporting that the site is under attack.
• Reporting that the FARP is not operational.
F-45
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
SETUP
F-188. FARP personnel—
• Determine the refuel and rearm point’s positions.
• Break down ammunition into the first standard loads and another
load in the RASA.
• Reposition vehicles into final parking location.
• Perform PMCS on vehicles, radios, NBC equipment, weapons, and
platoon equipment.
• Camouflage vehicles and equipment.
RESUPPLY
F-189. FARP personnel resupply ammunition and fuel as necessary. After
ammunition trucks offload, depending on the FARP’s expected duration of
operation, vehicles may need to depart for resupply of Class V. HEMTT
tankers may transload into other tankers as they become empty or can fill
empty 500-gallon drums. This practice allows these vehicles to go for
additional Class III at distribution points or logistics RPs. In all cases,
personnel diverted to resupply vehicles are not available to assist in arming
and refueling. With a silent FARP prepared to assume the mission, the initial
FARP vehicles can resupply without disrupting the mission.
AIRCRAFT PROCEDURES
F-190. Unit SOP and orders specify procedures. The following provides
recommendations and describes standard signals.
LANDING
F-191. The AMC calls in the blind when 5 kilometers from the FARP. An
example call is “T14 (FARP), this is T56 with five on blue.” The AMC is
telling the FARP that five aircraft are inbound on the Blue route. This alerts
the FARP and other aircraft of his intentions. The FARP does not reply
unless the area is not safe or secure. Personnel do not use terms that violate
OPSEC such as aircraft, inbound, outbound, and FARP.
F-192. Aircraft fly NOE within 3 kilometers of the FARP. Approaching
aircraft maintain visual contact with departing aircraft.
POSITIONING
F-193. FARP personnel use standard hand-and-arm signals to assist pilots in
positioning aircraft into refueling and rearming points.
F-46
Appendix F
F-47
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
Figure F-24. (Left) Turn to Port; (Center) Turn to Starboard; (Right) Landing Direction
F-197. In Figure F-25, the ground guide—
• (Left): Extends arms horizontally to the side, palms up; repeatedly
raises arms overhead; and indicates rate of ascent by speed of motion.
• (Right): Extend arms horizontally sideways with palms down; holds
position to signal hover.
F-48
Appendix F
F-49
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
F-50
Appendix F
Figure F-29. (Left) Engage Rotor(s); (Center) Start Engine(s); (Right) Wave Off
F-202. In Figure F-30, the ground guide—
• (Left): Holds hand raised with thumb up.
• (Center): Holds arm out, hand below the waist level, thumb down.
• (Right): Holds hands down by side, palms forward; with elbows
straight, repeatedly moves arms forward and upward to shoulder
height.
Figure F-30. (Left) Affirmative or All Clear; (Center) Negative or Not Clear; (Right) Move Back
F-203. In Figure F-31, the ground guide—
• (Left): Crosses hands and extends arms downward in front of the
body.
• (Center): Points left arm down, and repeatedly moves right arm from
overhead vertical position to horizontal forward position.
• (Right): Points right arm down, and moves left arm from overhead
vertical position to horizontal forward position; repeats left arm
movement.
F-51
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
Figure F-31. (Left) Land; (Center) Tail to the Right; (Right) Tail to the Left
F-204. In Figure F-32, the pilot—
• (Left): Makes a beckoning motion with right hand at eye level.
• (Right): Raises left hand overhead, palm toward aircraft with the right
hand indicating the persons concerned; and gestures toward aircraft.
F-52
Appendix F
Figure F-33. (Left) Tail Hook Up; (Center) Tail Hook Down;
(Right) Slow Engine(s) on Indicated Side
F-206. In Figure F-34, the ground guide—
• (Left): Holds either arm and hand at shoulder level, palm down; draws
the extended hand across neck in a “throat-cutting” motion.
• (Center): Day Operations: Extends hands overhead; pushes first two
fingers of right hand into fist of left hand. Night Operations: Makes
same movement with the left-hand wand vertically and the right-hand
wand horizontally.
• (Right): Day Operations: Extends hands overhead; pulls first two
fingers of right hand away from left fist. Night Operations: Makes
same movement except that left-hand wand is vertical and right-hand
wand is horizontal.
F-53
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
F-54
Appendix F
Figure F-37. (Left) Cut Cable; (Center) Winch Up; (Right) Winch Down
F-210. In Figure F-38, the ground guide—
• (Left): Hits right elbow with palm of left hand.
• (Center): Day Operations: With arms above head, clasps left forearm
with right hand and clenches the left fist. Night Operations: Similar to
the day signal except the right wand is placed against the left
forearm; holds wand in the left hand vertically.
• (Right): Day Operations: With arms and hands in “install-downlocks”
position, the right hand unclasps the left forearm. Night Operations:
Similar to the day signal except the right wand is placed against the
left forearm.
F-55
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
WARNING
Exercise the following precautionary measures if wearing the Extended
Cold Weather Clothing System (ECWCS) while performing aircraft
arming and refueling operations:
a. Fuel handlers wearing ECWCS should ground/bond themselves to
the aircraft, truck, or refueling component for several seconds before
fuel/defuel operations.
b. Do not remove ECWCS within 50 feet of fueling operations or near
flammable vapor-air mixture.
c. Rinse fuel-soaked ECWCS with water before removal.
F-212. The standard refueling and rearming line consists of eight points and
a maintenance point. The unit locates the maintenance point where it will
not interfere with normal operations.
F-56
Appendix F
REFUELING
F-213. FARP personnel inspect fuel and equipment according to regulations
and the unit accident prevention program.
F-214. For hot refueling, FARP personnel—
• Ensure that a 100-foot separation exists between refueling points.
• Ground CCR nozzles to grounding rods, and bond to the aircraft.
• Secure fuel caps and disconnect grounding cables before aircraft
takeoff.
F-215. Aircrews ensure that armament systems are on Safe or Off. They
stabilize the aircraft at flat pitch and deplane passengers before conducting
refueling operations. Although no transmissions are permitted except during
an emergency, they monitor all communications. Aircrews turn strobe lights
off before refueling and back on before takeoff (day only).
F-216. FARP personnel and crew chiefs wear protective equipment,
including eye and hearing protection and gloves, while conducting refueling
operations. FARP personnel or crew members man fire extinguishers.
REARMING
Maintenance Point
F-217. Units locate the maintenance point where it will not interfere with
normal operations. This point should be equipped with the following items:
• One fire extinguisher and a ground rod with cable.
• One standard toolbox.
• Two pallets for downloading rockets and 30-millimeter ammunition.
• Special tools as determined by the maintenance officer in charge.
• Spare parts.
Rearm Points
F-218. These points should be equipped with the following items:
• One standard toolbox.
• One metric toolbox (AH-64).
• One fire extinguisher and grounding rod with cable.
• One uploader/downloader (AH-64).
• One wing mike cord.
• Two pallets for rockets.
Personnel Requirements
F-219. Each FARP should include the following personnel:
• One noncommissioned officer.
• One line SO.
• One officer in charge.
• Three armament personnel (preferred); two armament personnel
(minimum) for each rearm pad.
F-57
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
Procedures
F-220. FARP personnel arm/dearm aircraft according to the appropriate
aircraft operator’s manual.
F-221. After turning off all armament switches, the pilot turns off the
anticollision light. The pilot makes no radio transmissions during
loading/downloading operations.
F-222. Once the anticollision light is off, armament personnel ground the
airframe, install the wing-store jettison pins, and chock the wheels, as
applicable. They plug in their headsets and establish communication with the
aircrew. The aircrew assists and monitors armament personnel during
loading/downloading operations.
F-223. Ground crews load subsystems inboard to outboard, remaining clear
of the front of the systems and back-blast areas. When loading is complete,
the ground crew removes all safety pins and moves away from the aircraft.
AIRCREWS
F-227. Aircrews make no radio transmissions within 100 feet of refueling or
arming points. While in the FARP, aircrews place aircraft position lights on
steady bright or dim. They turn off lights if required by the tactical situation
or if using NVD.
F-228. Aircrews flash aircraft position lights to alert the ground guide when
ready to refuel or depart. The pilot signals the refueler to stop refueling the
aircraft. Before takeoff, pilots ensure that personnel remove grounding clips
and stand clear.
F-58
Appendix F
STORAGE
F-229. FARP personnel—
• Secure and statically ground all 600-gallon tanks on an asphalt or
concrete hardstand that is away from aircraft and ground vehicle
operation.
• Empty the tanks before storage (except residual fuel).
• Store ERFS equipment—such as the pump board, fuel lines, and tie-
down straps—in the ERFS storage cases provided by the shipping
facility.
• Ensure that the storage area is enclosed and well ventilated.
• Drain all fuel supply lines of excess fuel before storage.
MISSION EQUIPMENT
F-232. Equipment requirements are divided between two sections. The unit
assigned the mission supplies the aircraft, the ERFS with FARE
attachments, one 50-foot suction hose (pot hose), one grounding rod with
cable, ground covers, tie-down ropes, and ALSE. The POL section supplies all
of the items shown in Figure F-16, one extra 100-GPM pump, one of each
type of refueling nozzle, and one 50-foot refueling hose.
F-233. The mission unit personnel install the required number of tanks
according to TM 55-1560-307-13&P and Figure F-16. If conducting extended-
range missions, they install the ERFS fuel management control panel:
• Hoses and Fittings. When possible, personnel use unisex fittings to
reduce assembly/disassembly fuel spillage and self-ground
connections.
• Pump System. If using the 250-GPM self-contained pump system,
exclude the filter separator from the equipment list and place the
pump in the 100-GPM mode; the pump’s size precludes loading a
spare pump.
• Nozzles. Mission unit personnel use the D-1 single-point nozzle on
CH-47Ds and CCR nozzles with attachments on other aircraft, unless
the D-1 is specified.
F-59
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
SITE SELECTION
F-234. The LZ must be large enough to accommodate FARP aircraft with no
less than 150 feet between refueling points. Allow at least 300 feet between
each CH-47 conducting ERFS refueling. This layout allows 150-foot
separation between supported aircraft refueling points.
SITE LAYOUT
F-235. For daytime operations, FARP personnel designate landing points
and mark them with standard visual signals and markers. For night
operations, they designate landing points and mark them with chemical
lights or tactical Y. FARP personnel—
• Set up refueling points and equipment as Figure F-14 shows.
• Place the extra 100-GPM pump beside the operating pump; for ease of
replacement, they place all spares so that they are readily accessible.
• Ground each FARP aircraft to its own grounding point; ground pumps
and filter separator.
• Place emergency equipment, such as a 5-gallon water can and fire
extinguisher, at the pump station and refueling points.
FIRE EXTINGUISHERS
F-236. Fire extinguishers must have current inspection tags and seals.
Authorized fire extinguishers include the following:
• Twenty-pound Halon 1211.
• Twenty-pound (KH CO3) Purple K.
• Fifteen-pound CO2.
Blade Ropes
F-237. Crew chiefs install and secure at least one blade rope per rotor system
on ERFS aircraft.
CREW DUTIES
Pilot in Command
F-239. The PC of the supporting aircraft is in charge of FARP operations. He
directs all operations and monitors safety. He ensures that personnel conduct
operations according to the SOP.
F-240. The PC’s station is at the fuel pump. This position enables him to
monitor all phases of the operation and turn off the fuel supply in case of a
mishap or an emergency.
F-60
Appendix F
Copilot
F-241. Copilots assist in marshalling, fire guard, and other duties that the
PC assigns.
Flight Engineer
F-242. The flight engineer is responsible for safely loading the aircraft before
the mission and unloading it after the aircraft is shut down. He controls the
fuel flow from inside the aircraft. In addition, he is responsible for cutting off
the fuel supply from inside the aircraft in case of a mishap or an emergency.
Crew Chief
F-243. The crew chief assists with marshalling and fire-guard duties.
Aircraft Position
F-246. A marshaller positions arriving aircraft in chalk order at each refuel
point. Aircraft remain in position until all refuel, then reposition together.
Fuel Transfer
F-247. Aircrews transfer fuel from the internal tanks in the same manner as
when aircraft self-deploy. To maintain aircraft center-of-gravity, complete
fuel transfer in the following sequence:
• Four tanks: 4, 1, 3, and 2.
• Three tanks: 3, 1, and 2.
PREFLIGHT INSPECTION
F-249. Before applying electrical power for system operation, aircrews
perform the checks and services listed in the PMCS, Table 2-6, TM 55-1560-
307-13&P.
F-61
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
MISSION
F-256. In this example, the mission is to deploy two FARPs to support
continuous attack, making the transition to phased attack of a different
target. The S3 designates two primary sites and alternates. The scheduled
operational times for FARP 1 are 0800 and 1930. The operational times for
FARP 2 are 1400 and 2000. In this example, the transition to phased attack
F-62
Appendix F
requires one of the FARP teams to further split to allow drivers to travel to
supply points and/or throughput LRP.
SUGGESTED SCHEDULE
F-257. Table F-5 illustrates a suggested FARP schedule. It assumes that
when one FARP is active, a second silent FARP is inactive. This example also
illustrates how a mission change to phased attack would require both FARPs
to operate simultaneously.
Table F-5. Suggested FARP Schedule
Team 1 (Platoon Sgt leads) Team 2 (Platoon Leader leads) FARP
FARP
0800 FARP 1 ACTIVE, Spts A Co Shuts down old FARP 2; drives to resupply point
0900 FARP 1 ACTIVE, Spts B Co Drives to resupply point/LRP
1000 FARP 1 ACTIVE, Spts C Co Arrives at resupply point/LRP; loads/transloads
1100 FARP 1 ACTIVE, Spts A Co Drives to FARP 2 location
1200 FARP 1 ACTIVE, Spts B Co Drives to & arrives at FARP 2 location; sets up
1300 FARP 1 ACTIVE, Spts C Co Continues setup, priority-of-work tasks
1400 Shuts down FARP; drives to resupply FARP 2 ACTIVE. Supports A Co.; offloads Class V trucks;
points/LRPs prepares to go to supply point
1500 Drives to resupply points/LRPs FARP 2 ACTIVE. Supports B Co; plt ldr prepares to split his
team; transloads fuel into empty tankers/drums
1600 Arrives at resupply points/LRPs, Team 2A: Supports C Co. in FARP 2; Team 2B: takes offloaded
loads/transloads trucks/tankers and drives to LRPs
1700 Drives to new FARP 1 location Team 2A: Supports A Co. in old FARP 2; Team 2B:arrives at
LRPs, loads/transloads
1800 Arrives at new FARP 1 location; off- Team 2A: Supports B Co. in old FARP 2, Team 2B: loaded
loads/sets up trucks return to new FARP site
1900 Continues setup, priority of work Tm 2A: Services C Co. in old FARP 2; tears down, moves to
FARP 1 ACTIVE new FARP/LRP; Tm 2B: loaded trucks arrive/set up new FARP
2000 FARP 1 ACTIVE, Spts A Co FARP 2 ACTIVE. Supports B Co. (phased attack)
2100 FARP 1 ACTIVE, Spts C Co FARP 2 ACTIVE. Continues offload of Class V
2200 FARP 1 ACTIVE, Spts A Co FARP 2 ACTIVE. Spts B Co. (phased attack)
F-63
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
F-259. If the FARP site is under attack or under a threat of being overrun,
FARP personnel—
• Stop refueling.
• Evacuate aircraft.
• Disconnect FARP aircraft from the system by disconnecting the 50-
foot pot hose from inside the aircraft and evacuate the aircraft.
• Defend the FARP area or abandon the system and evacuate as
directed.
AIRCRAFT FIRE
F-261. FARP personnel stop refueling at all points, then—
• Turn off all pumps.
• Close all valves.
• Evacuate personnel from the aircraft.
• Attempt to shut down the aircraft.
• Evacuate all other aircraft from the area.
• Fight the fire.
• Notify the higher command.
FUEL LEAKS
F-262. FARP personnel stop refueling at the affected point, then—
• Turn off all pumps.
• Turn off the valves to the leak.
• Repair or replace the affected pieces.
• Open valves and start the pumps.
• Check for additional leaks.
• Proceed with refueling operations.
F-263. Three primary ground vehicles support FARP operations: the M978
HEMTT tanker, M977 HEMTT cargo vehicle, and the M989A1 HEMAT.
F-64
Appendix F
Load Plan 1
Item Quantity Approximated Weight (lbs)
30mm Pallet 2 7,472
RF Hellfire Pallet 4 7,200
Total Weight 14,672
Load Plan 2
Item Quantity Approximated Weight (lbs)
2.75” Rocket Pallet 2 5,032
RF Hellfire Pallet 3 5,400
Total Weight 10,432
Load Plan 3
Item Quantity Approximated Weight (lbs)
RF Hellfire Pallet 2 3,600
30mm Pallet 2 7,472
2.75” Rocket Pallet 2 5,032
Total Weight 16,104
F-65
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
F-66
Appendix F
NIGHT OPERATIONS
F-269. The establishment of a FARP at night requires special considerations.
Movement must be planned in detail and executed in an orderly manner.
Delays will occur because of low-light levels. Light discipline is extremely
important.
F-67
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
NIGHT VISION
F-273. Artificial lights may pose several problems. The FARP will probably
be in total darkness until aircraft arrive. When personnel start working with
lights, their night visual acuity may be impaired. Personnel will be
constantly adjusting from a no-light to a low-light working environment.
Each time that the light level changes, personnel may need time for their
night vision to readapt.
F-274. The glow from a nearby chemical light can disturb a worker’s vision.
Objects may be blurred when looked at closely. Artificial light sources are a
problem because they cannot be placed to adequately illuminate the work and
leave both hands free.
F-275. NVDs may be the best choice for night FARP operations. However,
their use requires extensive training or aircraft turnaround times may
increase.
Disadvantages
F-277. The disadvantages of NVDs for night FARP operations are the
following:
• Objects closer than 10 inches will appear blurred.
• Close workspace around weapon systems may impair the individual’s
efficiency.
• NVDs may not be compatible with current NBC equipment.
• The unit may not have enough NVDs to support both aircrew and
FARP personnel.
F-68
Appendix F
DESERT OPERATIONS
F-278. The desert environment poses many problems for FARP operations.
Adequate water supplies should be available. Aircrews and ground personnel
will perspire profusely. To prevent heat casualties or extensive dehydration,
each individual must drink plenty of water—up to 5 gallons every 24 hours.
Other factors include terrain, mobility, communications, flying techniques,
high-density altitude, and FARE systems.
TERRAIN
F-279. Deserts may consist of many different types of sand. Sand may be as
fine as talcum powder or as coarse as gravel. The type of sand affects off-road
vehicle mobility. In many areas, a crust may form on the surface. If the crust
is dark-colored, the sand is very coarse. In such situations, the light sand has
been blown away, leaving a surface crust that may be hard enough for a
helicopter to land with almost no dust signature.
F-280. The flat terrain and poor relief of the desert create serious
navigational problems. Therefore, FARPs must be established in easily
recognizable positions. The use of offset, low-output NDBs assists in locating
FARP positions. Navigation equipment, such as Doppler, also helps.
F-281. The enemy can observe desert activities from as far away as 10
kilometers. From a vantage point of high ground, the enemy can observe
activity from as far away as 20 kilometers. The FARP will be a target of
opportunity for any enemy pilot who can see it. Without cover and
concealment, the FARP must have AD protection.
MOBILITY
F-282. The best ground vehicles for the desert are the 1-1/4-ton truck, 2-1/2-
ton truck, 5-ton truck, and HEMTT. Most vehicle trailers are unsuitable for
off-road travel except for the HEMAT.
F-283. The easiest and fastest way to establish a FARP in the desert is to
sling load it into position. Two FARE systems oriented into the prevailing
wind and set up in a T-formation (Figure F-44) allow adequate separation
from the turning rotors. This system can support four refueling points. The
FARP should be positioned to facilitate ground vehicle support. This
positioning eases the strain of trying to aerially support the FARP.
F-69
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
COMMUNICATIONS
F-284. Electronic communication capabilities will vary from day to day.
Communicating with an element more than 25 kilometers away may require
a relay station.
FLYING TECHNIQUES
F-285. Aircraft dust signatures are reduced if airspeed is kept above 40
knots. Aircrews should not attempt in-ground-effect hovering. Aircrews
should plan and execute approaches to the ground. Correct desert flying
techniques help the aircrew to maintain visual contact with the ground.
HIGH-DENSITY ALTITUDE
F-286. High-density altitudes that can degrade aircraft performance will
affect most desert operations. In the early morning, when density altitude is
lowest, the UH-60 may be able to carry two full 500-gallon collapsible fuel
drums. By noon, it may be able to carry only one. An attack helicopter may
have to carry less than a full load of ammunition or fuel. Aircrews will
require more frequent trips to the FARP. The FARP must be logistically
prepared for them.
F-70
Appendix F
• Clean small-engine air filters daily with compressed air and replace
weekly.
• Run generators continuously for no more than three to six hours
before they replace it.
WINTER OPERATIONS
F-289. The winter battlefield is characterized by low temperatures, fog,
freezing rain, snow, ice, frozen ground, and at times, muddy ground. FARP
operations are difficult under these conditions. Detailed planning and
training are required to overcome them.
DISPLACEMENT
F-290. Snow, ice, and mud reduce vehicle mobility, complicating ground
displacement. Commanders should plan for aerial displacement when
possible. If ground displacement is necessary, leaders should allow more time
for movement. Breakdown and setup of the FARP take more time on the
winter battlefield than in other environments.
PERSONNEL
F-291. Low temperatures make it difficult for personnel to keep warm and
function. Wind chill caused by rotor wash can result in cold injuries even
when air temperatures are not very cold. Fuel spilled on bare skin or soaked
into clothing has a cooling effect as it evaporates, increasing the probability of
cold injury. Personnel handling cold ammunition need mittens or other
protection and a lighter pair of gloves when manual dexterity is needed to
perform delicate operations. Commanders should ensure that personnel are
equipped and trained to function in a cold environment.
F-71
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
CAMOUFLAGE
F-293. Camouflage can be difficult, particularly where there is complete
snow cover. The use of white covers and snow as camouflage is a possible
solution. The best solution, however, is to avoid open snowfields when
selecting FARP locations. Instead, the FARP should be located near partially
wooded or urban areas. FM 3-58.1 (FM 20-3) describes camouflage
procedures in detail.
ELECTRICAL GROUNDING
F-294. Electrically grounding equipment and aircraft is another problem.
Frozen ground makes the emplacement of grounding rods difficult and
reduces effectiveness of the electrical ground. To emplace a grounding rod, a
hole must be dug, drilled, blasted, or melted and the rod placed in the hole.
To ensure the proper flow of electricity, paper or other absorbent material is
filled in around the rod and then soaked with salt water.
MAINTENANCE
F-295. Maintenance requirements for aircraft and equipment increase on the
winter battlefield. When aircraft icing occurs, FARP personnel may have to
deice the aircraft. In cases of extremely thick ice, a Herman Nelson heater or
aviation ground power unit may be the only effective deicing equipment
available. At times, ammunition can freeze. Deice caps for the Hellfire
missiles are available. They are fitted over the seeker to prevent it from
freezing. Rocket-pod covers also are available. These covers fit snugly over
the rockets, and the rockets can be fired through them. FARP equipment
must be “winterized” with additional antifreeze or low-temperature
lubricants.
SPILL DEFINITIONS
F-296. Broadly defined, a spill is the release of any kind of a petroleum
product or hazardous substance into the environment. Three spill types are
small priming spills, small spills, and large spills:
• A small priming spill covers less than 18 inches in all directions.
• A small spill extends less than 10 feet in any direction, covers less
than 50 square feet, and is not continuous.
F-72
Appendix F
SPILL DISCOVERY
F-299. The initial component in the spill-response plan is discovery. The
primary responsibility of a discoverer is to notify proper authorities, who are
trained and equipped to deal with an environmental incident. Upon
discovery, the discoverers—
• Stop the source of the spill if properly trained to do so and it can be
done safely.
• Begin the notification process.
ASSESSMENT
F-300. During every step of the spill-response process, each responding
individual continually assesses the situation. He makes decisions on the next
appropriate action to be taken. Upon initial discovery, he reports—
• Time and type of incident.
• Name and quantity of spilled material and rate of release.
• Direction of the spill, vapor, or smoke release.
• Fire or explosion possibility.
• Coverage area of spill and the intensity of any fire or explosion.
• Extent of injuries, if any.
• Status of cleanup.
• Whether spill team is on-site or en route.
• Whether spill team is adequate.
• Estimated time to completion.
• Name of on-scene commander and how to contact him.
F-301. The commander or on-site coordinator determines the appropriate
response based on potential risks associated with the spill. He determines
whether an imminent or actual threat exists to human health or the
environment. He notifies appropriate authorities. For example, the on-scene
commander may determine that the spill cleanup is beyond the capability of
F-73
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
the functional area activity that created the spill. He then mobilizes the
response team to control, contain, and clean up any spilled material if—
• The spill could result in the release of flammable or combustible
liquids or vapors, thus causing a fire or gas-explosion hazard.
• The spill could cause the release of toxic liquid or fumes.
• The spill is containable on site but the potential exists for ground
contamination.
• The spill cannot be contained on site, resulting in off-site soil or water
contamination.
TYPE OF SPILL
Small Spill
F-305. For small spills, the responsible unit—
• Stops operations in the area and posts a fireguard.
• Uses an absorbent cleaning agent; if the fuel spills on concrete or a
similar hard surface, after cleaning, place the absorbent material in a
closed metal container for later burning.
• Does not use rags to absorb the spill—if aircraft fuel spills. Fuel may
spill on the ground or on a hard surface away from operational areas;
if so, rope off the spill area until the fuel evaporates and vapors
disperse.
F-74
Appendix F
• Ceases operations; does not allow personnel in the area until the fuel
is vapor-free.
Large Spill
F-306. For large spills the responsible unit—
• Calls the fire department immediately.
• Stops the flow of fuel; after taking all safety precautions, personnel
may consider removing aircraft, refueling vehicles, and personnel
from the spill area.
• Shuts engines off.
• Blankets large fuel spills with foam.
F-307. The fire chief directs subsequent recovery of fuels. He does not use the
area for operations until it is declared free of fuel and fuel vapors.
ADDITIONAL ACTIONS
F-308. If berms or grated trenches did not contain the spill, the responsible
unit establishes an area of isolation. The area size depends on the spill’s size
and the waste removed.
F-309. If the spill produces a toxic vapor cloud, evacuate the area. If large
quantities of volatile (toxic or combustible) materials spill, the responsible
unit evacuates a downwind area at least 500 feet wide and 1,000 feet long.
Contact the Air Weather Service (AWS) for ambient wind speeds and
directions. The AWS will assist the fire chief and commander or on-site
coordinator by providing toxic corridor computations. The responsible unit
should—
• Use pumps or tank trucks to collect as much of the material as
possible.
• Use hay or other absorbent material to absorb oil not collected by
pumping.
• Dispose of contaminated earth and absorbent material as directed by
the environmental officer, commander, or on-site coordinator.
F-75
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
• Secures the accident scene after the area is declared safe and declares
“all clear” following withdrawal, as the situation dictates.
• Coordinates appropriate actions with local civil authorities at the
accident scene.
• Coordinates logistical support, as necessary.
• Informs higher headquarters of the situation and actions taken and
notifies appropriate agencies if unit personnel cannot sufficiently
contain and clean the spill.
ORGANIZATION
F-311. Units establish procedures and response teams to manage
environmental emergencies. The installation or major subordinate command
governs organization and provides training.
TRAINING
F-312. Training includes classroom and emergency-response exercises.
Classroom instruction trains response teams in exposure hazards of
substances that they may encounter during a spill response. Training
exercises focus on actual spill-control and cleanup activities. Team members
receive proper hazardous substance response training to—
• Familiarize them with facility layouts and typical oil and hazardous
substances.
• Use and maintain breathing apparatuses and other equipment.
• Classify hazardous substances and their characteristics.
• Retain spills and recover spilled substances.
• Dispose of contaminated soil, absorbent material, and recovered
pollutants.
• Restore the contaminated area to its former condition.
F-313. Individuals who store, transfer, or employ oil or hazardous substances
require some level of hazard training; recommended training includes—
• Spill procedures and safety concerns.
• Reaction and avoidance of exposure to hazardous substance spills.
• Specific safety requirements and procedures of the work assignment.
F-76
Appendix G
G-1. The A2C2 system is the airspace management component of the Army
Air Ground System (AAGS). It outlines the Army’s integration of airspace
usage and C2 within the framework of the TAGS. These systems, in whole or
in part, are placed in each echelon from maneuver battalion to numbered
army. This appendix summarizes these systems and the communication
mediums used to accelerate the airspace control authority’s objectives. AAGS
is the control system for synchronizing, coordinating, and integrating air
operations. It provides the means to initiate, receive, process, and execute
requests for air support and to disseminate information and intelligence
produced by aerial assets.
G-2. AAGS interfaces with elements from other services to function as a
single entity in planning, coordinating, deconflicting, and integrating air
support operations with ground operations. The Army elements of the AAGS
consist of CPs, FSEs, air defense elements, A2C2, and coordination/liaison
elements (Figure G-1).
SIMULTANEOUS USE
G-3. A2C2 maximizes the simultaneous use of airspace. At decisive moments,
commanders are able to exploit all available combat power—synchronized in
time, space, and purpose. Potential users of the aerial dimension of the
battlefield include not only Army aviation but also AD, MI, FS, and joint and
combined air and ground forces.
FRATRICIDE AVOIDANCE
G-4. Effective airspace management and control minimize the risk of
fratricide and increase overall force effectiveness. The A2C2 system provides
an effective conduit for timely bidirectional communication between the
airspace control authority (ACA) and all friendly airspace users. The air
ATO), published daily by the ACA, directs tactical IFF use and assignments
in each theater, as well as projecting ground combat movements.
G-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
ARFOR
AAMDC XXXX
ADA XXX
NUMBERED
XX CORPS ARMY
AAGS DIV
CP
DOCC CP
FSE
SOCCE
NG REP
FSE ANGLIC AC
2 2
X
BDE
2
AC
2 TACP ASOC
II
CP TACP
BN
FSE ANGPLT
CP
2 2
AC*
FSE
TACP
2 *
A C2 2 2 2 2
A C * - ad hoc elements perform A C functions at US Army battalion
2 2
TACP and brigade levels. Currently no formal TOE A C organization exists
at these levels. The proliferation of airspace platforms and users may
compel formal organizational changes.
AIR DEFENSE
G-6. AD protects the force and selected geopolitical assets from aerial attack,
missile attack, and surveillance. Air defense forces use both positive and
procedural means of fire control. Integration and airspace control are
imperative to ensure safe, unencumbered passage of friendly aircraft while
denying access to enemy aircraft and missiles. AD units require automated
transfer of airspace information via the airspace control order (ACO) and
ATO. AD units provide near-real-time airspace SA using organic and
integrated joint sensors at all echelons.
AVIATION
G-7. Army aviation combat, CS, and CSS operations are generally conducted
in the terrain-flight dimension of the battlefield, which is fundamentally
linked to it at all echelons. A2C2 planning should allow complete flexibility for
Army aviation units operating below the coordination altitude.
G-2
Appendix G
FIELD ARTILLERY
G-8. FA uses airspace to deliver indirect fires through airspace from
extremely low to very high altitudes. Personnel in the FSEs, from company
through corps, have the principal means for deconflicting FS with other
airspace users.
MILITARY INTELLIGENCE
G-10. MI aircraft and UAVs conduct intelligence collection and target
acquisition missions. These platforms may use low-altitude airspace normally
allotted to the land component commander (LCC). However, they normally
conduct missions in upper-altitude airspace procedurally allotted to the air
component commander. The ATO and ACO include these upper-altitude
missions. However, commanders often direct these flexible, highly responsive
assets to perform immediate missions not in the ATO or ACO. The A2C2
system must provide a real-time conduit to acquire airspace for immediate
missions. The system must also be capable of displaying real-time, three-
dimensional locations of MI airborne platforms.
AEROMEDICAL SUPPORT
G-11. Aeromedical evacuation units provide 24-hour support within the AO.
To ensure rapid response to evacuation requests, aeromedical units provide a
coordinating element as part of the A2C2 system. This coordinating element
provides the interface necessary to complete time-sensitive airspace requests
with limited aeromedical assets. The A2C2 system provides the
communications means to coordinate with aircraft conducting the mission
because airspace clearance may occur in flight.
SPECIAL OPERATIONS
G-12. By design, SOFs deploy quickly in small, low-profile units to specific
regions or theaters of operations. The presence and number of other U.S.
forces in theater usually dictate the method of airspace deconfliction. Special
operations ground forces often operate beyond normal friendly troop
concentrations. Missions deep within enemy territory demand A2C2 systems
capable of restrictive battle space control measures to avoid fratricide.
AIRBORNE OPERATIONS
G-13. Airborne units require many of the same A2C2 considerations as
aviation and SOFs. They require airspace control measures to provide entry
and exit routes and ROAs to deconflict airspace from aircraft not directly
involved in the operation. The ground phase requires substantial
deconfliction of battle space. Once employed, these forces are often in areas
G-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
beyond the normal concentration of forces—near free-fire areas for FA, other
fires, and effects of those fires.
INFANTRY OPERATIONS
G-14. As with FA indirect fires, infantry mortars require battle space
deconfliction.
G-4
Appendix G
G-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
force, the brigade may receive TACPs and theater airlift liaison officers
(TALOs) to assist in mission planning.
G-24. Brigades and battalions do not have direct A2C2 support. Therefore,
existing staff personnel, LNOs, and FS representatives must perform the
A2C2 function supervised by the S3 Air.
G-25. The battalion S3 Air submits airspace control means requests to the
brigade A2C2 element for processing and forwarding. ADA, FA, MI, and
aviation battalions must receive and implement ACOs and ATOs.
G-28. The airspace control plan, ACO, and ATO are the foundations of
airspace operations in the joint environment. Airspace control must
effectively allow combat operations without adding undue restrictions or
adversely affecting the capabilities of any service or functional component.
G-6
Appendix G
control area, planners must address coordination procedures for all airspace
users. Implementation of the airspace control plan is through the ACO, which
all components must comply with.
G-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
but each ATO period usually covers a 24-hour period. The ATO that is being
built today will refer to past ATOs and project into the future. Any plans or
subplans that were built yesterday will be used as a starting point or
reference point for the plan that is being built for tomorrow. For example, to
build the next airspace control plan, planners will refer to the current
airspace control plan (Figure G-3).
MAAP A
JCB A JIPTL A SEND A FLY A ASSESS A
ATO A
MAAP B
JCB B JIPTL B SEND B FLY B ASSESS B
ATO B
MAAP C
JCB C JIPTL C SEND C FLY C ASSESS C
ATO C
MAAP D
JCB D JIPTL D SEND D FLY D ASSESS D
ATO D
JCB E
SPECIAL INSTRUCTIONS
G-35. Special instructions are normally included as part of the
“combined/general unit remarks” in a free text format that highlights,
modifies or supplements mission data contained in other portions of the ATO.
SPINS, includes eclectic supplemental information that will not fit into other
mission formats. As a general rule, SPINS are valid until they are rescinded
or superseded. In some theaters, SPINS are published as a separate message
because of their length.
G-36. ATO and SPINS are formatted using basic United States Message Test
Format (USMTF) procedures and organized using alphanumeric section
designators. Although SPINS are formatted using standardized procedures,
their appearance varies according to the theater requirements and command
directives. Special instructions cover a variety of mission planning
considerations, to include the following:
• Airspace.
• Range times.
• Frequencies.
• Control agencies.
• IFF/selective identification feature (SIF).
G-8
Appendix G
G-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
SPINS INDEX:
1. RANGE TIMES/MODE 3.
2. PACKAGE COMMANDERS.
3. LIVE ORDNANCE.
4. IFF/SIF.
5. COMMUNICATIONS PLAN.
6. GENERAL.
7. OPERATIONAL RESTRICTIONS.
8. AIRSPACE CONTROL ORDER.
1. RANGE TIMES/MODE 3:
RANGE RESTRICTIONS: ALL TIMES ARE ZULU MODE 3:
CHARACTERS THREE AND FOUR (XX) ARE YOUR CALL SIGN
NUMBER.
A. CAL: 1445-1800
B. RANGE 71 OPEN: 1500-1800
C. RANGE 76 OPEN: 1510-1800
ETC...
2. MISSION COMMANDERS:
MISSION MSN UNIT ROOM PHONE
A29131 INT 31FW 56 22104
A29242 CAS 354FW 51 22103
A29151 OCA 33FW 45 27094
G-10
Appendix G
G-11
Appendix H
SECTION I – PURPOSE
INTRODUCTION
H-1. UAVs operate anywhere on the battlefield to include forward of the
FLOT. They can operate at night and in limited adverse weather conditions
when equipped with the proper sensors. UAVs are an excellent intelligence
asset that provides the commander with near-real-time reconnaissance and
battlefield surveillance without major risk to personnel. They also give
commanders a dedicated, rapidly taskable asset that can look wide as well as
deep. During a mission, new targets may arise and the commander can
redirect a UAV to a different mission or area in real time. Some models also
can conduct operations other than reconnaissance such as laser designation
and attack.
SINGLE-SITE OPERATIONS
H-3. Single-site operations facilitate command, control, communications (C3),
and logistics support. However, adding the UAV element to a brigade TOC
creates a greater electronic and physical signature.
SPLIT-SITE OPERATIONS
H-4. In split-site operations, the UAV element is split into two distinct sites:
the mission planning and control site (MPCS) and the launch and recovery
(L/R) site.
H-0
Appendix H
EMPLOYMENT
H-7. The UAV provides near-real-time reconnaissance, surveillance, and
target acquisition (RSTA). It may be employed forward of the FLOT, on the
flanks, or in rear areas. When employed together, UAVs and aeroscouts
provide excellent reconnaissance resolution. The commander also may use
UAVs to determine the best locations to employ air reconnaissance assets or
to observe selected areas, thus freeing aeroscouts to focus efforts where
contact is most likely. UAVs can be fitted with laser designators that can
mark targets. They can also be armed. The commander can also employ
UAVs to—
• Support in a separate economy-of-force mode or in teamed
arrangements with manned aircraft.
• Support target acquisition efforts and lethal attacks on enemy
reconnaissance and advance forces.
H-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
CAPABILITIES
H-8. UAVs equipped with day television or IR sensor packages can
reconnoiter air routes, LZs, and objectives before and during all types of
tactical operations. UAVs may precede any element, to include vehicle or
aircraft security elements, to provide early warning, reaction time, or target
servicing. Current capabilities allow the UAV to distinguish between
different types of vehicles at about 6,000 feet above ground level (AGL) and to
detect vehicles at altitudes as high as 32,000 feet AGL.
RISK REDUCTION
H-9. The UAV provides an airborne targeting and surveillance asset that
does not expose personnel to risk. UAVs of other services provide additional
support. Those UAVs will sometimes have greater range, altitude, and
endurance capabilities.
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
H-10. The Tactical Control System (TCS) (software, hardware, and extra
ground support hardware) is the data link through which UAVs interface
with the JSTARS and other joint and combined systems.
DETECTION
H-11. Currently, tactical UAVs are extremely difficult for enemy AD systems
to detect and engage. Enemy radars are designed to detect much faster
moving aircraft and tend to skip over these slow-flying platforms. If detected,
the composite airframes provide very small radar cross sections. IR-guided
surface-to-air missile (SAM) systems have difficulty getting a positive lock on
the small power plants and, in most cases, cannot engage them. The low
visual and acoustic signatures of UAVs make them an attractive platform for
stealth reconnaissance. Tactical UAVs have less than a 10-percent chance of
detection by the unaided human eye when operating as low as 3,000 feet
AGL.
SPECIAL CONSIDERATIONS
H-12. Even UAVs with degraded mission packages can disrupt enemy
operations. Enemy concerns about UAV activity cause frequent movement
and tend to lead to increased radio traffic from which intelligence data can be
generated. Frequent movement disrupts the enemy force’s ability to conduct
H-2
Appendix H
coordinated operations, strains its logistical system, and degrades its physical
and mental endurance.
LIMITATIONS
H-13. The UAV is less effective in locating enemy forces that are well
covered or concealed. Tactical UAVs are not well suited for wide area
searches; rather, their capabilities are enhanced when they are employed as
part of an overall collection plan. Like manned aircraft, they are vulnerable
to enemy AD systems and they have weather restrictions.
OPERATIONS
H-14. The UAV provides an airborne targeting, surveillance, and
retransmission asset that does not expose personnel to risk. UAV
employment may include teaming with aviation combat platforms.
NONLINEAR BATTLEFIELD
H-17. A nonlinear, expanded battlefield may routinely create gaps between
friendly units. Reconnaissance of these gaps is an excellent mission for the
UAV.
H-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
GENERAL
H-20. This section provides general characteristics and capabilities of
currently fielded and developmental models. UAVs generally are categorized
as tactical or endurance, based on capable range.
H-4
Appendix H
H-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
H-6
Appendix H
system will be able to survey, in one day, an area equivalent to the State of
Illinois (40,000 square miles), while providing imagery with a three-foot
resolution. The large radius gives the commanders much flexibility in
choosing an operating location, to include out-of-theater operations. This
UAV can perform persistent tracking of critical targets, loitering over the
target area for more than 24 hours and providing high-quality images in all
weather conditions. It is employed in low-to-moderate risk areas to look into
high-threat areas. The Global Hawk has a conventional aircraft design that is
easily visible on radar screens; therefore, survivability is derived from its
very high operating altitude and self-defense measures. It is equipped with a
threat warning receiver and a threat deception system, which includes
onboard radar jammers and expendable decoys. Differential GPS and
advanced control technology will allow the UAV to be virtually autonomous,
handling take-offs on its own. It communicates through SATCOM and LOS.
It requires a 5,000-foot runway for takeoff. The dimensions of this UAV are
the following:
• Wing-116.2 feet.
• Length-44.4 feet.
• Height-15.2 feet.
• Takeoff weight-25,600 pounds.
H-32. Key operational factors are the following:
• Has a SAR and an EO and IR sensor.
• Is self-deployable.
• Requires multiple C-141, C-17, or C-5 sorties for GSE.
• Attains a maximum altitude of 65,000 feet.
• Has an operational radius of 5,500 kilometers.
• Maintains a cruise speed of 350 knots.
• Has operation endurance greater than 40 hours.
H-7
Appendix I
Aircraft Characteristics
This appendix provides an overview of the basic characteristics and
capabilities of aircraft organic to the various aviation brigades—or that
may be available in an aviation task force organization.
I-1. The primary missions of this aircraft are armed reconnaissance and light
attack. The OH-58D discussed herein is the version addressed with
affectivity code “R” in TM 1-1520-248-10.
DESCRIPTION
I-2. The OH-58D is a single-engine, dual-seat, armed observation aircraft. It
has an improved master controller processing unit (IMCPU) system that
provides highly integrated communication, navigation, aircraft, and mission
equipment subsystems. The VIXL can store compressed images in memory
and enables transmission of video images between aircraft. The mast-
mounted sight contains a suite of sensors that include a high-resolution
television camera, IR thermal imaging, a laser rangefinder, and a laser
designator. It is also equipped with a videotape recorder.
SPECIFICATIONS
I-3. Table I-1 outlines OH-58D aircraft specifications.
Table I-1. OH-58D Specifications
Length 41'2.4”
Height 12'10.6”
Fuselage width (with weapons 9'2”
pylons)
Main rotor diameter 35'
Maximum gross weight 5,500 pounds (5,200 pounds by Interim Statement of Airworthiness
Qualification (ISAQ).
Cruise airspeed 100 knots (varies with environmental/mission conditions)
Combat radius 120 kilometers (varies with environmental/mission conditions)
CAPABILITIES
I-4. The OH-58D provides the following:
• Day, night, battlefield obscurant, and limited adverse-weather
fighting capabilities.
I-0
Appendix I
• Data transfer system that permits upload from AMPS data transfer
cartridge and download of selected postmission data.
• Countermeasure suite of IR jammers, radar warning receivers, and
laser warning detectors.
• Moving map display.
• Video recording and cockpit playback of television and thermal
imagery from the mission.
• Advanced navigation and mission planning equipment; transportable
in the C-130, C-141, C-5, and C-17.
ARMAMENT SYSTEMS
I-5. The OH-58D armament capabilities consist of a .50-caliber machine gun,
2.75-inch rockets, Hellfire missiles, and air-to-air missiles. These systems are
mounted on two universal weapons pylons. The aircraft has a laser
rangefinder/designator used to designate for the weapons system as well as
provide range-to-target information for onboard weapons systems.
HELLFIRE MISSILE
I-8. The SAL Hellfire is used primarily for the destruction of tanks, armored
vehicles, and other hard-material targets. The OH-58D can carry two
two-missile launchers for a maximum of four missiles. However, weight
restrictions usually restrict the aircraft to just one launcher. The minimum
engagement range is 500 meters; the maximum range is 8,000 meters. Laser
designation may be autonomous or remote.
I-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
ARMAMENT CONFIGURATIONS
I-10. Figure I-1 illustrates an example of mission load configurations. Only
one system at a time may be mounted per side.
COMMUNICATIONS
I-11. The OH-58D has the following communications systems:
• Up to three AN/ARC-186 provide VHF-FM 1 (30- to 87.975-megahertz)
and FM 2 (if installed) and VHF-AM (116- to 151.975-megahertz)
secure communication when employed with KY-58.
• The AN/ARC-164 Have Quick II provides antijam frequency-hopping
UHF-AM communications in the 225- to 399.975-megahertz range in
25-kilohertz intervals.
• The OH-58D may have the AN/ARC-201 SINCGARS, which requires
KY-58 interface for secure communications, or 201D SINCGARS with
embedded encryption and data capability; both operate in the 30- to
87.975-megahertz frequency range and have antijam, frequency-
hopping capability.
• The IDM transfers digital messages.
• The KY-58 provides secure communications for SINCGARS, Have
Quick II, and VHF-AM/FM radios.
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
I-12. The Embedded Global Positioning System Inertial Navigation System
(EGI) is a self-contained, all-attitude navigation system that works with the
radar altimeter and laser rangefinder/designator. Its embedded GPS receiver
(EGR) supports the pure GPS and blended GPS/Inertial Navigation System
(INS) solutions. The system is capable of storing waypoint and target
information for making flight plan routes and changing these routes as a
mission may change. EGI also provides target location in longitude and
I-2
Appendix I
LIMITATIONS
I-14. The following are limitations of the OH-58D:
• IR Crossover. The thermal imaging sensor operates by determining
temperature differentials; when targets and their surroundings reach
the same temperature, target detection degrades.
• Obscurants. Some obscurants (such as dust, rain, haze, or smoke) can
keep laser energy from reaching the target and can hide the target
from the incoming munitions seeker.
• Low Cloud Ceilings. Consideration must be given to cloud ceilings to
determine maximum employment range of the SAL Hellfire.
Depending on the distance to target, trajectory mode selected, and
lasing techniques, the missile may climb into low cloud ceilings,
causing the seeker to break track from the laser spot or preventing the
seeker from acquiring the laser spot.
• Hellfire Remote Designation Constraints. The designating crew may
offset a maximum of 60 degrees from the gun-to-target line and must
not position its aircraft within a +30-degree safety fan from the firing
aircraft.
• IMC. The Kiowa Warrior is not certified for instrument flight rules
(IFR) operations.
DESCRIPTION
I-16. The AH-64A is a twin-engine, tandem-seat, aerial weapons platform. It
is equipped with a target acquisition designation sight (TADS), laser range
finder/designator (LRF/D), and a pilot night vision sensor (PNVS) that allow
the two-man crew to navigate and attack at night and in adverse weather
conditions at extended standoff ranges. The Apache has a full range of
aircraft survivability equipment and can withstand hits from rounds as large
23 millimeters in critical areas.
I-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
SPECIFICATIONS
I-17. Section III contains aircraft specifications and comparison to AH-64D
specifications.
CAPABILITIES
I-18. The AH-64A provides the following:
• Precision attacks during the day, at night, or in adverse weather or
when the battlefield is obscured.
• Wide array of firepower options.
• Robust suite of electronic warfare systems.
• Lethal suppression of enemy air defenses.
• Data transfer system to upload from the AMPS data transfer
cartridge and download postmission data.
I-4
Appendix I
HELLFIRE MISSILE
I-22. The Hellfire is used primarily to destroy tanks, armored vehicles, and
other hard-material targets. The AH-64A is capable of firing only the SAL
Hellfire missile. SAL missiles can defeat any known armor. The minimum
engagement range is 500 meters, and the maximum range is 8,000 meters.
The maximum aircraft load is 16 missiles. Laser target designation may be
autonomous or remote.
MISSION CONFIGURATIONS
I-23. Table I-2 shows AH-64A mission profiles and typical ammunition loads.
Table I-2. AH-64A Mission Profiles/Typical Loads
Mission Hellfire 30mm Hydra 2.75
Attack 16 1,200
Movement to 8 1,200 38
Contact
Screen 8 1,200 19
COMMUNICATIONS
I-24. The AH-64A has the following communications systems:
• Radio set AN/ARC-186(V) is a VHF-FM/AM transceiver that provides
clear and secure voice communication capability at frequencies in the
VHF-AM and -FM bands.
• The AN/ARC-164 Have Quick II system is a UHF-AM radio
transmitter-receiver set that provides an antijam, frequency-hopping
capability.
• The AN/ARC-201D is an airborne VHF-FM transceiver and part of the
SINCGARS family of radios; it has an antijam, frequency-hopping
mode of operation. The radio set provides secure or plain voice
communications over the frequency range of 30- to 87.975-megahertz
at 25-kilohertz intervals. When used with the TSEC/KY-58 voice
security system, the radio set can transmit and receive clear voice or
cipher-mode communications.
• The AN/ARC-220 HF radio provides NOE long-range communications
in the 2- to 29.999-megahertz range and secure mode when employed
with the KY-100.
• The TSEC/KY-100 provides secure communications for the AN/ARC-
220 HF radio.
• The TSEC/KY-58 interfaces with the AN/ARC-186 and AN/ARC-201
radios to provide secure voice for these radios.
I-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
NAVIGATION SYSTEMS
I-25. The navigation systems of the AH-64A are divided into two major
groupings: stand-alone radio NAVAIDs—a nonintegrated navigation
system—and an integrated navigation system. The stand-alone aids consist
of the AN/ARN-89 or the AN/ARN-149(V)3 automatic direction finder (ADF)
sets. The integrated navigation system consists of the EGI unit, the air data
sensor subsystem (ADSS), the heading and attitude reference system
(HARS), the AN/ASN-137 DNS, the IP-1552G computer display unit (CDU),
and the navigation software module in the FCC.
LIMITATIONS
I-27. The following are limitations of the AH-64A:
• Threat Identification. Threat identification through the FLIR system
is extremely difficult; although the crew can easily find the heat
signature of a vehicle, it may not be able to determine whether it is
friend or foe.
• IR Crossover. The thermal imaging sensor and PNVS operate by
determining temperature differentials. When targets and their
surroundings reach the same temperature (normally twice a day),
target detection is degraded; these conditions also make flight while
using the FLIR sensor difficult.
• Obscurants. Some obscurants (such as dust, rain, haze, or smoke) can
prevent laser energy from reaching the target and can hide the target
from the incoming munitions seeker for SAL Hellfire and prevent
effective use of FLIR systems.
• Low Cloud Ceilings. Consideration must be given to cloud ceilings to
determine maximum employment range of the SAL Hellfire.
Depending on the range to target, trajectory mode selected, and lasing
techniques, the missile may climb into low cloud ceilings, causing the
seeker to break track from the laser spot or preventing the seeker
from acquiring the laser spot.
• SAL Hellfire Remote Designation Constraints. The designating crew
may offset a maximum of 60 degrees from the gun-to-target line and
must not position its aircraft within a +30-degree safety fan from the
firing aircraft.
I-6
Appendix I
DESCRIPTION
I-29. The AH-64D is a remanufactured AH-64A (Section II of this appendix).
Its improved navigation system integrates dual INS/GPS and Doppler radar
for acceleration cueing. Some D models are equipped with a millimeter wave
FCR that allows the helicopter to identify, classify, prioritize, and track
targets out to the maximum range of the Hellfire weapon system. (See Table
I-3 below.)
WITH RADAR
I-30. Apaches equipped with the Longbow system are denoted as either AH-
64D with radar, AH-64D Longbow, or LBA. The LBA helicopter is equipped
with FCR, radar frequency interferometer (RFI), and upgraded 701C engines
to compensate for the additional weight of the Longbow system. The Longbow
system is integrated with the TADS to allow simultaneous and autonomous
operation of the TADS and the FCR.
WITHOUT RADAR
I-31. The AH-64D without radar includes all of the above LBA aircraft
upgrades except the FCR and the RFI system and their associated black
boxes. The aircraft may not have the improved 701C engine installed. The
AH-64D without radar can be converted to an AH-64D with radar, with the
installation of the Longbow system and 701C engines. The AH-64D without
radar can fire the RF Hellfire missile autonomously (with LOS to the target)
or by using FCR targeting data handed over from an AH-64D with radar.
SPECIFICATIONS
I-32. Table I-3 compares AH-64A/D specifications.
Table I-3. Comparison of Apache Specifications
AH-64D w/o AH-64D
Model AH-64A
Radar Longbow
Length (feet) 57.67 57.67 57.67
Height (feet) 15.25 13.33 16.08
Width (feet) 17.17 15.50 15.05
Main Rotor Span (feet) 48 48 48
Max Gross Weight
21,000 23,000 23,000
(pounds)
Cruise Speed (knots) 120* 130* 30*
Combat Radius (km) 200* 200 200
Combat Radius With
One 230-Gallon Aux Fuel 350* 350* 350*
Tank (km)
Self-Deployability Yes Yes Yes
* Varies with a multitude of factors such as temperature, wind, gross weight, and mission-specific time requirements.
I-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
CAPABILITIES
I-33. The AH-64D provides the following:
• Precision attacks during day or night, in adverse weather, or when the
battlefield is obscured (Longbow).
• Wide array of firepower options.
• Detection, classification, and prioritization of stationary and moving
ground and airborne targets (Longbow).
• Robust suite of electronic warfare systems.
• Lethal destruction of enemy air defenses (DEAD).
• Real-time SA and intelligence of the battlefield to the digitized
aviation/ground commander; data transfer system to upload from the
AMPS data-transfer cartridge and download postmission data.
• High-frequency radio for NOE long-distance NLOS communications.
ARMAMENT SYSTEMS
I-34. The Longbow system enhances the rapid employment of all available
weapons including Hellfire missiles, air-to-air missiles (future capability),
aerial rocket system, and the 30-millimeter cannon. Once the FCR detects,
classifies, and prioritizes targets, the gunner selects the desired weapon for
the attack and the data is automatically transferred to the weapon and
displayed on the selected weapon sight.
I-8
Appendix I
HELLFIRE MISSILE
I-37. The Hellfire is used primarily for the destruction of tanks, armored
vehicles, and other hard material targets. The AH-64D retains the capability
to fire SAL Hellfire. Hellfire missiles (SAL and RF) can defeat any known
armor. The minimum engagement range is 500 meters, and the maximum
range is 8,000 meters. The maximum aircraft load is 16 missiles.
MISSION CONFIGURATIONS
I-40. Table I-4 is a matrix of AH-64D mission profiles and typical
ammunition loads (weight limits may require a reduction in mission loads).
Table I-4. AH-64D Mission Profiles/Typical Loads
Hydra 2.75-
Hellfire
Mission 30mm inch Aux Tank
RF/SAL
Rockets
12/4 300 No
Attack 12/4 300 Internal
8/4 300 External
4/4 300 38 No
Movement to
4/4 300 38 Internal
Contact
4/4 300 19 External
8/4 300 19 No
Screen 8/4 300 19 Internal
4/4 300 19 External
FIRE-CONTROL RADAR
I-41. The Longbow system consists of an integrated millimeter wave FCR,
along with an RFI. The FCR enables LBA helicopters to detect, classify,
prioritize, and engage targets with RF Hellfire missiles without visually
acquiring the target. LBA crews may also employ the RF Hellfire missile
during poor visibility when laser, optical, and FLIR sensors are degraded.
The RFI can detect and identify radar systems and display targeting
information on the same screen as the information from the FCR. The FCR
will not identify friend or foe, other than AD weapons, which are identifiable
by their distinctive radar signatures detected by the RFI system.
I-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
COMMUNICATIONS
I-42. The AH-64D has the following communication systems:
• The AN/ARC-186 (V) provides VHF-AM/FM communications in the
frequency ranges of 30 to 87.975 megahertz and 116 to 151.975
megahertz; the radio is primarily for administrative communications
with ATS but can function as an FM 3.
• The ARC-164 Have Quick II provides UHF communications and
includes antijam, frequency-hopping capability; it is normally
employed for internal air-to-air and air-to-TOC communications and
for communicating with the air components of other services. When
used with the KY-58, the radio provides secure communications.
• Two AN/ARC-201D radios provide VHF-FM secure communications in
the 30- to 87.975-megahertz frequency range for communications
internally and with ground units.
• The AN/ARC-220 HF provides high-frequency, NOE long-range
communication with the AN/ARC-100 in the TOC and with other HF
receivers.
• The IDM transfers digital messages.
NAVIGATION SYSTEMS
I-43. The navigation subsystem consists of the following major components:
• EGI (primary and backup).
• Doppler radar velocity sensor.
• Radar altimeter.
• ADF.
• High integrated air data computer.
• Flight management computer.
LIMITATIONS
I-45. The following are limitations of the AH-64D:
• Threat Identification. Threat identification through the FLIR system
is extremely difficult; although the crew can easily find the heat
signature of a vehicle, it may not be able to determine whether it is
friend or foe. In addition, the FCR will not identify friend or foe, other
than radar air defense weapons, which are identifiable by their
distinctive signatures detected by the RFI system.
• IR Crossover. The thermal imaging sensor and PNVS operate by
determining temperature differentials; when targets and their
surroundings reach the same temperature (normally twice a day),
target detection is degraded. These conditions also make flight while
using the FLIR sensor difficult.
I-10
Appendix I
I-46. The primary missions of this aircraft are air assault, air movement, C2,
casualty evacuation, and aerial delivery of mines. Other roles include CSAR,
aircraft recovery, parachute operations, disaster relief, and fire fighting.
UH-60A/L DESCRIPTION
I-47. The UH-60A/L is a twin-engine, dual-seat, utility helicopter. The
minimum required crew is a pilot and copilot. It is designed to carry 11
combat-loaded air assault troops (seats installed). It can move a 105-
millimeter howitzer and 30 rounds of ammunition. The UH-60A/L is
equipped with a full instrument package and is certified for instrument
meteorological conditions as well as day and NVG operations. In addition to
its basic configuration, the UH-60A/L includes kit installations that provide
the capability for rescue hoist, extended-range fuel, and casualty evacuation
operations. The UH-60L is powered by upgraded engines and has an
improved durability gearbox.
SPECIFICATIONS
I-48. Table I-5 gives UH-60A/L aircraft specifications.
I-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
CAPABILITIES
I-49. The UH-60A/L provides the following:
• Countermeasure suite of IR jammers, radar warning receivers, and
laser-warning detectors.
• Data-transfer system to upload from the AMPS data-transfer
cartridge and download postmission data.
• Internal transport of 11 combat-loaded troops with seats installed and
16 combat-loaded troops with seats removed.
• MEDEVAC of six litter patients.
• Self-deployable range of 558 NM with the ERFS, with 30-minute
reserve.
• Transportable in the C-5 and C-17 aircraft.
• Shipboard compatibility for joint and combined operations.
ARMAMENT SUBSYSTEMS
I-50. The Black Hawk has provisions for door mounting of two M60D 7.62-
millimeter machine guns. The subsystem is pintle-mounted in each gunner’s
window at the forward end of the cabin section. The two M60D 7.62-
millimeter machine guns are free pointing but limited in traverse, elevation,
and depression.
AIR VOLCANO
I-51. The air Volcano is a helicopter-mounted, automated, scatterable mine-
delivery system that can deliver mines day or night. The system can dispense
mines during day/night. The system can rapidly emplace a 278-meter, 557-
meter, or 1,115- by 140-meter field at up to 960 mines (800 antitank and 160
antipersonnel) per sortie. The antitank density yields an 80 percent chance of
encounter. Mines can be set to self destruct after 4 hours, 48 hours, or 15
days. FM 3-34.32 (FM 20-32) addresses Volcano operations.
I-12
Appendix I
LIMITATIONS
I-52. The air Volcano system has limitations:
• The UH-60 with air Volcano mounted, a full crew, and one system
operator will be at high gross weight, which reduces range and
maneuverability.
• Minefield emplacement is conducted at low airspeeds (80 knots or
less), making the aircraft more vulnerable to detection and
engagement.
• The crew cannot operate the M60D machine gun with the air Volcano
installed.
• System installation requires about four hours.
• These systems require two five-ton cargo trucks for transport; it is an
engineer responsibility to provide transportation assets to move these
systems.
TYPES OF MINEFIELDS
I-53. Four types of minefields can by emplaced using Volcano—disrupt, fix,
turn, and block. Figure I-2 illustrates emplacement techniques.
Figure I-2. Disrupt and Fix (Left), Turn and Block (Right)
COMMUNICATIONS
I-54. The UH-60D has the following communications systems:
• The AN/ARC-186 provides two-way voice communications in both the
VHF-AM-FM ranges. It provides VHS-AM ATS communications, but
it can function as an FM 2.
• The AN/ARC-164 (V) Have Quick II provides two-way voice
communications in the UHF-AM frequency range of 225 to 399.975
megahertz; the sets provide an antijam frequency-hopping capability.
• The AN/ARC-201 (SINCGARS) is a VHS-FM antijam frequency-
hopping radio, providing communications in the 30- to
87.975-megahertz frequency range at 25-kilohertz intervals.
• The AN/ARC-220 HF radio provides NOE, long-range communication
with the AN/ARC-100 in the TOC and with other HF receivers.
• The TSEC/KY-58 interfaces with the ARC-186 (V), Have Quick, and
SINCGARS radios to provide secure communications.
I-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
NAVIGATION SYSTEMS
I-55. The UH-60A/L has the following navigation systems:
• The ASN-128B Doppler/GPS navigation set provides present position
or destination navigation information in latitude and longitude or
MGRS coordinates.
• The AN/ARN-89 or AN/ARN-149 (V) provides automatic
direction-finding capability for instrument navigation and approach.
• The AN/ARN-123 (V) or AN/ARN-147 (V) VOR/LOC/GS/MB receiving
sets provide instrument navigation and approach.
LIMITATIONS
I-58. The following are limitations of the UH-60A/L aircraft:
• UH-60A/L aircrews employ AN/AVS-6 NVG that lack the same night
capabilities as FLIR systems in AH-64 aircraft.
• UH-60A/L aircraft are instrument-certified but cannot operate in all
environmental conditions, depending on threat and navigational aid
availability.
• Aircraft equipped with extended-range fuel tanks may not offer the
same accessibility to the aircraft cabin for loading; self-defense
machine guns have a limited range of motion when ERFS kits are
installed.
I-14
Appendix I
DESCRIPTION
I-61. The HH-60L is a twin-engine, dual-seat, utility helicopter. The
minimum required crew is a pilot and copilot. For aerial MEDEVAC
missions, the crew includes up to three medical attendants. The HH-60L is
equipped with a full instrument package and can conduct operations in
day/night/NVG and instrument meteorological conditions. In addition to the
basic configuration, the HH-60L includes a nose-mounted FLIR and kit
installations that allow for rescue hoist, extended range fuel, and MEDEVAC
operations.
SPECIFICATIONS
I-62. Table I-6 outlines HH-60L aircraft specifications.
Table I-6. HH-60L Specifications
Length 64'10” rotors turning, 41'4” rotors/pylon folded
Height 12'4” center hub, 16'10” tail rotor
Width 9'8.6” main landing gear, 14'4” stabilator
Main rotor and tail rotor diameter 53'8” main rotor, 11' tail rotor at 20-degree angle
Cabin floor and door dimensions 73” wide x 151” long, 69” wide x 54.5” high
Maximum gross weight 22,000 pounds.
Rescue hoist/cargo hook max weights 600 pounds rescue hoist; 8,000 pounds, cargo hook
Maximum range with ERFS 630 NM w/400 pound reserve
Patient capacity 6 litter or 6 seated
Crew capacity 2 pilots, 1 crew chief, 3 medical attendants
Fuel capacity 360 gallons and additional 460 gallons. w/ERFS
CAPABILITIES
I-63. The HH-60L provides the following:
• Transport of six litter patients and two medical attendants.
• Transport of six seated patients and two medical attendants.
• Transport of internally and externally loaded medical supplies.
• Transport of medical teams.
ARMAMENT
I-64. The HH-60L is an unarmed aircraft.
COMMUNICATIONS
I-65. The HH-60L has the following communication systems:
• The AN/ARC-201 (SINCGARS) provides VHF-FM communications in
the 30- to 87.975-megahertz frequency range and has antijam,
frequency-hopping capability.
• The AN/ARC-222 provides VHF-AM/FM communications and a
maritime capability.
I-15
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
NAVIGATION SYSTEMS
I-66. The HH-60L has the following navigation systems:
• AN/ARN-149 ADF.
• AN-ARN-147 VOR/LOC/GS/MB receiving set.
• AN/ASN 128B Doppler/GPS navigation set.
• AN/ASN 153 (V) TACAN.
LIMITATIONS
I-69. The following are limitations of the HH-60L aircraft:
• HH-60L aircrews employ AN/AVS-6 NVG that lack the same night
capabilities as FLIR systems in AH-64 aircraft; the HH-60L FLIR is
for mission detection of soldiers to be evacuated. It is not compatible
for flying the aircraft.
• HH-60L aircraft are instrument certified but cannot operate in all
environmental conditions, depending on threat and navigational aid
availability.
• Aircraft equipped with extended-range fuel tanks may not offer the
same accessibility to the aircraft cabin for loading.
I-70. The primary missions of this aircraft are air assault, artillery raids,
and air movement of troops, cargo, and weapons. Other roles include CSAR,
casualty evacuation, aircraft recovery, parachute operations, disaster relief,
fire fighting, and heavy construction.
I-16
Appendix I
DESCRIPTION
I-71. The CH-47D is a twin-turbine engine, tandem-rotor helicopter. The
minimum crew required to fly it is a pilot, copilot, and flight engineer.
Additional crew members, as required, may be added at the discretion of the
commander. Tactical missions normally require the addition of one or two
crew chiefs.
SPECIFICATIONS
I-72. Table I-7 outlines CH-47D specifications.
Table I-7. CH-47D Specifications
Length 98.9’
Height 18.9’
Fuselage width 12.4’
Main rotor span 60’
Cargo space 1,500 cu ft
Floor space 225 sq ft
Maximum gross weight 50,000 pounds
Max load for forward and aft hooks 17,000 pounds
Max tandem load for forward and aft hooks 25,000 pounds
Max load for center hook 26,000 pounds
Cruise airspeed 130* knots
Max continuous airspeed 170* knots
Combat radius (16,000 lb cargo) 50* NM (90 km)
Combat radius (31 troops) 100* NM (180 km)
* Varies with a multitude of factors such as temperature, wind, gross
weight, internal versus external load, and time in PZ/LZ.
CAPABILITIES
I-73. The CH-47D provides the following:
• Countermeasure suite of IR jammers, radar-warning receivers, and
laser-warning detectors.
• Data-reduction transfer system to upload from the AMPS data-
transfer cartridge and download postmission data.
• Internal transport of two HMMWVs or a HMMWV with a 105-
millimeter howitzer and gun crew.
• MEDEVACs of 24 litter patients and 2 medics.
• Self-deployable range of 1,056 NM with the ERFS, with 30-minute
reserve; transportable in the C-5 aircraft.
• Shipboard compatibility for joint and combined operations.
ARMAMENT SUBSYSTEMS
I-74. The armament subsystems are the M24 and M41 machine-gun systems
installed in the cabin door, cabin escape hatch, and on the ramp. Both
I-17
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
subsystems use the M60D 7.62-millimeter machine gun. The two flexible
7.62-millimeter machine guns are free pointing but limited in traverse,
elevation, and depression.
COMMUNICATIONS
I-75. The CH-47D has the following communications systems:
• The AN/ARC-164 Have Quick II radios provide UHF-AM two-way
communications in the 225- to 399.975-megahertz range in 25-
kilohertz-intervals; they can operate in normal or antijam, frequency-
hopping mode.
• The AN/ARC-201 SINCGARS provides two-way communications in
the VHF-FM range of 30 to 87.975 megahertz in 25-kilohertz
intervals; it employs antijam, frequency-hopping capability, and, when
used with the KY-58, provides secure voice and cipher-mode
communications. Later SINCGARS has embedded encryption and
does not require KY-58 interface.
• One or two AN/ARC-186 VHF-AM-FM radio sets are installed,
providing broad VHF communications on either the number 1 or 3
position on the function control selector of the Controls and Function,
Interphone Control.
• The AN/ARC-220 HF radio supports NOE long-distance
communications from 2 to 29.999 megahertz in 100-hertz steps on 20
preselectable channels, for a total of 280,000 possible frequencies; as
one of the radios available to the commander, it is accessible in the
number 4 position on the function control selector.
• The KY-58 interfaces with the AN/ARC-186 VHF-AM-FM radio in the
FM range to provide secure communications.
• The KY-100 provides secure communications for the AN/ARC-220
high-frequency radio.
NAVIGATION SYSTEMS
I-76. The CH-47 has the following navigation systems:
• The AN/ASN-128B Doppler/GPS navigation set provides present
position or destination navigation information in latitude and
longitude or the MGRS coordinates. In the primary combined mode,
the GPS updates Doppler position at a 1-megahertz rate; other CH-47
aircraft have the AN/ASN-128 Doppler navigation without GPS.
• The AN/ARN-89 ADF provides automatic direction finding for
instrument navigation and approach.
• The AN/ARN-123 (V) VOR/LOC/GS/MB provides instrument
navigation and approach.
I-18
Appendix I
LIMITATIONS
I-79. The following are limitations of the CH-47D aircraft:
• CH-47D aircrews employ AN/AVS-6 NVG that lack the same night
capabilities as FLIR systems in AH-64 aircraft.
• CH-47D aircraft are instrument certified but cannot operate in all
environmental conditions depending on threat and navigational aid
availability.
• CH-47D aircraft generate a powerful downwash that may dislodge
tents or other unsecured items in proximity to landing or hover. In
desert and snow conditions, this downwash can disclose friendly
positions; LZs must be chosen that accommodate the aircraft’s size
and signature.
I-80. The C-12 provides higher speed intratheater transport for key
personnel.
DESCRIPTION
I-81. The C-12 is a twin-engine, turboprop, fixed-wing aircraft. Many
different C-12 models are fielded. The C-12C and D1 have PT6A-41 engines;
the C-12D2, T1, and T2 have PT6A-42 engines. Aircraft can normally carry
eight passengers and a crew of two. All models have an aft passenger door,
and all, except the C-12C, have a separate cargo door.
SPECIFICATIONS
I-82. Table I-8 outlines C-12 specifications.
I-19
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
CAPABILITIES
I-83. The C-12 provides the following:
• Transport of up to eight personnel.
• Communication equipment capable of supporting key passengers.
• Light cargo transport capability.
ARMAMENT SYSTEMS
I-84. The C-12 is unarmed.
COMMUNICATIONS
I-85. The C-12 has the following communication systems, depending on the
model:
• The AN/ARC-164 (C, D1, and D2) provides two-way voice
communications in the 225- to 399.975-megahertz range for a normal
range of 50 miles.
• The UHF-20B (C and D1) provides VHF-AM communications in the
116- to 151.975-megahertz frequency range for a normal range of 50
miles.
• The 718U HF command set (C and D1) provides high-frequency
communications in the frequency range of 2 to 29.999 megahertz.
• The AN/ARC-186 (C and D1) provides VHF-AM/FM communications.
• The AN/ARC-210 (V) (T1 and T2) provides multifrequency
communications in the 30 to 88 FM band, 108 to 136 AM band, 136 to
156 FM band, 156 to 174 FM maritime band, and 225 to 400 AM/FM
Have Quick and SATCOM bands.
• The VHF-22C (D2, T1, and T2) provides VHF communications.
• The KHF 950 (D2, T1, and T2) provides high-frequency, long-range
communications.
I-20
Appendix I
NAVIGATION SYSTEMS
I-86. The C-12 has the following navigation systems:
• The KLN-90B GPS provides global positioning system navigation.
• Two VIR-30 VOR receivers are installed, one without marker beacon
capability for instrument navigation.
• The KR 87 ADF provides automatic direction finding capability with
AM transmitters.
• The DME-40 provides distance-measuring equipment capability.
• The AP-106 autopilot system works with other navigation equipment
to fly the aircraft en route.
LIMITATIONS
I-88. The C-12 has no self-defense protection system and limited capability to
survive against airborne threats. It is not normally flown at terrain-flight
altitudes.
I-89. The C-23B or B+ supports theater aviation needs for cargo transport,
airdrop, and aeromedical evacuation.
DESCRIPTION
I-90. The C-23B Super Sherpa is a twin turboprop, fixed-wing aircraft. Its
rectangular-shaped cabin readily accommodates palletized cargo; up to 500
pounds of additional baggage can be stored in a nose compartment. The C-
23B has a crew of three.
SPECIFICATIONS
I-91. Table I-9 outlines C-23B specifications.
I-21
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
CAPABILITIES
I-92. The C-23 provides the following:
• Transport of up to 30 seated passengers.
• Transport of 27 paratroopers.
• Transport of 18 litters and 2 medical attendants.
• Transport of palletized cargo.
ARMAMENT SYSTEMS
I-93. The C-23B is an unarmed aircraft.
COMMUNICATIONS
I-94. The C-23B and B+ lack SINCGARS, Have Quick, and HF capability.
The two organic AN/ARC-182(V) radios operate in the 30- to 399.975-
megahertz frequency ranges.
NAVIGATION SYSTEMS
I-95. The C-23B has the following navigation systems:
• Two VIR-32A VHF navigation receivers with DME 42 and ILS/GS.
• Two RMI-36 radio magnetic indicators.
• One ADF-60A ADF.
• Two EHSI-74 electronic horizontal situation indicators.
• One TDR-90 transponder.
• One AN/APX-100(V) transponder.
I-22
Appendix I
C-23B LIMITATIONS
I-97. The following are limitations of the C-23B:
• The C-23B is not pressurized; therefore, aircrew members require
oxygen for sustained flights above 10,000 feet. Passengers would also
require oxygen above that altitude, which would generally be
impractical; resultant flights with passengers at lower altitude will
adversely affect range and endurance.
• The narrow cabin will not permit internal loading of Army vehicles
such as the HMMWV.
I-23
Appendix J
Aircraft Survivability
SECTION I – FUNDAMENTALS
THREAT
J-1. Aircraft survivability is a primary concern throughout planning and
execution of all missions. Army aircrews operate in an extremely hazardous
environment of highly lethal air defense threats. The array of enemy air
defense systems includes radar, IR, EO, and directed-energy weapons. Proper
use of ASE, combined with careful route planning and movement techniques,
greatly reduces the enemy’s ability to effectively engage Army helicopters.
Section III contains further threat information.
TACTICS
J-3. Appropriate tactics are the most effective means of enhancing aircraft
survivability. Mission planning begins with a detailed analysis of the enemy
air defense threat. Planners then determine how to best avoid or degrade
that threat. Flight planning incorporates a detailed flight route analysis,
seeking to avoid known or suspected enemy air defense sites and reduce the
chances of detection or engagement by the enemy. Flight modes (low-level,
contour, and NOE) and techniques (traveling, traveling overwatch, and
bounding overwatch) are selected. Effective terrain flight not only limits LOS
exposure times but also places the aircraft’s radar, IR, and visual signature
in a cluttered environment. Chapter 4 addresses flight modes and movement
techniques.
J-0
Appendix J
J-9. This section includes a brief description of each ASE system with
available configurations to optimize the ASE system.
AN/APR-39(V)1
J-10. The AN/APR-39(V)1 is a passive, omnidirectional radar signal
detecting set (RSDS). The system detects friendly and threat radar systems
in the high (E, F, G, H, I, and J) bands, as well as missile guidance radars in
the low (C and D) bands. Some enemy systems may operate outside these
bands. Therefore, crews must be aware if these systems are in the AO.
AN/APR-39A(V)1
J-11. The AN/APR-39A(V)1 RSDS is an upgraded version of the AN/APR-
39(V)1. It uses a digital processor, alphanumeric symbology display, and
synthetic voice warning to alert the aircrew of radar-directed air defense
threat systems. It provides coverage for C, D, and E through M band pulsed
wave radar. The theater-specific mission data set software is
J-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
AN/APR-44(V)1/3
J-12. The AN/APR-44(V)1/3 RSDS is a passive system used to detect
continuous wave (CW) radar signals aimed at the aircraft. A light indicates
the detection, a tone is heard in the headset, and a logic signal is produced for
external use. The AN/APR-44(V)1 is connected to the AN/APR-39A(V)1 and
warns the pilot through the AN/APR 39A(V)1 or a warning display on the
multifunctional display. The AN/APR-44(V)3 is a stand-alone system and
warns the pilot with a light and a tone in the headset. The AN/APR-44(V)3
has additional components that enable an aircraft to detect airborne
interceptors.
AN/APR-48A
J-13. The AN/APR-48A RFI detects emitting radar targets and computes
accurate target azimuth and target identification for AH-64D LBAs equipped
with FCR. Mounted on the mast above the rotors, the RFI provides
continuous 360-degree emitter detection and threat identification, including
early warning, ground targeting, counterbattery, and aircraft radars. For fine
direction-finding measurements, a four-element interferometer array with a
90-degree FOV provides the DF accuracy and tolerance to multipath induced
errors found from radar reflectance.
AN/AVR-2/2A
J-14. The AN/AVR-2/2A LDS is a passive laser warning system that provides
input to the AN/APR-39A(V)1 to detect laser energy. The 2A version is also
used as sensors for MILES/AGES. The system has reprogrammable emitter
identification (EID).
AN/ALQ-136(V)5
J-15. AN/ALQ-136(V)5 countermeasures set (CMS) is an airborne, automatic
electronic radar jammer designed to defeat/degrade the tracking capability of
a limited number of hostile threat pulse radars. When threat signals are
identified and verified, jamming automatically begins and continues until the
threat radar signal is no longer detected. The CMS then ceases jamming but
continues to receive and analyze radar signals.
AN/ALQ-144A(V)1/3
J-16. The AN/ALQ-144A(V)1/3 CMS is an active, continuous operating
omnidirectional IR jammer system designed to confuse or decoy threat IR
missile systems. The AN/ALQ-144A(V)1 CMS provides jamming of all known
threat IR missile systems when operated on an aircraft that has been
equipped with low-reflective paint and engine exhaust suppressors. The
J-2
Appendix J
system has specific jam-program number settings that must be set before
flight.
AN/ALQ156(V)1
J-17. The AN/ALQ156(V)1 missile approach detector is an airborne radar
system that provides IR homing protection to the aircraft by detecting the
approach of antiaircraft missiles. Upon detection of an incoming missile, the
missile detector automatically initiates a signal, which triggers the M-130
general purpose dispenser system. The dispenser system then releases a flare
to decoy IR missiles away from the aircraft.
M-130
J-18. The M-130 general purpose dispenser has a dual countermeasure
capability of chaff and flares. The system is operated either manually with
AN/APR-39 RSDS warning or automatically through interface with the
AN/ALQ-156. The dispenser system can dispense flares only (30 each) or
chaff only (30 each). By adding a second M130 dispenser assembly and
payload module, the aircraft may dispense flares or chaff, independently.
Chaff and flare cartridges cannot be mixed in any payload module. The chaff
protects against radar-directed antiaircraft weapon systems, while the flares
protect against IR-directed missile systems. When the M-130 is set to
dispense chaff, the electronic control module must be set with the program
setting for the aircraft before flight. Currently, only the CH-47D has an
approved airworthiness release to fire flares from the M-130.
J-19. Table J-1 depicts the systems that are in each aircraft. Note that
aircraft carry only one AN/APR-39 system at a time. In addition, very few
aircraft use the AN/APR-44 system.
Table J-1. Aircraft ASE Matrix
ASE AH-64A AH-64D OH-58D UH-60A/L CH-47D HH-60L RC-23B
AN/APR-39(V)1 X X X
AN/APR-39(V)2 X
AN/APR-39A(V)1 X X X X X X
AN/APR-44(V)1/3 X X X X
AN/APR-48A X
AN/ALQ-136(V)2 X
AN/ALQ-136(V)5 X X
AN/ALQ-144A(V)1 X X X
AN/ALQ-144A(V)3 X X
AN/ALQ-156(V)1/2 X X
AN/ALQ-162(V)3 X
AN/AVR-2A X X X
M-130 (CHAFF) X X X X X
M-130 (FLARE) X X X
J-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
J-20. This section provides general information about the capabilities and
characteristics of threat systems. It may be applied to specific threats on a
case-by-case basis.
ENGAGEMENT ENVELOPE
J-25. Threat systems have a minimum and maximum effective altitude and
range. These numbers are computed against a cooperative engagement
(nonmaneuvering aircraft, blue-sky background, flat terrain, and steady
velocity). The typical effective envelope for a threat system is based upon a 50
percentile; that is, at the maximum (or minimum) effective range (or
J-4
Appendix J
altitude), the weapon system is able to hit the target one out of two times. As
the target gets further into the threat’s envelope, the probability of a first-
shot kill increases. As the target gets further outside the threat envelope, the
probability decreases until the target is outside the threat’s maximum range
(or altitude), where it is physically impossible to hit.
J-26. The aircrew, even if exposed, can make the engagement more difficult
for the threat. A stationary target, for example, allows the threat to adjust
each shot off the last until it hits the aircraft. A more difficult engagement is
a moving, constant-velocity shot. A prediction can be made, and if a miss
occurs, an adjustment can be made based off the last shot. The most difficult
engagement is against a moving target that varies range, altitude, attitude,
and velocity. Prediction is impossible because all four factors are changing at
differing rates.
RADAR
J-28. Direct threat radar weapons require LOS to hit the target. They are
either fire-controlled antiaircraft artillery (AAA) or, for missile systems,
command, semiactive radar homing (SARH), or active radar homing (ARH).
Radar weapons must detect, acquire, track, launch and guide (or fire a
ballistic solution), and assess damage. Radar systems are hampered by
ground clutter. To pick out targets from ground clutter, radar systems can
detect movement though the use of a MTI, Doppler (continuous-wave radar),
or pulse Doppler. Some modern radar systems track not only the movement
of the aircraft itself but also the movement of rotor blades. Radar systems can
be detected, avoided, decoyed, jammed, and destroyed by direct and indirect
fires (self-artillery and antiradiation missiles).
INFRARED
J-29. IR direct threat weapons require LOS before launch. The in-flight
missile must maintain LOS with the target until impact or detonation of the
proximity fuse. IR missiles require the operator to visually detect the target
and energize the seeker before the sensor acquires the target. The operator
must track the target with the seeker caged to the LOS until it is determined
that the seeker is tracking the target and not background objects (natural or
man-made objects such as vehicles, the sun, or reflected energy of the sun off
clouds). The IR sensor is also susceptible to atmospheric conditions (such as
haze or humidity), the signature of the aircraft and its background, flares,
decoys, and jamming. Generally, the portability of IR systems makes it
difficult to predict where they may be located. Their passive sensors make
them difficult to detect before launch. Aircrews have little time to respond to
a launch because of the missile’s short TOF.
J-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
DIRECTED-ENERGY WEAPONS
J-30. Laser-guided or -aided weapons use lasers to perform ranging,
tracking, or guiding functions for conventional explosives. Pure directed-
energy weapons (DEW)s use laser and other forms of DEWs to inflict damage
to the aircraft or its sensors. DEWs are of short duration, hard to detect,
extremely hard to decoy or jam, and hard to kill. They rely upon LOS and
atmospheric conditions and are somewhat short ranged at present.
OPTICAL/ELECTRO-OPTICAL
J-31. Optical/EO sensors are used as either the primary or the secondary
sensor for all weapon systems. They are, with very few exceptions, completely
passive. They are limited by human eyes, atmospheric conditions, distance,
jitter, and in many cases, by darkness. The optical/EO sensors are most
difficult to detect, seldom can be decoyed, and can be jammed in the sense of
obscurant, but, when located, can be killed.
MISSION PLANNING
J-33. ASE and EW must be considered in all phases of mission planning and
execution. Figure J-1 illustrates the roles and responsibilities of ASE
planning.
J-6
Appendix J
Situation
Mission, Intent, & End States
Risk Analysis
Enemy & Friendly
OPORD & FRAGO: Mission
1. Situation ASE Settings
2. Mission Briefing
3. Execution
4. Service Support
5. Command and Signal
J-36. Aircrews must be familiar with ASE SA displays and their threat
indications. Some actions must be performed immediately. After receiving
visual indications of enemy gun or missile firing or ASE indications of radar
J-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
track or launch, the aircrew has but seconds to react. The aircrew should
immediately—
• Deploy to cover.
• Perform evasive maneuver if masking terrain is not readily available.
• Determine whether to continue or abort the mission.
CREW COORDINATION
J-37. Crew coordination must be rehearsed to perform evasive maneuvers.
Standardized terminology, such as “Missile 3 o’clock, break right” and
“Breaking right,” should be used to avoid confusion.
MULTISHIP CONSIDERATIONS
J-38. Formations and spacing intervals should be selected to provide all
aircraft maneuver space to evade hostile fire. Standardized terminology, such
as “Chalk three, tracers 3 o’clock, breaking left,” should be used to alert the
flight. Briefings should include evasive formation break-up procedures and
how to reestablish the formation after breaking the engagement. Terrain,
narrow radar beam, altitude, maintenance problems, or other factors may
prevent all aircraft in the formation from receiving signals; therefore, it is
important to communicate ASE alerts or indications immediately.
J-8
Appendix K
Digitization
This appendix summarizes key information that leaders require to
exercise C2 using the ABCS. It includes information on the components of
ABCS and its supporting systems and how to use ABCS within a CP to
support battle planning, preparation, execution, and sustainment.
SECTION I – INTRODUCTION
GENERAL
K-1. For military operations in the twenty-first century, force projection,
split-base operations, information warfare, and joint or combined operations
will be the rule. Crucial to these capabilities is the effective flow of
information to support warfighting throughout all phases of an operation (see
Figure K-1). ABCS provides rapid and reliable information nets to enable the
Army to project the force, protect the force, gain information superiority,
determine the battle space, conduct decisive operations, and sustain the
force. It provides real-time and near-real-time information that enables
sound decision making inside the enemy’s decision cycle.
K-2. ABCS is a collection of information management systems that assists
the commander in exercising C2. It assists him in gaining SU of the
battlefield. ABCS permits him to apply his judgment more productively, to
use his command presence more efficiently, to develop and disseminate his
vision effectively, and to understand better the dynamics of war (in general)
and the specific operation (in particular).
K-3. ABCS provides a visual means to see friendly and enemy forces and the
ability to arrange and maneuver forces to accomplish missions. The ABCS
components assist in answering the following questions:
• Where am I?
• What is my status?
• Where are the other friendly units?
• What is their status?
• Where is the enemy?
• What is the enemy’s status?
K-4. Digitization capability is an evolutionary process that will occur over
many years. This appendix describes envisioned objective operations. When
capability is incomplete, the challenge is to devise ways to mix traditional,
manual methods with the automated systems that permit more rapid
planning and synchronized execution. As always, these guidelines should be
applied to a degree that complements the existing level of automation.
K-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
COMMON PICTURES
K-5. Definitions of common pictures follow. In practice, the terms common
operational picture (COP) and common tactical picture (CTP) are often used
interchangeably.
• Common Operational Picture. The COP is an operational picture
tailored to the user’s requirements, based on common data and
information shared by more than one command; the COP facilitates
collaborative planning and assists all echelons in achieving SU, which
helps to synchronize execution.
• Common Tactical Picture. The CTP is an application available on
ABCS computers and supporting systems; the application uses a
common mapping background, is accessed through a common user
K-2
Appendix K
K-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
COMMON SERVICES
K-10. ABCS provides several information management applications.
COLLABORATION TOOLS
K-11. Collaboration tools include—
• VTC, whiteboard, and shared applications.
• Messaging.
• File transfers.
• Calendar creation/scheduling.
• Task management.
• Internet browser.
• Database query tools.
TRAINING APPLICATIONS
K-12. These provide training and simulation capabilities for individual and
collective training events.
APPLICATIONS
K-13. Common applications include word processor, spreadsheet, and
presentation/graphics programs. Document interchange services support
document exchanges between heterogeneous computer systems using
common file formats.
K-14. The operational picture application creates a shared picture of the
battle space.
K-15. The planning application automates aspects of the MDMP and enables
parallel and collaborative planning.
K-4
Appendix K
K-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
LOCATION
K-21. There is a GCCS-A system at the corps main and tactical CPs.
KEY CAPABILITIES
K-22. The commander’s force analyzer provides current, time phased force
deployment data (TPFDD). This information is key for planning the
movement of forces and monitoring unit status and availability.
K-23. The logistics analyzer allows planners to forecast resources needed in
various combat situations.
K-24. GCCS-A shares the client-server architecture common operating
environment (COE) with the joint GCCS for the general functions of
teleconferencing, messaging, file transfers, office automation, utilities, and
system administration.
K-6
Appendix K
LOCATION
K-26. FBCB2 is found on platforms from the commander to the soldier level.
KEY CAPABILITIES
K-27. FBCB2 assists SU by telling the user his location and the locations of
other friendly forces, observed enemy forces, and reported battlefield
obstacles. The user can adjust his picture of the battlefield by selecting which
overlays, graphics, and icons are shown. Unit displays can be altered by
grouping icons according to unit type or echelon.
K-28. FBCB2 automates frequently used urgent messages for reporting the
enemy, requesting MEDEVAC, NBC attack, call for fire, cease fire, and unit
situation reporting. Enemy information can be rapidly formatted via an
automated report. This information is forwarded to all other FBCB2 users
and the all source analysis system (ASAS) supporting the user, usually the
task force or brigade S2.
K-29. FBCB2 supports the call-for-fire process via a message in JVMF sent
directly to AFATDS. The integration of the laser ranger finder with FBCB2’s
Ground Positioning System greatly improves the speed and accuracy of both
calls for fire and enemy spot reports. It provides key information to the
CSSCS on unit logistical status.
LOCATION
K-31. A TAIS is found at the DMAIN. A second TAIS is located at the
division tactical CP or aviation brigade where it can optimally provide flight-
following functionality. At corps level, one TAIS is at the main CP while a
second is placed consistent with the tactical situation. TAIS is also at EAC.
K-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
KEY CAPABILITIES
K-32. TAIS deconflicts (mathematically and graphically), in real time,
airspace usage in the third and fourth dimensions (altitude and time). For
example, the operator can graphically rotate a three-dimensional
representation of the airspace to see ACMs from different angles, enabling
him to see how they intersect and overlap.
K-33. The air traffic services display includes information from the ACO and
ATO. TAIS operators can use this display to track the flight of aircraft. If an
aircraft leaves the safe transition corridor, TAIS can alert the operator. TAIS
will be able to communicate (voice and data) with current and future military
aircraft (joint/combined), civilian aircraft and air traffic control systems, and
other U.S. and allied forces airspace users.
LOCATION
K-35. DTSS is found at the corps main CP, DMAIN, and tactical and brigade
CPs.
KEY CAPABILITIES
K-36. DTSS produces sophisticated mobility analysis products. For example,
it provides a detailed analysis comparing off-road mobility of the HMMWV
and M1 tank.
K-37. DTSS performs intervisibility analysis, which is overlaid on a terrain
map backdrop. For example, from any point on the map, it can depict every
other point within LOS of the first point.
K-38. DTSS depicts a three-dimensional view such as a fly-through area.
Colored areas show threat and friendly air defense domes superimposed on
satellite imagery. The DTSS database contains detailed terrain information
but not weapon characteristics and locations; these must be obtained from
the intelligence staff.
K-8
Appendix K
LOCATION
K-40. IMETS workstations, manned by staff weather teams, are at the
aviation brigade, division, and corps main CPs.
KEY CAPABILITIES
K-41. IMETS receives and integrates weather information from polar-
orbiting civilian and military meteorological satellites, the Air Force Global
Weather Center, artillery meteorological teams, remote sensors, and civilian
forecast centers.
K-42. IMETS processes and collates forecasts, observations, and
climatological data to produce timely and accurate weather products tailored
to the warfighter’s specific needs. Additional weather information is available
via the IMETS web pages. Severe weather warnings are disseminated to
units via USMTF message.
K-43. The integrated weather effects decision aid (IWEDA) displays weather
effects on weapon systems or missions. For example, it can show the various
weather effects—whether favorable, marginal, or unfavorable—on various
weapons over the next 24 hours.
Location
K-46. MCS is found at echelons from battalion through corps.
Key Capabilities
K-47. A message processor is available on all MCS workstations. It is used to
create, edit, transmit, print, and store messages in both USMTF and JVMF.
K-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
Location
K-51. MCS-L is found at battalion, brigade, and certain separate companies.
Key Capabilities
K-52. The MCS-L can be used to—
• Produce orders, plans, and annexes; used to develop task
organizations, overlays, and synchronization matrices.
• Develop and assess courses of action; the MCS-L includes a
distance/rate tool.
• Create messages and generate reports; used to maintain the staff
journal.
• Record and depict NAIs, TAIs, and CCIR including HVTs and HPTs.
• Function as file transfer protocol (FTP) client/server; the MCS-L
possesses Adobe Acrobat™, a file zip utility, Microsoft Office™, and a
web browser.
Location
K-54. ASAS is at echelons from battalion to corps. An ASAS RWS can
function as a stand-alone system or as an adjunct to an analysis and control
K-10
Appendix K
element (ACE) at corps and division level and the analysis and control team
at brigade.
Key Capabilities
K-55. Intelligence personnel can use the analysis tools in the ASAS RWS for
their IPB. For example, it is able to depict tracked vehicle GO and NO-GO
areas overlaid on a terrain map. The ASAS RWS assists the warfighter’s
COA analysis with information on enemy units, equipment, locations, and
movements.
K-56. Using reports and sensor inputs, the RWS can alert the operator to
enemy targets and can automatically nominate them for friendly supporting
fires. Commanders and staff can even focus ASAS on the specific types of
targets that will best support the mission.
K-57. ASAS also monitors the current enemy situation. Using the latest
combat information and intelligence, it maintains and displays timely,
detailed data on enemy units.
Location
K-59. ASAS-L is at battalion.
Key Capabilities
K-60. The ASAS-L provides ISR management and analytic support to the
battalion S2 for SU, tactical warning, force protection, and targeting. It
provides an analyzed enemy picture to the operational picture.
K-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
Location
K-62. AFATDS is at the firing platoon through EAC. Remote terminals allow
commanders, LNOs, and other FS personnel to monitor FS operations and
issue guidance.
Key Capabilities
K-63. AFATDS analyzes a potential target and then identifies which
available FS systems would be most effective. This information is shown to
the operator through a visual display.
K-64. Based on the commander’s guidance, AFATDS prioritizes targets and
supported units, specifying the method of engagement and the volume of fire
for each type of target. These priorities can vary according to varying
guidance for each phase of an operation to best support the commander’s
intent and scheme of maneuver.
K-65. AFATDS processes fire missions through combat messages in dialogue
with MCS, CSSCS, AMDWS, and FBCB2 and reports mission results to
ASAS.
K-66. In addition to managing the FS of current operations, AFATDS assists
FS planning for future operations. Its planning mode offers decision aids and
analytical tools to determine which FS plan best supports a course of action.
Location
K-68. AMDWS is located at the AD battery CP with the maneuver brigade
main CP, division CPs, corps CPs, and EAC.
Key Capabilities
K-69. The air defense unit status screen shows the location, alert status, on-
hand munitions, vehicles, and personnel for AD units from section through
battalion echelon.
K-70. Its weapon and sensor visibility feature supports placement of AD
weapons and sensors. By analyzing platform capabilities and digitized
terrain elevation data, AMDWS can determine the area coverage of weapons
and sensors at different locations.
K-12
Appendix K
Location
K-73. CSSCS terminals are found from the battalion through theater.
Key Capabilities
K-74. Logistics reports depict unit and resource status with a color code of
green, amber, red, or black by using corresponding percentages set by the
user. Reports can be displayed as web-based custom reports or as standard,
preformatted reports. The standard report shows the logistical readiness of a
unit and its subordinate units. The user can focus on parts of the report to
isolate specific units and materiel items. This capability helps identify how
an individual status affects the overall readiness rating of the unit. In the
custom report, the user can track the status of specific units and resources:
• The capability report shows a unit’s logistical ability to conduct
sustained combat operations; this report provides unit resource status
in relation to combat posture and intensity for the current day and
next four days.
• The supply class report shows resource status with items grouped by
class of supply.
• The personnel daily summary depicts unit personnel status and is
available for all company-size units and separate battalions.
K-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
OVERVIEW
K-76. The Army’s network architecture is the Warfighter Information
Network-Tactical (WIN-T). It is an evolving tactical telecommunications
system consisting of infrastructure and network components from the
maneuver battalion to the theater rear. It comprises multiple systems and
pathways designed to facilitate information distribution and access to
information services.
K-14
Appendix K
K-15
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
K-16
Appendix K
INTRODUCTION
K-85. The Army is making rapid and drastic changes in CP design, taking
full advantage of the newest computer technology. The CPs for digitized units
will be mobile, deployable, and equipped to access, process, and distribute the
information and orders for their echelon. This section outlines the internal
operations of a digital CP. FM 3-91 (FM 71-100), 71-100-2, FM 71-100-3, and
FM 5-0 (FM 101-5) contain detailed discussion.
DATA EXCHANGE
K-86. Central to digital CP operations is the manner in which they exchange
data. ABCSs share information either directly with one another or through
the JCDB. The JCDB resides on all of the ABCS computers in a CP and
provides the data for the common applications that generate the COP.
Battlefield information dynamically flows back and forth between ABCSs and
the JCDB. When data is entered through a BAS, this change is forwarded to
all ABCS subscribers on the CP’s tactical LAN (TACLAN) and posted to the
COP (Figure K-7).
K-17
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
K-18
Appendix K
K-19
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
INDIVIDUAL WORKSTATIONS
K-91. The focus of the individual workstation is the individual BAS and the
specific BOS that it supports. At his workstation, the staff member inputs
and monitors data within his sphere of responsibility. He also accesses data
posted to web pages and shared files by other staff sections in the LAN and
WAN to carry out his BOS functions and duties.
K-20
Appendix K
posting within the CP. This is especially true for information that is less
likely to change during a mission such as CCIR and the synchronization
matrix. In turn, this optimizes the use of LSD subscreens by freeing them to
depict dynamic ABCS digital content. The commander, XO, S3, and battle
captain must be able to orchestrate BOS coordination through the display of
key information on the LSD. Each staff section must, therefore, maintain
information relating to its BOS using visual graphics that support the COP.
Staff sections and their supporting systems should be arranged around the
LSD to facilitate information control, interaction, coordination, and
information analysis.
K-97. The COP is displayed on the LSD through one ABCS, typically the S3’s
MCS or MCS-L. COP control and manipulation and CP LAN administration
are aided by centrally collocating the CP server and the BAS that projects the
COP. The ability to view the LSD through the BAS controlling the COP also
facilitates communication and navigation through data. During discussions
in the CIC, personnel can focus staff on key portions of the COP. Data will be
displayed on the LSD via the COP using the ABCS COP application or
through overlays provided by individual BASs. To portray the COP
graphically requires METT-TC analysis of information. The COP displays
enemy (shown as red feed and graphics), friendly (shown as blue feed and
graphics), terrain (shown as characteristics and impact), and civilian
considerations (shown as gray feed and graphics).
K-98. Friendly analysis occurs in the CIC by all BOS sections and systems.
Each BAS provides BOS overlays for subsequent data manipulation and
consolidated viewing in the form of operational pictures that form the COP.
Enemy analysis is especially time-sensitive information.
K-99. The MCS whiteboard or electronic whiteboard equips leaders and
staffs to conduct collaborative sessions. Participants at distributed locations
view the same enemy and friendly COP on an MCS display and are linked
with audio. The telestration feature of whiteboard allows each participant to
use a mouse with a crayon drawing capability to visually depict locations,
graphics, and other coordination measures that can be seen on the
participants’ screens.
K-21
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
staff’s need to quickly review, update, and use information for battle
monitoring and planning.
K-102. Establishing a standard staff estimate format facilitates navigation
through the estimate and cross-referencing between estimates. Staff
estimates should also list available BOS overlays by name to better focus
graphical review within the ABCS COP application and to focus all echelons
and staff on the same, most current data. Through digitally equipped LNOs,
analog units should access these digital estimates to obtain current
operational data and to help synchronize their operations with digital units.
INFORMATION MANAGEMENT
K-103. The staff must be organized to support the information management
process of filter-fuse-focus. This process will be guided by doctrine, TTP, and
unit SOPs. The staff must operate according to established procedures that
specify access to common databases, common displays, and report formats.
The staff must be organized to allow the vertical and horizontal flow of
information. This organization should provide links between teams within
staff sections, between staff sections within a CP, and between CPs at the
same, higher, and lower echelons.
K-104. Digitization enables commanders and staff members to focus more on
the execution of combat operations and much less on planning, coordination,
and the processing of information. Commanders and staff will have much
more data upon which to base their decisions. Their challenge, therefore, will
be to manage the flow of vast amounts of data so that the right information
gets to the right person at the right time. These specific challenges are—
• Relevancy: Determine the relevant information from among the vast
amount of data available.
• Responsibility: Ensure that each product is the assigned responsibility
of a specific staff section.
• Accuracy and Currency: Ensure that the data are correct and up-to-
date.
• Dissemination: Ensure that information generated by the staff gets to
the right personnel.
• Evaluation: Ensure that information is appropriately assessed.
RELEVANCY
K-105. Because of the large quantity of data available, the commander needs
to establish information priorities to focus the staff during their data
collection. These priorities must address the relevant information to the
specific operation. The commander provides this focus via CCIR that are—
•Specified by the commander and applicable only to him.
•Situation dependent and linked to present and future operations.
• Based on events or activities that are predictable.
• Time sensitive (answers to CCIR must be reported to the commander
by the most rapid and effective means).
K-106. Table K-1 summarizes the CCIR responsibilities.
K-22
Appendix K
RESPONSIBILITY
K-107. The diverse products produced using ABCS must each be the
responsibility of specific staff sections. This responsibility will usually be
obvious, being based on doctrine. Unit SOPs/TTP must confirm these
doctrinal responsibilities while ensuring that all other products are the
assigned responsibilities of specific staff sections.
DISSEMINATION
K-109. Because of bandwidth limitations, it might not be possible to
routinely send out products through e-mail. On the other hand, it is not
enough to merely post information to a web site or shared folder and expect
others to use it. With the exception of routine, scheduled postings and
updates, the staff must proactively notify users when such changes are made.
When a product is posted or revised, staff sections must notify other staff
sections and units at the same, lower, and higher echelons. This notification
must include instructions on precisely where to find the product and its file
K-23
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
name. Units must establish SOPs that specify file-naming conventions and
file-management procedures. Whether forwarding products or providing
notification of product postings in shared files/web pages, the right personnel
must receive the right information. Correct address information using the
ABCS address books and message handling tables (MHTs) must be
established to ensure that data will be sent to the correct BASs. Addressees
must be the users employing the individual ABCS rather than generic role
names in the address book. If this is not done correctly, information on one
BAS will not flow to other BASs even in the same TOC. During initialization,
operators must also create and distribute databases, which can be done via
messages in ABCS. These databases will ensure that BASs can share the
right kind of information.
EVALUATION
K-110. Computer data tends to be accepted at face value because it is
computer-based and, therefore, is assumed to always be correct. Users of
digital systems must resist this tendency. Error can be introduced through
failures in BASs, databases, and communications systems; human error in
inputting data; and failing to update information in a timely manner. Data
must therefore be evaluated within the context provided by SU to verify that
they are accurate and current. Users must follow up on discrepancies to
ensure that they have the right information.
COMMANDER
K-112. The commander has the following digital duties and responsibilities:
• Provides command guidance for employing ABCS.
• Provides C2 of automation resources.
• Establishes automation support priorities.
• Specifies the unit’s COP.
• Establishes the CCIR and ensures that these requirements are
depicted in ABCS.
• Ensures that subordinate leaders are trained in the employment,
operation, and sustainment of automation.
• Trains subordinate leaders and staff to create, maintain, distribute,
and use the COP.
K-24
Appendix K
EXECUTIVE OFFICER
K-113. The XO has the following digital duties and responsibilities:
• Coordinates the staff to ensure ABCS integration across BAS.
• Ensures that the staff integrates and coordinates its ABCS activities
internally, vertically (with higher headquarters and subordinate
units), and horizontally (with adjacent units).
• Manages the CCIR; ensures satisfaction of the CCIR.
• Directs the creation and distribution of the COP to include procedures
for updating enemy and friendly SU.
• Monitors the information filters, collection plans, and networks that
distribute the COP.
• Provides guidance for automation support.
• Coordinates the staff to ensure automation support.
• Coordinates procedures for inter-CP VTCs and whiteboard sessions.
• Monitors liaison teams with analog (nondigitized) units and
joint/allied forces for their contribution to the COP.
S1
K-114. The S1 has the following digital duties and responsibilities:
• Is responsible for personnel functions of CSSCS.
• Employs CSSCS to monitor and report on personnel-related portions
of the commander’s tracked item list (CTIL).
• Manages Standard Installation/Division Personnel System (SIDPERS)
interface with CSSCS.
S2
K-115. The S2 has the following digital duties and responsibilities:
• Acts as staff proponent for ASAS and IMETS.
• Supervises ASAS and IMETS operations and support.
• Provides guidance on employment and support of ASAS and IMETS.
• Supervises the information security program; evaluates security
vulnerabilities.
• Assists the G6/S6 in implementing and enforcing LAN security
policies.
• Provides software application expertise on proponent systems.
S3
K-116. The S3 has the following digital duties and responsibilities:
• Acts as staff proponent for MCS, AFATDS, AMDWS, FBCB2, and
AMPS.
• Plans, integrates, and employs ABCS.
• Develops the ABCS annex for plans and orders.
• Develops ABCS annexes to the garrison and tactical SOPs.
K-25
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
S4
K-117. The S4 has the following digital duties and responsibilities:
• Acts as staff proponent for CSSCS.
• Supervises CSSCS operations and support.
• Provides guidance on employment and support of CSSCS.
• Monitors and reports on the status of all automation equipment.
• Provides software application expertise on proponent systems.
S6
K-118. The S6 has the following digital duties and responsibilities:
• Serves as signal subject matter expert to the commander; advises the
commander and staff on all signal support matters.
• Monitors WAN performance; integrates the CP LAN.
• Is responsible for all automation information systems, automation and
network management, and information security.
• Ensures consistency and compatibility of automation systems.
• Manages the TI; is responsible for network employment, network
configuration, and network status monitoring and reporting.
• Receives planning worksheets with LAN/WAN requirements.
• Ensures unit information network connectivity between unit and
higher/lower echelons.
• Plans, coordinates, and manages network terminals.
• Develops, modifies, and manages network need lines, UTO, and base
configuration files.
• Plans, coordinates, and manages communications links to include
reach-back communications.
• Coordinates with higher echelon signal officers for additional
communications support.
• Develops and coordinates the signal digital support plan.
• Determines system and retransmission requirements for the tactical
situation.
K-26
Appendix K
K-27
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
BATTLE ROSTERS
K-122. Each section within the CP must maintain a digital battle roster
listing the section operators assigned to each BAS. At a minimum, sections
should plan for three operators per system: two soldiers to man a 12-hour
shift each plus one soldier to serve as a backup and to provide periodic relief.
The roster should list the following:
• Personnel name and rank.
• Assigned BAS.
• Assigned shift.
• Date of most recent training on system.
• Software version of most recent training.
• Estimated date of departure from unit.
K-123. Operators should be managed in a manner similar to unit vehicle
drivers according to the following principles:
• Depth: Have more trained operators than needed to ensure BAS
coverage even when unanticipated losses occur.
• Anticipate: Know when personnel are scheduled to depart the unit,
and train their replacements well in advance.
• Leaders: Section leaders should be prepared to function as operators;
in addition to providing additional coverage, this ability enables
section leaders to better supervise and employ the BASs that they
oversee.
• Currency: Operators must be trained on the most current software
carried on their BAS.
K-28
Appendix K
SHIFT MANAGEMENT
K-124. Shift changes are usually scheduled at 12-hour intervals.
Commanders should consider offsetting shift changes at midshift for key
personnel. Staggering personnel in this manner will maintain a constant
interface of new and old shift personnel. This practice will ensure that at
least one individual knows what happened during the previous shift. Figure
K-10 provides an example.
K-29
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
BATTLE RHYTHM
K-129. Battle rhythm is a nondoctrinal term that describes a process
essential to effective and efficient battle staff operations. The cycle of
K-30
Appendix K
K-31
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
K-133. Battle update briefs should maximize the use of information from
BASs to aid in understanding the COP. Cutting and pasting information to
non-ABCS briefing slides focus on fact finding and less on analysis. The
traditional form also consumes considerable time: more than one hour to
build/transmit slides, one hour to present (at brigade level), and one
additional hour to present (at the division level). By the time that slides are
briefed, their information is outdated and inconsistent with the more current
COP.
K-32
Appendix K
• Manual creation of the analog unit friendly and enemy SU and its
transmission back to the parent organization.
• Fire support and coordination.
PLANNING
K-135. A digitized unit must exchange liaison teams with nondigitized units
early and consistently throughout the planning process. Nondigitized units
must strive to conduct parallel planning but will be at a disadvantage
without digital staff tools. Parallel planning requires rapid exchange of
information with analog units during the planning process. Involving higher,
adjacent, and lower staff elements early in the planning process allows the
entire staff to see both current and future operations and to identify known
or potential problem areas.
LIAISON TEAMS
K-136. Digital liaison teams may be sent to the analog unit’s CP. Liaison
provides at least some digital capability to analog units. These teams will
support SU for both the digital and nondigital unit, the issue of orders, and
informal information exchange. The number of liaison teams is limited, and
these alone cannot solve the C2 challenges of analog units that are without
digitally based SU. Liaison teams may be needed to escort elements of the
analog unit, even down to single vehicles if necessary. This latter option will
provide SU for these analog elements but is only practical if the digital unit
forms additional liaison elements.
EQUIPMENT REQUIREMENTS
K-137. The equipment and skills required of the liaison teams are a function
of the type of operation being conducted and the force with which the team is
coordinating. There are three basic forms of liaison that affect the task
organization of liaison teams:
• Digital unit to digital unit: This requires the least equipment and
personnel because information is easily shared in near-real time;
critical SU is maintained in each unit’s knowledge base.
• Digital unit to analog unit: This may occur when conducting
operations with some active component units, most reserve component
units, and coalition forces; these teams require a full suite of digital
systems to maintain the parent unit’s COP and to provide SU of the
nondigitized force back to the digital headquarters. Representation
from each staff section may be required on the team.
• Digital unit to nonmilitary forces/agencies: This is the same as for
analog units but augmented with additional specialties such as the
S5/G5.
K-33
Appendix L
L-0
Appendix L
MISSION
L-2. A2C2S provides maneuver commanders—from ATKHB to echelons above
corps—with on-the-move C2. The system supports three major operational
functions: mission planning, mission execution, and mission support. Its
primary function is to monitor the execution of current operations while the
main CP focuses primarily on planning future operations.
L-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
• OH-58D.
• M1 main battle tank.
• M2/M3 cavalry fighting vehicle.
• MLRS.
OPERATION AS A GROUND CP
L-6. The preferred power source for ground operations is commercial power.
If commercial power is not available, a generator is the next preferred power
source. If external power is not available, aircraft power is required.
Extended ground times may require a ground power unit, which could be
brought in via sling load, or by a tactical ground vehicle, such as a HMMWV
with a generator kit.
SYSTEM INITIALIZATION
L-8. Initialization is an important step in preparing A2C2S automated
systems. If A2C2S begins a mission without proper initialization, it is difficult
to transfer the necessary volume of initial information while en route (in a
timely manner) to exploit the capabilities of the automated workstations and
data communications. A2C2S initialization is a three-step process:
• Initializing radios.
• Initializing the IDM (+)/INC.
• Loading of MCS data.
SYSTEM OPERATOR
L-9. A master operator manages the software/hardware while the
commander and staff control the battle. The operator must be trained to
initialize the system, use each of the component systems, and troubleshoot
the system and provide immediate work-around solutions in case of
malfunctions. The aviation unit may not have personnel available to operate
the system. The supported unit commander must be prepared to provide a
systems operator.
SECTION II – EMPLOYMENT
L-2
Appendix L
INFORMATION FLOW
L-12. The ATCCSs are primarily top-down planning tools. Once the
execution phase begins, the primary flow of information is bottom-up via
FBCB2. A2C2S draws real-time data from broadcast sources to determine
changes to the enemy situation during the execution phase of a mission. The
intelligence information that the ASAS provides is an analyzed and formal
product. Intelligence information that A2C2S receives from tactical related
applications (TRAP), Tactical Data Information Exchange-Broadcast (TADIX-
B), and Tactical Information Broadcast Service (TIBS) broadcast sources is
raw data (Figure L-2).
BATTLEFIELD EMPLOYMENT
L-13. A2C2S expands the battlefield by providing the means to exercise C2
and gather tactical information in support of a mission while on the move.
From A2C2S, the commander and staff influence the battle via direct
exchange of voice and digital information with units conducting the mission.
They simultaneously develop the situation beyond the range of their unit’s
sensors and shooters by accessing broadcast intelligence sources.
L-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
CLOSE AREAS
L-15. Integral activities during operations in close areas include maneuver,
close combat (including TACAIR), indirect FS, CS and CSS of committed
forces, and C3I. Aviation organizations may be employed as a security or
reserve force in the security or main battle area. A2C2S gives the commander
a clear picture of the close battle and allows him to coordinate and
synchronize maneuver and fires. Linked with other automated systems,
A2C2S can pull information on demand. This allows the commander to
operate at his own tempo, without the information delays characteristic of
traditional reporting methods.
REAR AREAS
L-16. The aviation brigade gives the division commander a highly mobile and
lethal combat force to counter a Level III incursion in the rear area. As a
maneuver headquarters, the brigade can be tasked as a tactical combat force
to respond to a significant threat. A2C2S provides a flexible and highly mobile
tactical CP to control operations.
L-4
Appendix M
Media Considerations
SECTION I – MEDIA SUPPORT
GENERAL
M-1. This section addresses how forces support media information needs
while protecting operational security.
MEDIA CAPABILITIES
M-3. Commanders examine the media’s technological capabilities and their
logistics support including their transportation and resupply assets. Units
may have to transport and logistically support media members.
M-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
PROTECTING INFORMATION
M-6. Commanders balance the need to inform the public with the
understanding that units must practice OPSEC. The threat has access to the
same media resources as the friendly force and public. Both sides can benefit
from and be hurt by information that the media gains and disseminates.
Pieces of the right information in the wrong hands can adversely affect the
outcome of operations. Soldiers must protect vital information by practicing
security at the source, following established OPSEC measures. In addition to
protecting both raw and completed information products, units protect
information networks.
MEDIA FACILITATION
M-7. The commercial news media are major players in the global information
environment. News media will cover future military operations and, in many
cases, will be on the ground before American forces arrive. They will transmit
images to the world of events as they happen, from both sides of the conflict.
It is the commander’s task, through the staff, to develop a responsive
infrastructure to facilitate media interaction.
M-2
Appendix M
Commanders and staff must also assess the intensity of news media interest
and anticipate the personnel, communications, transportation, and
deployment requirements for communicating through the news media during
all stages of the operation.
GROUND RULES
M-12. Sustained contacts between military forces and the news media can
result in the most complete and accurate stories about their units. They seek
to convince reporters that acceptance of reasonable military ground rules in
the integration of journalists into operational units is in the best interest of
both institutions. Some reporters will choose not to cooperate. Commanders
have no responsibility for such individuals and should focus their attention
on the reporters who desire to abide by the procedures outlined for the
operation.
MEDIA SECURITY
M-13. Some members of the media may claim that their security is of no
concern to the military and that DOD policy calls for working with journalists
without regard for their safety. The captures of journalists by U.S.
adversaries in Panama during Operation Just Cause, in Iraq during
Operation Desert Storm, and in Afghanistan have proven that no one can
guarantee the security of all reporters. However, those who accept the
protection afforded them by military units are in the best position to cover
the story and avoid harm.
MEDIA TRANSPORT
M-15. The PAO normally arranges for the press to visit a unit. He assists in
transport to the unit and relies on designated subject matter experts (such as
M-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
an XO, first sergeant, or platoon leader) to assist the media while with that
unit. Transportation arrangements need not place special requirements on
the unit. Reporters can move with supply columns or any other transport
that shuttles within the organization.
COMMAND INTEREST
M-16. Commanders at every level should stay abreast of what reporters are
saying about their efforts. Tactical-level commanders will often learn from
the reporters integrated with their units, from news summaries, or other
reports published or broadcast after the fact. They need not like or agree with
news reports, but they do need to understand the report’s effect. Media
reports help shape public perception and opinion of the command’s
effectiveness. With an effective media facilitation program, the command is
aware of differences between its version of events and what the news media
may report. Relying on technology, assessments, and media facilitation plans,
commanders and PA staffs continuously work to narrow that inevitable gap.
M-17. Information should be fully and readily available, consistent with
statutory requirements, unless current and valid security classifications
preclude its release. Units adhere to the following guidelines:
• Support provisions of the Freedom of Information Act (FOIA) in both
letter and spirit.
• Allow members of the Armed Forces and their family members to
freely exchange general and military information with media
members, without censorship or propaganda.
• Do not classify or withhold information to protect the government
from criticism or embarrassment.
• Withhold information only when disclosure would adversely affect
national security, compromise the mission, or otherwise threaten the
safety or privacy of soldiers.
• Plan and coordinate public affairs details within DOD and with other
government agencies to meet DOD obligations to provide information
to the public.
• Do not employ propaganda in DOD public affairs programs.
M-4
Appendix M
M-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
SECTION II – GUIDELINES
M-19. This section explains DOD media guidelines for reporters and the
units that support them.
M-6
Appendix M
M-22. SASO present unique challenges and may require greater diplomacy
in dealing with the media. The Army may also coordinate media coverage
with other nonmilitary agencies in the AO.
MEDIA FOCUS
M-23. Media attention should be viewed as an asset rather than a hindrance.
The public often considers media reports more credible than official
pronouncements. News reports are a primary conduit for communicating
Army goals, capabilities, and accomplishments. They contribute to
M-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
SOLDIER PREPARATION
M-24. SASO usually receives intense international media attention;
therefore, soldiers must understand that their decisions and actions can have
immediate strategic and political implications. They should understand the
nature of the operation and know its goals. Internal information programs
build soldier knowledge of the history and cultural factors that shape the
operation and its context. These also enhance knowledge of coalition
partners, thereby contributing to mutual trust and respect.
MULTINATIONAL OPERATIONS
M-25. Political considerations and media involvement may be the most
important factors in a multinational operation. Combined operations help to
solidify international acceptance of the SASO; however, the accompanying
international media coverage presents unique challenges.
OPERATIONAL CONSIDERATIONS
M-26. To reinforce unity of purpose, spokespersons from all nations should
speak with one voice. Multinational partnerships consist of alliances and
coalitions. Alliances are long-standing relationships of nations with formal,
standardized agreements and operating procedures oriented on long-term
objectives. Coalitions are more short term in duration and goal. Cultural,
psychological, economic, technological, and political factors influence these
alliances and coalitions.
COALITIONS
M-27. The United States enters coalitions for a single purpose of finite
duration. Coalition members may be diverse in culture, politics, and
philosophy. Their relationships may be tenuous and fragile. Each nation
enters an alliance or a coalition for its own reasons; therefore, mutually
agreed upon end states must be clearly defined. Coalition nation reporters
may show interest in U.S. Army units. Exercise particular caution because
reports may strengthen or weaken coalition nation public opinion about the
SASO.
PEACE OPERATIONS
M-28. Peace operations are nearly always multinational, subject to intense
media scrutiny, and designed to allow the political process to resolve
conflicts. It is vital for peacekeepers to be seen as impartial to belligerents
while firmly united within their coalitions. Political and cultural complexities
of past and present alliances and coalitions can make impartiality difficult.
Media recognition that the operation is an impartial, team effort enhances
mutual confidence and respect and solidifies the partnership. On the other
hand, media perception that the U.S. Army lacks confidence in and respect
for coalition partners can doom an operation.
M-8
Appendix M
CROSS-CULTURAL INTERACTION
M-29. Spokespersons must show great sensitivity to cultural differences
when addressing issues involving other coalition members. Even an
appearance of cultural insensitivity can undermine popular and political
support for a member-nation’s participation, thus threatening coalition unity.
Army units addressing media members must clearly define common
objectives in a multinational environment.
M-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
DEPARTMENT OF STATE
M-34. Because the DOS formulates and implements foreign policy, it has a
stake in media activities. In this area, the DOS has primary or joint
responsibility with DOD for policy concerning—
• The extent to which U.S. forces will aid a host government.
• Any matters affecting U.S. relations with other nations, particularly
allies or neutrals.
• How U.S. operations will influence or maintain the country’s economy.
• Matters involving media access or other measures that may influence
populace attitude.
NONGOVERNMENTAL ORGANIZATIONS
M-36. Nongovernmental organizations (NGOs) and humanitarian groups
often locate in the AO before, during, and after any military operation. If
present before the media arrive, they often are the initial sources of
information for journalists and may serve as major sources during an
operation. These organizations may conduct operations that are
humanitarian (short term) or developmental (long term) in scope. The
sponsoring groups or agencies may be private corporations, foundations,
professional associations, or religious groups. Units on the ground should
contact these organizations to develop an understanding of their concerns,
goals, and potential needs. Representatives of these organizations are
credible spokespersons on the local situation and may provide invaluable
background information on the operational situation.
M-37. The G5 maintains a list of NGOs. The S5 should coordinate efforts
with the G5.
M-10
Appendix N
Rules of Engagement
GENERAL
N-1. ROE are directives issued by competent military authority that
delineate the circumstances and limitations under which United States forces
will initiate/continue combat engagement with other forces. In a general war
between two uniformed, similarly-equipped opponents, the complexity of
ROE is normally low. The soldier in contact with the enemy is usually
instructed on the priority of target classes to engage, with restricted targets
delineated by the laws of war. In the same conflict, however, soldiers
performing support missions may find their ROE are more complex,
reflecting the ROE more often associated with SASO, rather than the ROE
associated with direct combat.
N-2. ROE must be clear. Soldiers operating with confusing or uncertain
guidance can compromise the mission.
N-3. Despite similarities that may exist between operations, each operation
has its own ROE. These rules are generally delineated in the OPLAN ROE
annex (Figure N-1); however, based on changing circumstances, they may be
further refined in the OPORD. For continuing operations, any further
changes are specified in follow-on FRAGOs. The overall commander approves
these rules with advice from the SJA, the CMO, the political advisor
(POLAD), and others as required.
FORCE-PROTECTION LEVELS
N-4. DOD Directive 2000.12 sets out the DOD Antiterrorism/Force
Protection Program responsibilities. DOD Directive 0-2000.12H establishes
guidance for force-protection levels. DOD Instruction 2000.16, sets out the
responsibilities of establishing force-protection levels. Full references can be
downloaded from http://www.dtic.mil/whs/directives/.
N-5. The graduated series of force-protection conditions range from
force-protection conditions normal to force protection conditions delta (Table
N-1). The four-force protection conditions above normal are—
• Force-Protection Conditions ALPHA: These conditions apply when
there is a general threat of possible terrorist activity against
personnel and facilities, the nature and extent of which are
unpredictable, and circumstances do not justify full implementation of
force protection conditions BRAVO measures. The measures in these
force protection conditions must be capable of being maintained
indefinitely.
N-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
References: No change.
1. Rules of Engagement.
a. ROE will be briefed in detail to all soldiers upon issuance of each 1-19 TF OPLAN/OPORD/FRAGO.
The commander will resolve conflicts between ROE and the 1-19 TF OPLAN/OPORD/FRAGO.
b. Nothing in these rules limits the rights of individual soldiers to defend themselves or the rights and
responsibilities to leaders to defend their units.
c. ROE follow:
1) SOLDIERS CARD: You will carry this card at all times.
2) MISSION: Your mission is to assist in the implementation of and to help ensure
compliance with this peacekeeping operation.
3) SELF DEFENSE:
a) You have the right to use necessary and proportional force in self-defense.
b) You will use only the minimum force necessary to defend yourself.
4) GENERAL RULES:
a) You will use only the minimum force necessary to accomplish your mission.
b) You will not harm hostile force/belligerents who want to surrender. Disarm them
and turn them over to your superiors.
c) You will treat everyone, including civilians and detained hostile
forces/belligerents, humanely.
d) You will collect and care for the wounded, whether friend or foe.
e) You will respect private property. Do not steal. Do not take war trophies.
f) You will prevent or report to your superiors all suspected violations of the Law
of Armed Conflict.
5) CHALLENGING AND WARNING SHOTS:
a) If the situation permits, issue a challenge:
English: U.S. Forces! STOP or I WILL FIRE
Local Language #1: U.S. Forces! STOP or I WILL FIRE!
Local Language #2: U.S. Forces! STOP or I WILL FIRE!
b) If the person fails to halt, you may be authorized by the on-scene commander
or by standing orders to fire a warning shot.
6) OPENING FIRE: You may open fire only if you, friendly forces, or persons or property
under your protection is threatened with deadly force. This means that:
a) You may open fire against an individual who fires or aims a weapon at, or
otherwise demonstrates intent to imminently attack you, friendly forces, or
persons or property designated as under your protection.
b) You may open fire against an individual who plants, throws, or prepares to
throw an explosive or incendiary device at, or otherwise demonstrates intent to
imminently attack you, friendly forces, or persons or property designated as
under your protection.
c) You may open fire against an individual deliberately driving a vehicle at you,
friendly forces, or persons or property designated as under your protection.
d) You may fire against an individual who attempts to take possession of friendly
force weapons, ammunition, or property designated as under your protection if
there is no other way to prevent this act.
e) You may use minimum force, including opening fire, against an individual who
unlawfully commits or is about to commit an act which endangers life, in
circumstances if there is no other way to prevent the act.
7) MINIMUM FORCE: If you have to open fire, you must:
a) Fire only aimed shots.
b) Fire no more rounds than necessary.
c) Take all reasonable efforts to avoid unnecessary destruction of property.
d) Stop firing as soon as the situation is resolved.
e) Refrain from intentional attack on civilians, or property that is exclusively
civilian or religious in character unless the property is being used for military
purposes or engagement is authorized by your commander.
N-2
Appendix N
N-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
N-4
Appendix O
Environmental Considerations
This appendix provides guidance on how to attain balance between mission
accomplishment and protection of the natural and physical environment. ARs
200-1 and 200-2 provide information on Army environmental programs. FM
4-04.4 (FM 3-100.4[20-400]) lists items of interest in the preparation for daily
operations, training, and combat operations while respecting the natural and
physical environment.
COMMANDER
O-1. Commanders must instill an environmental ethic in their subordinate
leaders, staffs, and soldiers. They train and counsel subordinate leaders to
monitor potential environmental hazards to the environment and enforce
compliance with laws and regulations.
O-2. AVUM and AVIM commanders have unique environmental concerns
and responsibilities. HHC commanders who supervise ground maintenance
activities and NBC and Class III operations have similar responsibilities.
Table O-1 shows points of contact available to assist commanders in
environmental matters.
STAFF
O-3. Primary staff officers and NCOs integrate environmental considerations
into the MDMP in operations and training. At battalion and above level, the
commander appoints an assistant staff officer to serve as the environmental
compliance officer (ECO) for the unit. Nevertheless, all staff officers must
integrate environmental considerations into their activities. The S3 and S4
have the major responsibilities.
FLIGHT SURGEON
O-4. The flight surgeon monitors potential environmental hazards that could
affect the health of soldiers in the command. When deployed, monitoring
could include regional health matters such as water quality, air pollution,
and environmental, endemic, and epidemic diseases. He monitors
environmental considerations—such as smoke, chemical, and biological
weapons—that the enemy could impose on the friendly force. He monitors
field sanitation to ensure elimination of unnecessary environmental
disruption and danger to soldiers from unsanitary conditions.
O-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
O-2
Appendix O
leaders must enforce proper use of HM and disposal of HW, while ensuring
safe temporary storage of the same. Proper disposal and recycling of oil,
coupled with the use of drip pans, ensure compliance with applicable
regulations.
SUBORDINATE LEADERS
O-11. The role of leaders in environmental stewardship centers on building
an environmental ethic in their soldiers by training, operating, and
maintaining/sustaining in an environmentally responsible manner. Leaders
counsel subordinates, lead by example, and enforce compliance by holding
soldiers accountable. Leaders do the following:
• Communicate the Army environmental-friendly ethic while training
soldiers to operate properly.
O-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
SOLDIERS
O-12. Soldiers have the inherent professional and personal responsibility to
understand and support the Army’s environmental program. They must do
the following:
• Comply with environmental requirements in unit and installation
SOPs.
• Maintain environmental awareness throughout daily activities.
• Provide recommendations to the chain of command on techniques that
ensure compliance with environmental regulatory requirements.
• Identify the environmental risks associated with individual and team
tasks.
• Support recycling programs.
• Report HM and HW spills immediately.
• Make sound environmental decisions based on guidance from the
chain of command, training, and personal concepts of right and wrong.
O-4
Appendix O
ASSESSMENT
O-16. The training process begins with an assessment of unit strengths and
weaknesses and a plan to sustain strengths while improving areas of
weakness. This process applies equally to the unit’s environmental
awareness and compliance. Commanders identify and assess known
environmental risks during training planning.
LONG-RANGE PLAN
O-17. During long-range planning, units create the long-range training
calendar based on major training area availability, training ammunition and
O-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
SHORT-RANGE PLAN
O-19. Short-range planning refines and defines the broad guidance of the
long-range calendar. It is often a quarterly plan. During short-range
planning, units prepare for upcoming training by reviewing existing
environmental procedures and guidance; updating as required, the unit SOP
and risk assessment matrices; and training soldiers on any new procedures.
Activities with an environmental focus during this phase include—
• Briefing the commander and staff.
• Reconnoitering the training site.
• Obtaining maps or overlays indicating environmentally sensitive
areas.
• Coordinating with the environmental management office to identify
recent changes in environmental conditions.
• Planning for HM/HW storage and transport.
• Reviewing spill-prevention measures.
• Modifying plans as necessary.
NEAR-TERM PLAN
O-20. Near-term planning defines specific actions for executing the short-
range plan. It is the final phase of planning before training execution. During
this phase, leaders exercise an environmental focus by—
• Briefing soldiers on environmental constraints and issues and
modifying plans as necessary.
• Rehearsing the training to include the environmental awareness
preventive measures built in and cleanup contingencies planned.
• Checking equipment for oil and fuel leaks and identifying HW
disposal locations at the training site.
• Planning for HM/HW storage and spill containment.
• Ensuring that subordinate unit SOPs meet the requirements for the
specific training site.
O-6
Appendix O
TRAINING EXECUTION
O-21. Precombat checks help ensure adequate preparation for training to
standard. Leaders execute precombat checks by—
• Briefing environmental considerations as part of the OPORD.
• Including environmental considerations in the safety checks and crew
briefings.
• Verifying completion of PMCS on vehicles, refueling equipment,
weapons, communications, and NBC equipment to include checks for
leaks and serviceability.
• Checking and confirming that vehicle load plans ensure security of
HM and equipment to contain spills.
O-22. During training execution, leaders continue to monitor potential risks
to the natural and physical environment by—
• Conducting environmental awareness training.
• Supervising high-risk operations.
• Conducting periodic environmental assessments.
• Correcting problems on the spot.
• Avoiding off-limits areas.
• Preventing and containing spills.
• Reporting damage accurately and in a timely manner.
• Removing HM/HW in a timely and appropriate manner.
EVALUATION
O-23. Evaluation is continuous and integral to training. Leaders at every
level evaluate training. In the process, they discuss both the environmentally
correct and incorrect actions that may occur. The AAR process should include
environmental performance and should cover—
• Ensuring environmental accountability by identifying the problems
encountered during training and how the unit corrected them as they
arose.
• Ensuring HM/HW accountability by identifying how the unit
accounted for the HM/HW and any difficulties that it may have had
removing contaminated soil and restoring sites to near-original
condition.
• Identifying potential consequences of environmental damage that
make the damage a serious concern.
• Developing environmental lessons learned and suggested SOP
changes.
O-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
RISK MANAGEMENT
O-29. Preparation is key to successful environmental awareness and
protection in daily operations and training. Commanders (company and
O-8
Appendix O
O-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
SUMMARY
O-35. Unit leaders use environmental risk assessments to estimate the
potential effect of unit activities on the natural and physical environment.
This process applies to routine activities, training, mobilization, or
deployment. The environmental risk assessment allows leaders and their
staffs to identify potential environmental problems. The process also allows
unit leaders to identify and manage residual risk.
O-10
Appendix P
GENERAL
P-1. JAAT is an engagement technique used to increase the effectiveness of
offensive or defensive operations by combining the firepower of fixed-wing
aircraft with that of armed rotary-wing aircraft. Artillery or NSFS fires—
along with direct fires from ground forces—should be employed, whenever
possible, to increase the synergistic effect. The attack may be against a single
enemy element or several enemy elements within a specified area. Air
cavalry and attack helicopter assets are often called upon to employ an
immediate or spontaneous JAAT while conducting their assigned missions.
This combination gives both the Army aviation team and CAS team greater
survivability while increasing the effectiveness of their firepower and
complicating the enemy’s movements.
PROCEDURES
P-2. The JAAT works best when helicopter and fixed-wing pilots
communicate directly. Detailed attack synchronization is sometimes
necessary; however, the most valuable attribute of a JAAT is the ability to
respond rapidly to an opportunity and overwhelm the enemy by applying
enormous amounts of firepower within a short time. All coordination
measures and communications should be directed toward achieving this
effort, while minimizing the potential for fratricide and maximizing the
survivability of the participants. Supporting units should address JAAT in
their SOPs and training programs.
NIGHT SYSTEMS
P-3. Modern systems enable JAAT operations anytime, day or night, at any
place on the battlefield. AH-64 systems include NVG and FLIR and, in the
AH-64D, millimeter wave radar. OH-58D systems include NVG and a TIS.
Air Force ground-attack aircraft are equipped with NVG as well as IR
pointers and may carry IR and white-light flares. Some F-16s are equipped
with low altitude navigation target infrared night (LANTIRN) pods and
NVG. Marine and Navy F/A-18 and AV-8 aircraft may be equipped with a
FLIR or a targeting pod, and their pilots usually are equipped with NVG. The
night capabilities that these systems provide make night JAAT operations
particularly effective but require close coordination and frequent training
with Air Force, Navy, and Marine air units.
P-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
SECTION II – PLANNING
PLANNING TEAM
P-4. Ground and aviation commanders use their S3s, FSOs, and the TACP to
plan the JAAT mission. Air commanders may use the FAC, TACP, air
support operations center (ASOC), air operations center (AOC), wing ground
LNO, or squadron commanders.
COMMANDER
P-5. The ground-maneuver force commander is responsible for the ground
and airspace below the coordinating altitude within the JAAT AO. The
supported commander synchronizes the JAAT into the battle and brings
these combined fires into play at the decisive moment.
TACTICAL AIRCRAFT
P-7. CAS assets that normally perform CAS are the Air Force A/OA-10 and
F-16, Navy F/A-18, and Marine AV-8 and F/A-18; but other aircraft may be
employed. The Air Force A/OA-10 provides the most flexible support to
JAATs and has several advantages over other aircraft. A/OA-10s were
specifically designed for and dedicated to the CAS mission. Their night-attack
capabilities have increased with the fielding of NVG and associated
equipment. The A/OA-10 has extensive loiter and multipass capabilities and
can react quickly to a changing attack plan. Other CAS assets do not possess
the extended loiter capability of the A/OA-10 but are capable because of their
LANTIRN or targeting pods, FLIRs, or NVG. The availability of aerial
refueling assets can greatly increase both loiter time and payloads carried by
attack aircraft.
P-2
Appendix P
suppress or destroy enemy AD, force armored vehicles to deploy, and create
confusion within the C2 of the element under fire. The FSO coordinates with
the Air Force TACP located at a ground-maneuver brigade, aviation brigade,
division, or corps headquarters so that FS fits smoothly into the plan. Once
the JAAT mission begins, the AMC works directly with the FSO to coordinate
FS.
MISSION PLANNING
P-10. Constant coordination is required between the commander, AMC, CAS
flight lead/ALO/FAC, and FSO. As elements of the mission change, all
members must be informed so that they can adjust their plans accordingly.
Success of the JAAT depends on the proper synchronization of assets and
how well each member of the JAAT understands the operation. JAAT
operations may be preplanned, immediate, or spontaneous.
PREPLANNED
P-11. A preplanned JAAT operation is used when time is available to request
CAS in the normal planning cycle (usually 36 hours). The preplanned request
is drafted by the FSO in coordination with the TACP and processed through
Army channels to the AOC. The AOC processes the request according to
priorities established by the joint force commander. Approved preplanned
JAATs will appear on the ATO with the number of sorties, times, and
ordnance.
IMMEDIATE
P-12. An immediate request for CAS is used when time is not available to
process the request within the normal planning cycle. An immediate CAS
request should be submitted as soon as the need is recognized.
SPONTANEOUS
P-13. A spontaneous JAAT operation occurs when all members of the team
are available but no time is available to plan and coordinate. Spontaneous
JAAT operations depend on unit SOPs, training, and communications. A
successful JAAT operation is possible anytime that pilots are able to
coordinate actions by talking with each other. A common JAAT radio
frequency that can be used by the team members is a critical portion of a
spontaneous operation and should be included in SOI and Air Force ATOs. A
common frequency allows the AMC to communicate and coordinate his
attacks with the CAS aircraft in a minimal amount of time.
SEQUENCING
P-14. A well-orchestrated operation normally requires a number of radio
calls. To minimize radio traffic, commanders often use a preplanned method
of coordinating JAAT activities.
P-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
based on time. To initiate the JAAT, the aviation AMC updates the target
information and issues the CAS a time hack (three minutes is the most
common) that starts the JAAT clock. The time hack serves as the TOT for the
CAS. CAS has ordnance impact or is over the target when the JAAT clock
runs out. The AMC can employ fires throughout the JAAT clock, except
during a safety buffer (normally 30 seconds) before the TOT. This safety
buffer ensures that residual ordnance effects of the impacting rounds do not
endanger CAS. The aviation AMC employs additional fires, as required,
suppressing the enemy during the CAS egress. A reattack can be either
immediate or based on an abbreviated JAAT clock. An example of a typical
engagement follows:
• AMC coordinates the attack, then calls “three-minute hack—ready,
ready, hack.”
• CAS lead responds with “good hack.”
• AMC engages the target with indirect fires, as required, to suppress
the enemy.
• CAS departs the initial point as required, to meet the three-minute
TOT.
• AMC ensures “check fire” on all indirect fires at the required time;
this time is calculated by subtracting the required safety buffer (30
seconds) and the artillery time-of-flight (generally 10 to 30 seconds)
from the TOT. The AMC may continue to suppress with direct fire
weapons using visual separation.
• CAS engages the target at the three-minute mark.
• AMC issues CAS “reattack” or “return to initial point” and suppresses
with direct fire to cover the CAS egress.
P-4
Appendix P
EMPLOYMENT
P-18. Employment of the JAAT depends on the factors of METT-TC. The
commander selects the method of employment as early as possible so that
attacking assets can be coordinated. The two basic employment methods are
sector attacks and combined attacks. Sector attacks allow each element of the
JAAT to attack within a specified sector. Combined attacks occur when JAAT
elements mass their fires by attacking in the same sector.
P-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
SECTOR ATTACKS
P-19. The three types of sector attacks are sector-simultaneous, sector-
sequential, and sector-random. Sectors work best when easily recognizable
terrain features—such as roads, rivers, ridgelines, or tree lines—are used.
Sectoring the target (Figure P-4) reduces targeting conflicts and provides
each weapon with system flexibility in prioritizing the targets within the
designated sector.
SECTOR-SIMULTANEOUS
P-20. During sector-simultaneous attacks, each element maneuvers to attack
within its assigned sector to engage targets simultaneously with other JAAT
elements. All aircraft must coordinate ordnance fans to reduce the potential
for fratricide.
SECTOR-SEQUENTIAL
P-21. During sector-sequential attacks, each element maneuvers to attack
within its assigned sector in a predetermined sequence. This sequence may
range from several seconds to several minutes. This option reduces the
ordnance fan coordination problem and facilitates covering fire for each
preceding element.
SECTOR-RANDOM
P-22. During sector-random attacks, each element maneuvers to attack
within its assigned sector and engages targets at will. All elements must
coordinate ordnance fans to reduce the potential for fratricide.
COMBINED ATTACKS
P-23. The three types of combined attacks are combined-simultaneous,
combined-sequential, and combined-random. Combined attacks usually
involve armed helicopters and CAS using about the same avenue of approach
to the target. Combined attacks typically provide good mutual support
between the different elements but require more coordination and are more
predictable to the enemy after the initial attack.
P-6
Appendix P
P-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
COMBINED-SIMULTANEOUS
P-24. During combined-simultaneous attacks, all elements engage targets in
the same sector and attack simultaneously. All elements must coordinate
ordnance fans to reduce the potential for fratricide. Combined-simultaneous
attacks maximize destruction of the enemy and are the simplest to control.
This method is an excellent control method when FA fires are not available or
when elements can use maximum ordnance elevation for deconfliction of
airspace.
COMBINED-SEQUENTIAL
P-25. During combined-sequential attacks, all elements engage targets in the
same sector and attack in a predetermined sequence. This sequence may
range from several seconds to several minutes. This option reduces the
ordnance fan coordination problem and facilitates covering fire for each
preceding element. Use of the JAAT clock method is an example of a
combined sequential.
COMBINED-RANDOM
P-26. During combined-random attacks (Figure P-5), all elements engage
targets in the same sector and attack at will. Once again, all elements must
coordinate ordnance fans to reduce the potential for fratricide because
attacks may inadvertently be simultaneous.
CONDUCT OF OPERATIONS
P-27. After receiving the mission, the task force conducts mission analysis in
as much detail as time allows. Units conduct planning, coordination,
analysis, and rehearsals to ensure success.
FIRE SUPPORT
P-29. During reconnaissance, the AMC establishes contact with the unit
providing indirect FS. This contact should continue throughout the mission,
with the AMC serving as the FS element on the battlefield. He should
consider using artillery before direct fire engagements. Planners must keep
in mind that obscurants generated by the impacting rounds may interfere
with laser range finders and designators, degrading the effectiveness of
precision-guided munitions.
P-8
Appendix P
ROTARY-WING SECTOR
P-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
with the arrival of the CAS at the initial point. As the armed helicopters
arrive, the teams take up their positions and begin their attack according to
the scheme of maneuver. The attack should begin by engaging AD targets
identified during the reconnaissance. The remainder of the teams attack
enemy forces according to the priorities provided in orders.
COMMUNICATIONS
P-34. The communications link between members of the JAAT is critical.
The aviation S3 or S6 must procure and disseminate the needed frequencies
before the CAS arrives at the initial point.
COMMUNICATIONS
P-35. Communications are the key to effective JAAT operations. The Have
Quick radio system on the AH-64, OH-58D, and CAS aircraft allows jam-
resistant, nonsecure, frequency-hopping communications with ALO or FAC
and CAS elements. The armed helicopters and the TACP must coordinate the
frequencies to be used before the CAS arrives at the initial point. Aircrews
use the CAS check-in briefing below (Figure P-6) to coordinate the voice
frequencies, digital data frequencies, and laser codes between the CAS and
armed helicopters.
P-10
Appendix P
LASER DESIGNATION
P-36. The AH-64 and OH-58D laser designators can mark sectors, targets,
and enemy positions for CAS equipped with proper sensing devices. The FAC
is responsible for coordinating the laser code used.
COMMUNICATIONS
P-37. CAS and FAC aircraft are equipped with jam-resistant, nonsecure,
frequency-hopping communications via the Have Quick II radio. They are
also equipped with other communications systems (VHF-AM and VHF-FM,
additional UHF radio, and data link) depending on the participating aircraft.
PRECISION MUNITIONS
P-38. Precision munitions offer improved effects on the targeted enemy force.
Laser-guided munitions can destroy bridges and other priority targets while
allowing CAS greater survivability. The IR and optically guided versions of
the Maverick missile provide precision hard- and moving-target kill
capability.
P-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
BRIEFING
P-40. In the absence of the FAC, the AMC briefs the JAAT. AMCs must be
familiar with responsibilities detailed in FM 3-09.33 (FM 90-21).
P-12
Appendix Q
Air-Ground Integration
SECTION I – GENERAL
Q-1. Operations must be integrated so that air and ground forces can
simultaneously work in the battlespace to achieve a common objective.
Integration maximizes combat power through synergy of both forces. The
synchronization of aviation operations into the ground commander's scheme
of maneuver may require the integration of other services or coalition
partners. It may also require integration of air cavalry, attack, assault, and
cargo helicopters.
Q-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
SITUATIONAL AWARENESS
Q-7. Attack and air cavalry units often engage targets near friendly forces
and noncombatants. This situation may occur during various types of
operations—shaping, decisive, and sustaining. Aircrews must have
knowledge of friendly force and noncombatant locations. Procedures for
positive identification of enemy forces are required.
SYNCHRONIZATION OF WEAPONS
Q-8. The main reason for using several weapons systems at once is to
overwhelm the enemy with more than it can counter. When possible, units
sequence the employment of CAS, indirect fires, direct fires, and armed
helicopters so closely as to seem simultaneous in fire effects. Fires are lifted
or shifted at the most advantageous time for ground elements to overwhelm
the objective before the enemy can offer effective opposition.
Q-9. Army aviators may be the key in controlling the employment of multiple
weapons systems because of their vantage point on the battlefield and their
ability to quickly relocate. Aviation units must routinely train with ground
units so that they can effectively employ other Army and joint weapons
systems.
GENERAL
Q-10. True integration occurs when the commander effectively uses every
available asset to its fullest extent. The following are some available assets
and capabilities:
• Satellites provide information concerning enemy location and
movements, weather, terrain, and obstacles.
• JSTARS aircraft provide real-time information on enemy formations,
direct TACAIR strikes, and furnish targeting data for other weapons
systems.
• UAVs operate from immediately in front of the ground forces to deep
into the enemy rear; they provide information and targeting data and,
if armed, may attack enemy formations and installations.
• EW systems provide interception, disruption, deception, and targeting
information.
• CAS elements destroy enemy formations and installations.
• Air and ground cavalry units search in front of the ground force,
confirm enemy strengths and weaknesses, protect flanks, and allow
the commander to orient on threats or exploit opportunities.
Q-2
Appendix Q
OFFENSE
Q-11. Reports from aviation units, UAVs, JSTARS, and satellites provide
valuable tactical information. These systems’ higher vantage points and long-
range sensor devices assist in directing ground vehicles against enemy
elements that ground elements cannot detect. Enemy forces can be identified,
engaged and destroyed, blocked or bypassed, as desired, by the maneuver
commander. Air cavalry and attack helicopters are positioned ahead, behind,
or to the flanks of the ground formation. Ground units in movement to
contact, exploitation, or pursuit can markedly increase movement rates when
preceded by air cavalry or attack helicopters.
DEFENSE
Q-12. A defensive example of integrated operations is a counterpenetration
mission (Chapter 4). In this type of mission, the aviation brigade may be
tasked to coordinate directly with the defending ground brigade to develop
EAs to destroy penetrating enemy forces before they can get to the ground-
BSA. This complex operation requires full understanding by both the ground
and air elements. All ground and air units must know the EAs to reduce the
potential for fratricide. Aviators must positively identify targets to avoid
engaging friendly troops who may not have cleared the area or may have
mistakenly entered. Buffer zones and fire-control measures must be
established.
Q-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
GENERAL
Q-14. Mission planning encompasses mission training, mission rehearsal,
and mission execution. During planning, the commander and staff visualize
how the battlefield will look at various stages. They war-game the scheme of
maneuver and anticipate enemy COAs at critical points. They plan friendly
integrated aviation-ground COAs necessary to maintain the initiative. They
also determine branches and sequels for the commander to exploit enemy
actions, reactions, and weaknesses.
Q-15. Training exercises validate planning, training, and rehearsal. The
outcome of the training exercise tells the commander where to place
emphasis for future training and where to focus sustainment training (Figure
Q-1).
Mission Planning
Mission Execution
Q-4
Appendix Q
• Situation including friendly forces’ location, enemy situation highlighting known ADA
threat in the AO, mission request, and tentative EA coordinates.
• Brigade- and battalion-level graphics update via MCS or AMPS or via radio
communications, updating critical items—such as LOA, fire-control measures, and
maneuver graphics—to better integrate into the friendly scheme of maneuver.
• Fire support coordination information: location of DS artillery and organic mortars,
and call signs and frequencies.
• Ingress/egress routes into the AO; this includes passage points into sector or zone
and air routes to the HA or LZ.
• Call signs and frequencies of the battalion in contact, down to the company in
contact; air-ground coordination must be done on command frequencies to provide
SA for all elements involved.
• GPS and SINCGARS time coordination; care must be taken to ensure that all units
are operating on the same time.
Figure Q-2. Minimum Brigade Planning Requirements
Q-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
DECONFLICTION
Q-24. Deconfliction is a continual process for ground, aviation, and other
supporting units. During planning and execution, aviation units must
deconflict their operations with friendly units:
• Indirect fires, including mortars.
• CAS.
• UAVs.
• Air defenses.
• Smoke operations.
• Other internal aviation operations.
• Nonorganic aviation operations.
• Other services’ delivery systems such as supply drops.
• Maneuver/movements for combat, CS, and CSS units.
Q-6
Appendix Q
Q-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
ensures that rotor wash, backblast, ammunition casing expenditure, and the
general signature of aircraft do not interfere with operations on the ground or
reveal ground unit positions. The offset position also allows aircraft to engage
the enemy on its flanks, rather than its front, and lessens the risk of
fratricide along the helicopter gun-target line. The scout platoon or other
friendly forces must clear any positions over which helicopters may hover or
orbit to preclude engagement by hidden enemy forces.
Q-31. The AMC provides the ground maneuver unit leader with his concept
for the operation. This briefing may be as simple as relaying the direction of
aircraft approach or attack route and time required to move to the
recommended BP. On completion of coordination with the lowest unit in
contact, the flight departs the holding or orbit area.
WEAPONS SELECTION
Q-32. Anything that kills the enemy for the ground force should be used.
Hellfire is the preferred system for armor or hardened targets; however,
Hellfire may be appropriate for use against a machine-gun position, bunker,
or even an individual if that is what is required to assist the ground unit.
Area fire weapons, such as gun systems and 2.75-inch rockets, are preferred
for engaging troops in the open and other soft targets such as trucks and
trenchworks. A Hellfire will usually not destroy the bunker unless it
detonates ammunition or explosives stored in the bunker. It is important to
note that the machine-gun crew may have been killed although the bunker
appears undamaged.
Q-8
Appendix Q
Q-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
MARKING
Q-34. There are various ways to mark a location or target. The effectiveness
of vision systems on helicopters compares to those found on ground vehicles.
During the day, the vision systems of the AH-64 and the OH-58D allow
accurate identification of targets. During periods of reduced visibility,
resolution is greatly degraded, requiring additional methods of verification.
This situation requires extra efforts from both the ground unit and aviation
element.
Q-35. Some U.S. weapons can kill targets beyond the ranges that thermal,
optical, and radar acquisition devices can provide positive identification. Both
aviation and ground forces may become overloaded with tasks in the heat of
battle. Simple, positive identification procedures must be established and
known to all.
Q-10
Appendix Q
Infrared Marking
Q-39. IR pointers and other IR devices can be used to mark targets at night
for aircrews who are using NVGs; however, aircrews using other NVDs—such
as FLIR or TIS—may not be able to see the mark. Unlike laser designators,
these IR devices cannot be used to guide or improve the accuracy of aircraft
ordnance. IR pointers may expose friendly units to an enemy with night-
vision capability and should be used with caution. Ground units should
initiate IR marks requested by the aircrew and continue until the aircrew
transmits “TERMINATE” or the weapon hits the target.
Backup Marks
Q-41. Whenever a mark is provided, a plan for a backup mark should be
considered. For example, direct fire may be tasked to deliver the primary
mark, while a mortar may be assigned responsibility for the backup mark.
SUMMARY
Q-42. Table Q-1 suggests methods for identifying friendly forces and enemy
targets.
Q-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
FRIENDLY TARGET
METHOD DAY NIGHT NVG NVS REMARKS
MARKS MARKS
Smoke Go No Go Marginal No Go Good Good Easy ID. May compromise
friendly position, obscure
target, or warn of FS
employment. Placement
may be difficult because of
terrain, trees, or structures.
Smoke (IR) Go Go Go No Go Good Good Easy ID. May compromise
friendly position, obscure
target, or warn of FS
employment. Placement
may be difficult because of
terrain, trees, or structures.
Night marking is greatly
enhanced by the use of IR
reflective smoke.
Illumination, Go Go Go No Go NA Good Easy ID. May wash out
Ground NVDs.
Burst
Signal Mirror Go No Go No Go No Go Good NA Avoids compromise of
friendly location. Depends
on weather and available
light. May be lost in
reflections from other
reflective surfaces such as
windshields, windows, or
water.
Spot Light No Go Go No Go Good Marginal Highly visible to all.
Go Compromises friendly
position and warns of FS
employment. Effectiveness
depends on the degree of
ambient lighting.
IR Spot No No Go Go No Go Good Marginal Visible to all NVGs.
Light Go Effectiveness depends on
the degree of ambient
lighting.
IR Laser No No Go Go No Go Good Marginal Effectiveness depends on
Pointer Go the degree of ambient
(below .4 lighting.
watts)
IR Laser No No Go Go No Go Good Good Less affected by ambient
Pointer Go light and weather conditions.
(above .4 Highly effective under all but
watts) the most highly lit or worst
weather conditions. IZLID-2
is the current example.
Visual Laser No Go Go No Go Good Marginal Highly visible to all. High risk
Go of compromise. Effective,
depending upon degree of
ambient light.
Laser Go Go No Go Go NA Good Highly effective with
Designator precision-guided munitions.
Very restrictive laser-
acquisition cone and
requires LOS to target. May
require precoordination of
laser codes. Requires PGM
or LST equipped.
Q-12
Appendix Q
FRIENDLY TARGET
METHOD DAY NIGHT NVG NVS REMARKS
MARKS MARKS
Tracers Go Go Go No Go No Go Marginal May compromise position.
May be difficult to distinguish
mark from other gunfire.
During daytime use, may be
more effective to kick up
dust surrounding target.
VS-17 Panel Go No Go No Go No Go Good NA Easy to see when visibility is
good. Must be shielded from
the enemy.
IR Paper No No Go No Go Go Good NA Must be shielded from the
Go enemy. Affected by ambient
temperature.
AN/PAQ-4C No No Go Go No Go NA Good Effective to about 600
IR Aiming Go meters.
Light
AN/PEQ-2A No No Go Go No Go NA Good Effective to about 1,300
IR Aiming Go meters. Can illuminate the
Light, target.
Pointer,
Illuminator
Chem Light No Go Go No Go Good NA Must be shielded from
Go enemy observation. Affected
by ambient light. Spin to give
unique signature.
IR Chem No No Go Go No Go Good NA Must be shielded from
Light Go enemy observation. Affected
by ambient light. Spin to give
unique signature.
Strobe No Go Go No Go Excellent NA Visible to all. Affected by
Go ambient light.
IR Strobe No No Go Go No Go Excellent NA Effectiveness depends on
Go ambient light. Coded strobes
aid acquisition. Visible to all
with NVGs.
Flare Go Go Go Marginal Excellent NA Visible to all. Easily seen by
aircrew.
IR Flare No No Go Go No Go Excellent NA Easily seen by aircrews with
Go NVGs.
Glint/IR No No Go No Go Go Good NA Not readily detected by
Panel Go enemy. Effective except in
high ambient light.
Combat ID Go No Go No Go No Go Good NA Provides temperature
Panel contrast on vehicles or
building.
Chemical No No Go No Go Go Poor NA Can be lost in thermal
Heat Go clutter. Difficult to acquire.
Sources, Best to contrast a cold
MRE Heater background.
Briefing No Go Go No Go Fair Poor Short range.
Pointer Go
Electronic NA NA NA NA Excellent Good Ideal friendly marking for
Beacon AC-130 and some USAF
CAS. Not compatible with
Navy/Marines. Can be used
as a TRP. Coordination with
aircrew essential.
Hydra 70 Go Go Go Go NA Good Assists with direct fire and
Illumination adjustment of indirect fire.
Q-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
Q-44. Training at the home station with SOF may not be practical or
available. Commanders and staffs must be aware that SOF are probably in
theater, but their activities may not be published. Establishment of a
communications link with special operations units is essential to coordinate
operations.
Q-45. SOF are usually very well trained in the use of all assets. Their
expertise should make the flow of coordination with them simple, but in some
instances, the aviation force leader may have to use emergency coordination
measures.
Q-46. Commanders must train their staffs and soldiers to be flexible and
prepared to conduct liaison with and support elements that are not
traditionally included in home-station training. These organizations may
include the CIA, DOS, DEA, domestic and foreign police agencies, and
indigenous forces. General checklists may be developed to address concerns.
Often, these other agencies may not be aware of aviation capabilities. LNOs
must be ready to advise and assist the supported element.
Q-14
Appendix Q
Q-47. Close combat is inherent in maneuver and has one purpose—to decide
the outcome of battles and engagements. It is carried out with direct-fire
weapons and supported by indirect fire, CAS, and nonlethal engagement
means. Close combat defeats or destroys enemy forces or seizes and retains
ground. The range between combatants may vary from several thousand
meters to hand-to-hand combat. During close combat, attack and cavalry
aircraft may engage targets that are near friendly forces, thereby requiring
detailed integration of fire and maneuver of ground and aviation forces. To
achieve the desired effects and reduce the risk of fratricide, air-ground
integration must take place down to company, platoon, and team levels.
Close-combat engagements also require a higher training standard for aerial
weapons delivery accuracy.
Q-15
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
ENGAGEMENT
Q-56. A potential target may seem lucrative because of its apparent location
and activity, but visual acquisition and activity do not mean positive
identification. If there is no immediate threat from a specific target and it is
not positively identified, aircrews do not shoot until all possible measures to
identify are taken. Before the armed helicopter team engages, the target
must be confirmed by the aircrew and friendly unit in contact.
Q-57. During engagement, open communication and continuous coordination
with friendly ground elements are required to ensure the desired effect.
Coordination of the direct and indirect fires from all participants produces
the most efficient results in the least amount of time, with the least risk to
all. This coordination includes CAS and any nonlethal methods that may be
employed.
Q-16
Appendix Q
(Omit data not required. Do not transmit line numbers. Units of measure are standard
unless otherwise specified. *Denotes minimum essential in limited communications
environment. BOLD denotes readback items when requested.)
9. Egress direction:
(Cardinal direction not over threats)
(Threats, restrictions, danger close, attack clearance, SEAD, abort codes, hazards)
Q-17
FM 3-04.111 (FM1-111)
Q-18
Appendix Q
• Can the ground unit mark its position with smoke, tracers, or other
methods? (If smoke is used, aircrew verifies color after deployment.)
• What assistance does the ground unit need (FS, extraction, or
resupply)?
• Where is the target? What are the grid coordinates or the relationship
of the target to a readily identifiable natural or man-made feature?
• How far is the target from the ground unit and in what direction is it?
If the observer is not familiar with meters, aircrews ask the observer
to try football or soccer field lengths to estimate distances.
• What is the target? Is the target personnel, vehicles, equipment, or
buildings? What is the size of the enemy force, and what is it doing?
Q-61. Aviators may have to fly helicopters near friendly troops to deliver
ordnance onto the target. Factors that can reduce the potential for fratricide
include the following:
• Precision-guided munitions.
• Fire support coordination measures.
• Planned or hasty coordination and control measures (Figures Q-5
through Q-8).
• Knowledge of the ground tactical plan.
• Knowledge of the exact location of friendly troops.
• Knowledge of the exact location of aircraft.
• Positive identification of targets.
• Familiarity between the supported unit and the aviation unit.
Q-19
Appendix R
Urban Operations
Like so many urban battles, the battle of Hue was filled with ambiguity
and uncertainty. The North Vietnamese Army (NVA) and Viet Cong
attacked as part of the surprise Tet Offensive in 1968. Two NVA
regiments overran the city, systematically executing thousands of
inhabitants. The U.S. and South Vietnamese response was awkward and
piecemeal. The Americans rapidly shifted three Marine Corps battalions
from ongoing combat missions, and eventually, 13 South Vietnamese
battalions were committed. The Americans followed with the commitment
of the 3rd Brigade, 1st Cavalry, and a battalion task force of the 101st
Airborne as blocking forces to attempt to stop enemy reinforcement and
destroy its C2 and logistical links. There was no clear unity of command
over the various South Vietnamese and American forces, and the city was
never fully isolated by either side. The battle raged for 22 days before the
United States and its South Vietnamese allies achieved victory.
Casualties were high, as is often the case in urban combat: 1,004 United
States, 2,184 ARVN, and more than 5,000 NVA. Throughout the battle,
aviation played a critical role in observation, troop movement, gun
support, and MEDEVAC.
SECTION I – GENERAL
R-1. Operations in urban terrain follow the same basic planning and
execution methodology as in other terrain; however, special planning and
consideration of the characteristics unique to urban terrain are essential. See
Chapter 6. FM 3-06.1 (FM 1-130) and FM 3-06.11 (FM 90-10-1) contain
detailed information.
R-2. Whenever possible, aircrews avoid a fight in urban terrain. The
optimum choice is to surround, isolate, and bypass a city, ensuring that any
troops and resources in that city are rendered ineffective and unavailable to
support other enemy operations.
R-0
Appendix R
AH-64 UNITS
R-4. AH-64 units attack targets with direct fire to destroy enemy troops and
equipment. They also assist with ISR and communications, using their
advanced suite of sensors and radios.
OH-58D UNITS
R-5. OH-58D units perform the same functions as AH-64 units. They also
perform reconnaissance and security missions in and around urban areas.
ALL HELICOPTERS
R-7. Aircraft can also assist in radio relay and perform as aerial OPs and C2
platforms.
ASSESS
R-9. In the assess stage (Figure R-1), the unit identifies the portions of the
urban area essential to mission success.
AVIATION ASSESS MISSIONS
Lift (Utility/Cargo) Helicopter Units
• Provide CASEVAC.
• Conduct air movement of troops and supplies.
• Support C2 operations.
• Support EW operations.
• Support NEO.
Attack/Cavalry Helicopter Units
• Perform reconnaissance of urban peripheral area to establish enemy strength and
disposition.
• Conduct route and area reconnaissance for forces.
• Establish initial security of flanks and rear until relieved by ground forces.
• Perform air security.
• Provide suppressive fires in support of ground reconnaissance and security elements.
Figure R-1. Missions During the Assess Phase
R-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
SHAPE
R-10. In the shape phase, units isolate those areas essential to mission
success in the offense or avoid isolation in the defense. In the offense,
aviation forces attack to isolate the objective, move troops and supplies,
enhance C2, conduct reconnaissance, and augment ground forces. In the
defense, aviation forces help set the conditions for the main battle and
prevent isolation of friendly units (Figure R-2).
DOMINATE
R-11. In the dominate phase, units precisely mass the effects of combat
power to rapidly dominate the area (Figure R-3).
R-2
Appendix R
TRANSITION
R-12. In the transition phase, units transfer control of the urban area to
other agencies and prepare for follow-on operations. Aviation forces facilitate
the transition (Figure R-4).
AVIATION TRANSITION MISSIONS
Lift (Utility/Cargo) Helicopter Units
• Provide CASEVAC.
• Perform personnel and equipment recovery.
• Conduct air movement of troops and supplies.
• Emplace logistical resupply points and FARPs.
2
• Support C operations.
Attack/Cavalry Helicopter Units
• Provide screen or area security.
• Conduct route and area reconnaissance for forces.
• Serve as reserve.
• Conduct operations to set conditions for follow-on missions.
SHAPE/DOMINATE
R-13. The lines between shape and dominate phases are rarely crisp.
Aviation capabilities allow the commander to more quickly shape the
battlefield and move into the dominate phase. There are always sectors of the
battlefield that will be in different phases than in other sectors, demanding
the application of various techniques by the commander.
R-14. During the operation illustrated in Figure R-5, aviation provides—
• Security by screening the flanks of the operation.
• Reconnaissance of NAIs.
• Direct fire on the enemy from numerous positions.
• Air assault and air movement.
R-15. These actions are conducted in concert with—
• Ground attacks.
• Observation by satellites, UAVs, and other aerial platforms.
• Indirect fires.
• Sister-service CAS.
• Ground elements tasked to control underground avenues of approach
such as sewers and subway tunnels.
• MP and other ground elements tasked to control critical points and to
screen those people departing and entering the sector for combatants.
R-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
Rooftop
Landing Zone
Wealthy neighborhood
very pro-US.
LEGEND:
Potential
HOSTILE NEUTRAL FRIENDLY helicopter routes
R-4
Appendix R
R-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
R-24. Urban terrain is canalized and often provides severely limited fields of
fire. Structures tend to limit target views to a narrow corridor along the
street or from high angles over the buildings. Enemy forces may occupy
buildings or “hug” the near sides of buildings, putting them out of view of
armed helicopters. Engagements of rooftop targets can come from all angles.
Expect targets to move rapidly from cover to cover and require quick
engagement.
R-25. The threat to aircraft is lessened when firing from friendly-controlled
areas. Positions should be planned to provide flexibility for aircraft maneuver
to maximize cover and multiple firing positions and angles. When forced to
fight and fly over areas where the enemy has not been cleared, aviation forces
face extremely high risk. Aircrews can expect engagement from the ground
and upper floors of buildings. When these conditions exist, it is better to keep
the aircraft moving rapidly, making it harder to engage. Aircrews normally
conduct running fire engagements from an initial point, engaging the target
and returning to a safe area to regroup for another attack. The lead-wingman
concept is used for this type of attack. The wingman suppresses the target
during and after lead’s engagement and “covers his break.” Ground units
provide suppressive fires to protect the aircraft during their attack.
R-26. Aircrews plan for both hovering fire (Figure R-6) and running fire
(Figure R-7). Running fire generally offers better aircraft survivability. If
aircrews use hovering fire, they can unmask laterally or vertically from cover.
NAVIGATION
R-28. Navigation over urban terrain can be more difficult than over natural
terrain because most maps do not show the vertical development of urban
terrain. Cities are compartmented, causing small navigational errors to have
significant effect. High density of structures, variety of geographical
references, and similarity of structures can cause confusion. If electrical
power is still available, high ambient light levels can create problems with
NVD.
NAVIGATION TECHNIQUES
R-29. Effective navigation over large towns and cities requires a variety of
navigational systems and techniques. GPS eases the problems associated
with navigation and orientation but does not eliminate the need for other
navigational methods. Navigation systems may be degraded because of
interference induced by buildings and by GPS jammers. Aircrews must
closely monitor and cross-check their positions by all available means.
R-6
Appendix R
R-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
R-8
Appendix R
R-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
R-10
Appendix R
aircrews to make the transition to the system in use by the ground element
upon arrival in the objective area. For example, references to the objective or
target may include local landmarks such as “The third floor of the Hotel
Caviar, southeast corner.” This transition should be facilitated by using a
“big-to-small” acquisition technique.
R-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
FIRES
R-41. Some special considerations for fires in urban operations include the
following:
• Minimum arming range and minimum slant ranges within urban
areas limit the use of some weapons.
• Heavy concentration of precision weapon systems along a narrow front
may cause coordination problems.
• Even precision weapons can cause fratricide if planning is not precise.
R-12
Appendix R
THREAT
R-42. Some special considerations for the threat in urban operations include
the following:
• Enemy forces may infiltrate urban terrain and ambush helicopters
from positions inside buildings.
• Cover and concealment of urban terrain enable enemy force
concentration, increasing the risk of effective small-arms fire.
• RPGs provide significant threat, especially to slow-moving helicopters.
• Portable surface-to-air missile systems are difficult to detect in and
among buildings.
• Air defense ambush zones should be emplaced around or near likely
aerial routes, landing sites, or objectives.
• Because LZs may be scarce and, therefore, predictable, air-assault
operations in mass may be vulnerable to enemy fires.
WEATHER
R-43. Some special considerations for weather in urban operations include
the following:
• Smoke and fire in the built-up area cause obscuration.
• Urban areas directly affect weather, especially wind patterns
resulting in gusts and thermals.
• High concentration of man-made materials increases the risk of
exposure to toxic industrial materials.
TERRAIN
R-44. Some special considerations for terrain in urban operations include the
following:
• Obstacles—such as power lines, towers, and guidelines—may be more
numerous and dangerous than in any other environment.
• Buildings limit maneuverability, and engagement ranges are typically
shorter, affecting the ability of attack helicopters to employ weapons
at desired standoff ranges.
• Buildings may be used to mask friendly helicopter operations.
• Urban terrain masks intelligence and electronic warfare acquisition
capabilities.
R-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
R-14
Glossary
Glossary-1
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-11)
Glossary-2
Glossary
AR Army regulation
ARFOR Army forces
ARH active radar homing
ARSOA Army special operations aviation
arty artillery
ARVN Army of the Republic of Vietnam
ASAS all source analysis system
ASAS-L all source analysis system-light
ASB aviation support battalion
ASE aircraft survivability equipment
ASET aviation survivability equipment trainer
ASIP advanced system improvement program
ASL authorized stockage list
ASOC air support operations center
ASP ammunition supply point
ATACMS Army tactical missile system
ATAS air-to-air stinger
ATCCS Army tactical command and control system
ATKHB attack helicopter battalion
ATKHC attack helicopter company
ATM aircrew training manual
ATO air tasking order
ATP ammunition transfer point
ATS air traffic services
ATSO air traffic services officer
aux auxiliary
AVIM aviation intermediate maintenance
avn aviation
AVUM aviation unit maintenance
AWACS airborne warning and control system
AWS air weather service
BAS battlefield automated system
BCC battlefield circulation control
BCD battlefield coordination detachment
Glossary-3
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-11)
Glossary-4
Glossary
Glossary-5
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-11)
Glossary-6
Glossary
Glossary-7
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-11)
EP electronic protections
EPA evasion plan of action
EPLRS enhanced position location reporting system
EPW enemy prisoners of war
EQCC environmental quality control committee
ERFS extended range fuel system
ES electronic support
ESM electronic support measures
ESSS external stores support system
EW electronic warfare
EWO electronic warfare officer
f female
FA field artillery
FAA forward assembly area
FAC-A forward area controller-airborne
FAC forward area controller
FADDL forward air defense data link
FARE forward area refueling equipment
FARP forward arming and refueling point
FBCB2 force xxi battle command brigade and below
FBI Federal Bureau of Investigation
FCC fire control computer
FCR fire control radar
FEBA forward edge of the battle area
FEZ fighter engagement zone
FFA free fire area
FFIR friendly force information requirements
FID foreign internal defense
FLD field
FLIR forward looking infrared
FLIR/TV forward looking infrared/television
FLOT forward line of own troops
FM field manual; frequency modulation
FOIA freedom of information act
Glossary-8
Glossary
Glossary-9
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-11)
Glossary-10
Glossary
Glossary-11
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-11)
Glossary-12
Glossary
Glossary-13
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-11)
Glossary-14
Glossary
Glossary-15
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-11)
Glossary-16
Glossary
Glossary-17
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-11)
Glossary-18
Glossary
Glossary-19
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-11)
stdns standards
STP soldier training publication
SU situational understanding
TAB Theater Aviation Brigade
tac tactical
TAC Theater Aviation Company
TACCP tactical command post
TACAIR tactical air
TACLAN tactical local area network
TACAN tactical air navigation
TACON tactical control
TACP tactical air control party
TACS theater air control system
TACSAT tactical satellite
TACSOP tactical standing operating procedure
TDA table of distribution and allowances
TADIX-B tactical data information exchange-broadcast
TADS target acquisition designation sight
TAGS theater air-ground system
TAI target areas of interest
TAIS tactical airspace integration system
TALO theater airlift liaison officer
TAMMS The Army Maintenance Management System
TBD to be determined
TBFDS tactical bulk fuel delivery system
TBMCS theater battle management core system
TCIM tactical communication interface module
TCS tactical control system
TDR transmittal data relay
TESS tactical engagement simulator system
TF task force
TI tactical internet
TIBS tactical information broadcast service
TIS thermal imaging system
Glossary-20
Glossary
TM technical manual
TMD theater missile defense
TOC tactical operations center
TOD time of day
TOE table of organization and equipment
TOF time of flight
TOO tactical operations officer
TPFDD time phased force deployment data
TPL target priority lists
TPU tank and pump unit
TRAP tactical related applications
TRP target reference point
TSC theater support command
TSEC telecommunications security
TSS target selection standards
TTCS tactical terminal control system
TTP tactics, techniques, and procedures
TTT time to target
TV television
UAV unmanned aerial vehicle
UH utility helicopter
UHF ultra high frequency
ULLS Unit Level Logistics System
ULLS-A Unit Level Logistics System-Aviation
ULLS-G Unit Level Logistics System-Ground
ULLS-S4 Unit Level Logistics System-S4
UMO unit movement officer
UMT unit ministry team
U.S. United States
USA United States Army
USAAVNC United States Army Aviation Center
USAF United States Air Force
USMC United States Marine Corp
USASC United States Army Safety Center
Glossary-21
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-11)
Glossary-22
Bibliography
The bibliography lists field manuals by new number followed by old number. These publications
are sources for additional information on the topics in this Field Manual. Most joint publications
can be found at http://www.dtic.mil/doctrine/jel/. Most Army doctrinal publications are available
online at http://155.217.58.58/atdls.htm
Aviation Liaison Officer (LNO) Handbook, United States Army Aviation Center. July
2001.
Allied Administrative Publication-4 (AAP-4). NATO Standardization Agreements and
Allied Publications. 1 February 2003.
AR 55-162. Permits for Oversize, Overweight, or Other Special Military Movements on
Public Highways in the United States. 1 January 1979.
AR 95-1. Flight Regulations. 1 September 1997.
AR 200-1. Environmental Protection and Enhancement. 21 February 1997.
AR 200-2. Environmental Effects of Army Actions. 23 December 1988.
AR 385-10. The Army Safety Program. 23 May 1988.
AR 385-40. Accident Reporting and Records. 1 November 1994.
AR 385-55. Prevention of Motor Vehicle Accidents. 12 March 1987.
AR 385-64. U.S. Army Explosives Safety Program. 28 November 1997.
AR 385-95. Army Aviation Accident Prevention. 10 December 1999.
AR 700-138. Army Logistics Readiness and Sustainability. 16 September 1997.
AR 710-2. Inventory Management Supply Policy Below the Wholesale Level. 31 October
1997.
AR 750-1. Army Materiel Maintenance Policy and Retail Maintenance Operations. 1
August 1994.
ARTEP 54-23. Materiel Management Center, Corps Support Command and Theater
Army Area Command. 24 July 1984.
CTA 8-100. Army Medical Department Expendable/Durable Items. 31 August 1994.
CTA 50-900. Clothing and Individual Equipment. 1 September 1994.
CTA 50-909. Field and Garrison Furnishings and Equipment. 1 August 1993.
DA Form 2408-13-1. Aircraft Maintenance and Inspection Record. October 1992.
DA Form 2408-13-3. Aircraft Technical Inspection Workshee. November 1991.
DA PAM 385-40. Army Accident Investigation and Reporting. 1 November 1994.
DA PAM 25-30. Consolidated Index of Army Publications and Blank Forms. 1 April 2003.
DA PAM 710-2-1. Using Unit Supply System (Manual Procedures). 31 Dec 1997.
Bibliography-1
FM 3-04.111
Bibliography-2
Bibliography
Bibliography-3
FM 3-04.111
Bibliography-4
Bibliography
FM 4-30.13 (FM 9-13). Ammunition Handbook: Tactics, Techniques, and Procedures for
Munitions Handlers. 1 March 2001.
FM 4-30.31 (FM 9-43-2). Recovery and Battlefield Damage Assessment and Repair. 3
October 1995.
FM 4-93.2 (FM 63-2). Division Support Command, Armored, Infantry, and Mechanized
Infantry Divisions. 20 May 1991.
FM 4-93.4 (FM 63-4). Theater Support Command. 15 April 2003.
FM 4-100.9 (FM 100-9). Reconstitution. 31 January 1992.
FM 5-0 (FM 101-5). Staff Organization and Operations. 31 May 1997.
FM 5-19 (FM 100-14). Risk Management. 23 April 1998.
FM 6-0. Command and Control. TBP.
FM 6-20 (FM 3-09). Fire Support in the AirLand Battle. 17 May 1988.
FM 71-100-2. Infantry Division Operations, Tactics, Techniques, and Procedures. 31
August 1993.
FM 71-100-3. Air Assault Division Operations for Tactics, Techniques, And Procedures.
29 October 1996.
Joint Pub 0-2. Unified Action Armed Forces. 10 July 2001.
Joint Pub 1-0. Doctrine for Personnel Support to Joint Operations. 19 November 1998.
Joint Pub 1-02. Department of Defense Dictionary of Military and Associated Terms. 12
April 2001.
Joint Pub 1-05. Religious Ministry Support for Joint Operations. 26 August 1996.
Joint Pub 1-06. Joint Tactics, Techniques, and Procedures for Financial Management
During Joint Operations. 22 December 1999.
Joint Pub 2-0. Doctrine for Intelligence Support to Joint Operations. 9 March 2000.
Joint Pub 2-02. National Intelligence Support to Joint Operations. 28 September 1998.
Joint Pub 3-0. Doctrine for Joint Operations. 10 September 2001.
Joint Pub 3-09.3 Joint Tactics, Techniques, and Procedures for Close Air Support (CAS).
1 December 1995.
Joint Pub 3-50.2. Doctrine for Joint Combat Search and Rescue. 26 January 1996.
Joint Pub 3-50.21. Joint Tactics, Techniques and Procedures for Combat Search and
Rescue. 23 March 1998.
Joint Pub 3-50.3. Joint Doctrine for Evasion and Recovery. 6 September 1996.
Joint Pub 4-0. Doctrine for Logistic Support of Joint Operations. 6 April 2000.
Joint Pub 4-01. Joint Chief of Staff, Joint Doctrine for the Defense Transportation
System. 17 June 1997.
Joint Pub 4-02. Doctrine for Health Service Support in Joint Operations. 30 July 2001.
Bibliography-5
FM 3-04.111
Bibliography-6
Bibliography
Bibliography-7
FM 3-04.111
U.S. Army Center for Lessons Learned Newsletter No. 00-5, Aviation Operations at the
Joint Readiness Training Center, Chapter 3. Light-Army Aviation at the JRTC: Do
We Perform Search and Attack? March 2000.
U.S. Army Combat Training Center Quarterly Bulletin No. 99-3. The Dying Art of Battle
Rhythm. LTC Gene C. Kamena. January 1999.
U.S. Army Safety Center. Commander and Staff Risk Management Booklet. 6 January
1999.
U.S. Army Safety Center. Small Unit Risk Management Booklet. 6 January 1999.
Bibliography-8
Index
A Air Cavalry Troop (ACT), 1-56, Air Traffic Services (ATS), 3-
1-64, 1-72, 5-75, 5-83, 5-100, 118, 3-129, 3-133, 4-50, 5-47
Actions on contact, D-53
5-127 Air Traffic Services Team, F-20
Active Component. See Preface,
Air Combat Operations, 6-16; Airborne Warning and Control
I-92 - I-93, I-95
Planning Considerations, 6-17 System (AWACS), 5-34, 5-42,
Active Radar Homing (ARH), J-
Air Data Sensor Subsystem 5-174, 6-19, E-23
28
(ADSS), I-25 Aircraft,
Adjutant (S1), 3-112, 3-113, C-
Air Defense, 2-39, 5-16 - 5-18, AH-64A
26, E-54, E-57, K-114, K-128,
5-41 - 5-42, 5-66 - 5-68, 5-91 Description/Specifications,
O-4
- 5-92, 5-120 - 5-121, 5-149 - I-15 - I-17
Administrative and Logistics 5-150, 5-173 - 5-175, 5-194 -
(A&L), 3-212, 3-227, 3-242, 3- AH-64D
5-195, 5-211 - 5-212, 5-229
247 Description/Specifications,
Active,7-51 I-28 - I-32
Administrative and Logistics
Distruction of Enemy C-12
Operation Center (ALOC). 3-
(DEAD), I-33 Equipment/Specifications,
70 - 3-73, 3-191, 3-192
Friendly, D-45 I-80 - I-82
Administrative and Logistics Net,
3-224, 3-238, 3-242, E-54 Identification Zone (ADIZ), C-23
C-42 Equipment/Specifications,
Advanced Aviation Forward Area
Operations Areas, 7-44 I-89 - I-91
Refueling System (AAFARS),
F-73, F-149 Passive, 7-52 CH-47D
Equipment/Specifications,
Advanced Field Artillery Tactical Planning and Employment,
I-70 - I-72
Data System (AFATDS), K-47 7-42
HH-60L
Advanced System Improvement Short Range Engagement
Description/Specifications,
Program (ASIP), L-6 Zone (SHORADEZ), 7-45
I-59 - I-62
Aerial Mine Warfare. See Suppression of Enemy
OH-58D
Volcano (JSEAD), 3-118
Description/Specifications,
Aerial Port Of Debarkation Air Interdiction (AI), 3-38 I-1 - I-3
(APOD), C-15 Air Liaison Officer (ALO), 3-119 UH-60A/L
Aerial Ports of Embarkation Air Mission Commander (AMC), Description/Specifications,
(APOE), C-3 2-43, 4-41, 5-59 I-46 - I-48
Aeromedical Evacuation, G-11, Air Reconnaissance, B-7, H-7, Aircraft Survivability Equipment,
I-89 H-18, P-6 J-9 - J-19
Air and Missile Defense Work Air Support, Fundamentals, J-1
Station (AMDWS), 7-42, K-44,
Close Air Support (CAS), 1- Threat Weapon Sensors, J-
K-67 - K-68, K-70
101, 7-29, 7-34, 7-35 27 - J-31
Air and Naval Gunfire Liaison
Operations Center (ASOC), Aircraft UAV, Types/Capabilities,
Company (ANGLICO),G-22
P-4 H-20 - H-32
Air Assault Brigade (Air Assault
Air Tasking Order, 3-22, G-28 Air-Ground Engagement System
Division), 1-79 - 1-85
Cycle, G-33 (AGES), 1-23 - I-24, J-14
Air Assault Task Force and Air
Air-Ground Integration, 2-56, Q-1
Mission Commanders Development, G-37
Air-Ground Control, 2-59;
(AATFC), 3-243, 5-59, 5-193, Air Traffic Servcies Officer Command and Control, 2-58
5-228 (ATSO), 3-129
Fundamentals, 2-57
Index-1
FM 3-04.111
Air-Ground Integration Close Area of Operations (AO), 2-4, 2- Main Body Arrival, D-25;
Combat, 14, E-30, J-10, M-22, O-27, P- Security, D-33
Close Combat, Q-47 5 Rear, 3-193, 4-24
Engagement, Q-56 Area Weapons System, 2-14, I- Shared, D-15
19, I-20, I-35
Ground Maneuver Liaison, Staff Responsibilities, D-6 -
Q-21 - Q-23 Area Weather Service (AWS), F- D-13
309
Positive Target Attack Helicopter Battalion
Identification, Q-33 - Q- Army Tactical Command and (ATKHB), 1-30, 1-47, 1-78, 5-
43 Control System (ATCCS), 3-8, 112, F-114
3-115, E-17, K-19, K-44, L-12
Situational Awareness, Q-7 Attack Helicopter Brigade, Air
Army Airborne Command and Assault Division, 1-2, 1-71, 1-
Synchronization of
Control System (A2C2S), 3- 72, 1-75, 1-79, 1-80, 1-82
Weapons, Q-8, Q-9
233, 5-127, 5-156, 5-179, 5-
Airspace, Attack Helicopter Companies
200, E-23, E-47, E-60, L-1, L-
(ATKHC), 1-31, 1-47, 1-56, 1-
Airspace interface, G-1; 3, L-5, L-10
64, 1-72
Command and Control Army Aircraft Weapons
Authorized Stockage List (ASL),
(A2C2), G-1; Capabilities, 6-22
8-6, 8-58, 8-59
Control Authority (ACA), Army Air-Ground System
Automated Network Control
G-4; (AAGS), G-1 - G-2, G-31
Device (ANCD), E-5, E-28
Control Measures (ACM), Army Airspace Command and
Control (A2C2), 1-25, G-17, G- Automatic Direction Finder
3-143;
20 (ADF), I-25, I-43, I-95
Control Order (ACO), 3-23,
Communications, Automatic Link Establishment
G-6, G-28;
Connectivity, E-24, G-26 (ALE), 5-97, E-11, E-13, E-24,
Control Plan, G-28, G-29; E-33, E-66
Staff Responsibilities, G-17
Coordination Area, 7-23; Aviation
Army Battle Command System
Fire Control Measures, (ABCS), Command and Support of Ground Unit
7-43; Control, 3-249, E-39, K-16, K- Passage of Lines, 3-216,
High Density Airspace 19 4-40, 6-1 - 6-15
Control Zone (HIDACZ), Army Forces (ARFOR), 5-32, 5- Survivability Equipment
7-46 61, 5-161, 6-75, 7-16 Trainer (ASET),1-23
Air-To-Air Stinger (ATAS), 6-23 Army Tactical Missile System Aviation Brigade
All Source Analysis System (ATCAMS), 5-15, 5-36, 5-40, Airborne Division, 1-63, 1-
(ASAS), K-28, K-44, K-53 – 5-210 64, 1-66, 5-220
K-58 Army-Air Force Exchange Division Combat Support, 1-
All Source Analysis System— Service, 8-56 2, 1-92, 1-95
Light (ASAS-L), K-58 - K-60, ASE Systems Descriptions, J-9 - Employment Aspects, 5-1
L-1 J-19
Heavy Division, 1-2, 1-46, 1-
ALOC Organization, 3-192 Assault Helicopter Battalion 47, 1-50
ALSE NCO, 3-131 (AHB), 1-39, E-66, E-67
Missions, 1-6 - 1-8
Ammunition Supply Point (ASP), Assembly Area (AA), 2-12, 4-20,
Organization, 1-3 - 1-5
6-48, 8-51 - 8-52, F-88 D-1,
Types, 1-2
Ammunition Transfer Point Advance Party Operations,
(ATP), F-132 - F-133, 8-51 D-21 Aviation Intermediate
Maintenance (AVIM), 3-133,
Analysis and Control Element Forward (FAA), 4-23, D-4,
4-24, 5-22, 5-45, 5-73, 8-82 -
(ACE), K-54, K-58 D-17
8-85
Analysis and Control Team, K- Heavy, 4-22, D-3
Aviation Life Support Equipment
54, K-58 Improvement, D-32 (ALSE), 3-130, 3-131
Anti-Aircraft Artillery (AAA), J-28 ISR Plan, D-38 Aviation Life Support Officer
(ALSO), 3-130
Index-2
FM 3-04.111
Index-3
FM 3-04.111
Military Intelligence, 7-1 Commander's Tracked Item Computer Display Unit (CDU),
Military Police, 7-61 List (CTIL), K-114 I-25
Missions, 1-11 Common Ground Station (CGS), Concept of Battle Command, 3-1
E-18, K-17 Control, 3-5
Weather Teams, 7-75
Common Operating Environment Decision Making, 3-2;
Combat Support Aviation
(COE), K-5, K-9, K-18, K-24
Battalion (CSAB), 1-39 Leadership, 3-3
Common Operational Picture
Combat Training Centers (CTC), Continental U.S. (CONUS),
(COP), K-5 – K-9, K-18, K-45,
1-95, Q-5 3-87, 8-40, 8-76, 8-87
K-80, K96 – K-99, K-116,
Command and Control (C2), 2- K-131 Continuous Wave (CW), J-13
58, 3-7, 3-155, 3-187, 3-207, Coordinated Fire Line (CFL),
Examples, K-6;
5-23 7-18
Key to creating, K-87;
Airborne, 3-232; Corps Attack Helicopter
Common Tactical Picture (CTP),
BOS, 2-46; Regiment: Overview, 5-27
K-5, K-75
Main CP, 3-165; Corps Aviation Brigade, 1-25
Communications
Nets, 3-165; Attack Helicopter Regiment,
Airborne Relay, E-23
Reconstitution, 4-107 1-26, 1-29, 1-30, 1-33
Aircraft Radios
Systems, 3-155; Aviation Group, 1-38
Have Quick II, E-6 Fundamentals, 1-41;
UAV, 4-92;
SINCGARS, E-3 Mission, 1-38;
Warfare, 3-157
Improved data modem, Organization, 1-39
Command Aviation Battalion E-17
(CAB), 1-39 Corps Aviation Group: Overview,
HF, E-9 5-47
Command Aviation Companies
VHF, E-16 Corps Support Area (CSA),
(CAC), 1-39
AN/PRC-112, E-19 F-130, F-133, F-140
Command Group, 3-202, E-56
Challenges, E-24 Corps Support Command
Command Post (CP), 1-4, 3-160,
Flight Mission, E-61 (COSCOM), 1-26, 1-32,
E-55
3-199, 5-22, 5-45, 5-53, 5-96,
Command Sergeant Major Ground; AN/PRC-127, E-43
5-125, 8-38
(CSM), 3-103 ATS, E-16, E-38
Counter-Drug Operations, 6-75
Command, Control, Ground Have Quick II, E-29
Counter-intelligence (CI), 7-3
Communications, and Ground HF, E-32
Intelligence (C3I), 1-11 Countermeasures Set (CMS),
Messenger, E-46 J-15
Command, Control,
SATCOM, E-40 Counter-terrorism, 6-76, 6-77
Communications, Computers,
and Intelligence (C4I), 3-115, SINCGARS, E-23, E-24, Course of Action (COA), 2-31, 3-
3-157 E-25, E-28 32
Command, Control, Visual and Sound, E-45 Development, 3-50;
Communications, Computers, Wire, E-27 Analysis and Comparison,
Intelligence, Surveillance, and Tactical Radio Networks, 3-51
4
Reconnaissance (C ISR), E-51
2-24
Communications-Electronics D
Digital Layout, K-88 Officer (S6), 3-138, D-11, Data Transfer Cartridge (DTC),
Overview, 3-203 E-58, K-118 3-61
Commander's Critical Communications Security Data Transfer Module (DTM),
Information Requirements (COMSEC), 3-138, 3-164 3-61
(CCIR), 2-35, 2-50, 3-114, 3- Compressed ARC Digitized Deception Operations, 2-50,
188, 4-5, H-15, K-52, K-96, K- Raster Graphic (CADRG), 6-29
105, K-112, K-113, K-126 3-62
Decide, Detect, Deliver, Assess
Responsibilities, K-106
(D3A), 3-28
Index-4
FM 3-04.111
Index-5
FM 3-04.111
Index-6
FM 3-04.111
Index-7
FM 3-04.111
K Low Level Transit Routes 18, 6-22, A-1, A-3, K-9, O-3,
(LLTR), 7-49 O-13
Knots True Airspeed (KTAS), H-
23, H-25, H-27, H-30 Low Probability of Interception Military Grid Reference System
(LPI), 3-160 (MGRS), I-12, I-55, I-76, R-37
L Military Intelligence (MI), 5-239,
M 5-199, G-3, G-25, 5-81, 5-
Land Component Commander
Main Command Post Critical 108, 5-134, 5-184, 7-1
(LCC), G-10
Item Reporting, 3-168 Military Occupational Specialties
Landing Zone (LZ), 1-21, 2-45,
Enemy Factors, 3-170; (MOS), F-1, F-8
3-171, 3-243, 4-59, 4-90, 4-
104, 4-105, E-67, F-234, H-8, Friendly Factors, 3-169; Military Operations Other Than
I-79, R-44 War (MOOTW), 5-221
Main CP Austerity, 3-179;
Large Screen Display (LSD), K- Military Police (MP), 3-183, 7-61,
Security and Defense,
93, K-97, K-100, K-131 D-61
3-180;
Laser Detecting Set (LDS), J-6, Military Strategic and Tactical
Site Selection, 3-171
J-14 Relay (MILSTAR), E-41
Main Supply Routes (MSR),
Laser Range Finder/Designator Military Traffic Management
4-21, 5-44, 5-124, 5-170,
(LRF/D), I-16 Command Transportation
5-177, 7-63, 7-64, D-2, F-39
Engineering Agency
Launch and Recovery (L/R), H- Main Support Battalion (MSB), (MTMCTEA), C-9
4, H-6 1-57, 8-49, 8-66, 8-111, E-59
Minimum Risk Route (MRR), 7-
Liaison Officer (LNO), 1-11, 2- Maintenance Principles, 8-61 49
47, 3-54, 3-55, 3-120, 3-324,
4-4, 5-82, 6-63, G-22 Maintenance Support Teams Mission Essential Task List
(MST), 8-14, 8-15, 8-79, 8-80 (METL), 1-95, 3-103, 3-149,
Team, 3-124
Major Theater War (MTW), 5-93, 5-68, 5-92, 6-62, 6-70, O-11
Light Weight Launchers (LWL), 5-122, 5-151, 5-196, 5-213, 6- Mission Oriented Protective
I-21 50, 8-18 Posture (MOPP), 4-78, 4-80,
Linear Operations, 2-15, 2-16, 2- Maneuver Control System F-99, F-123
17 (MCS), 3-57, 3-59, 3-61, Mission Planning and Control
Line of Sight (LOS), 3-39, 3-53, 3-237, K-45 - K-50, K-65, Site (MPCS), H-4, H-5, H-6
5-26, 5-97, 5-219, E-3, E-6, E- K-87, L-1, L-9
Mission, Enemy, Terrain and
16, J-3, J-29 Maneuver Control System-Light, weather, Troops and support
Lines Of Communication (LOC), K-44, K-47, K-52, K-99 available, Time available, and
2-10, I-55, I-66, I-76 Master Air Attack Plan (MAAP), Civil considerations (METT-
Listening Posts (LP), 3-186 G-37 TC), 2-59, 3-76, 3-97, 3-160,
Local Area Network (LAN), 3-63, Materiel Handling Equipment 3-162, 3-177, 3-198, 4-22, 4-
3-138, 3-139, 3-164, 3-237, K- (MHE), F-49, F-50, F-113 24, 4-27, 4-36, 4-40, 4-42, 4-
16, K-82, K-91, K-97, K-115 51, 4-99, 4-104, 5-78, 5-105,
Materiel Management Center 5-131, 6-87, 8-18, A-1, A-10,
Logistics Officer (S4), 3-132, D- (MMC), F-130, F-132, 8-36 A-12, D-27, F-5, F-32, P-18,
10, K-117 Mean Seal Level (MSL), I-12, Q-54
Logistics Release Point (LRP), I-56, I-67, I-77 Mobile Subscriber Equipment
F-58, F-256 Media Presence, 4-70, M-2 (MSE), 3-120, 3-195, 3-219,
Longbow Apache (LBA), 4-17, 6- Media Support, M-1 - M-18 3-237, 5-200, D-11, E-30, K-
19, I-30, I-31, I-41, J-13 16
Medical Evacuation
Low Altitude Missile (MEDEVAC), 1-12, 8-22, D- Mobile Subscriber Radio
Engagement Zone (LOMEZ), 53, I-49, I-60, I-61, I-73, K-28 Telephone (MSRT), E-31
7-45
Message Handling Table (MHT), Mobility, Countermobility,
Low Altitude Navigation Target K-109 Survivability BOS, 1-13, 2-40,
Infrared Night (LANTIRN), P- 2-43, 5-231
3, P-7 Military Decision-Making
Process (MDMP), 2-52, 3-24, Moving Target Indicator (MTI), 5-
3-25, 3-27, 3-47, 3-54, 4-6, 6- 10, J-28
Index-8
FM 3-04.111
Index-9
FM 3-04.111
Index-10
FM 3-04.111
68, 5-92, 5-121, 6-50, 6-58 - Tactical Air Control Party Techniques, D-49 – D-52
6-60, 6-85, 6-90, F-8, L-17, (TACP), 3-119, 7-29, 7-38, Tactical Satellite (TACSAT),
M-22, O-24, G-2, G-22, P-4, P-35 3-224, E-40, E-57, E-58, L-5
Stability Operations, 4-18, 4-68, Tactical Airspace Integration Tactical Terminal Control
6-66, 6-67 System (TAIS), E-39, G-26, System (TTCS), E-39, F-20
Staff Judge Advocate (SJA), 6- G-27, K-19, K-30, K-33, K-52
Tactics, Techniques, and
57, 6-63, 6-65, 6-75, N-3 Tactical Bulk Fuel Delivery Procedures (TTP), 3-78,
Standard Army Maintenance System (TBFDS), F-156, F- 3-159
System (SAMS), 8-109 161, F-162, F-172, F-173
Tank and Pump Unit (TPU),
SAMS-1, 8-110; Tactical Command Post, 1-16, F-72, F-144
3-55, 3-97, 3-120, 3-154,
SAMS-2, 8-111 Target Acquisition Designation
3-190, 3-194, 3-195, D-17,
Standard Army Management Sight (TADS), I-16, I-30, I-39
E-46, K-31, L-1, L-17
Information Systems Target Priority Lists (TPL), 2-32
Tactical Communication
(STAMIS), 3-248, 8-102, 8- Target Selection Standards
Interface Module (TCIM), 3-61
103, 8-115 (TSS), 3-32, 3-33, 3-51
Tactical Control System (TCS),
Standard Installation/Division Technical Inspector (TI), 8-90
H-10
Personnel System
Tactical Data Information Theater Air-Ground System
(SIDPERS), K-114
Exchange-Broadcast (TADIX- (TAGS), 3-23, G-1
Standard Army Retail Supply
B), L-12 Theater Airlift Liaison Officers,
System-Objective (SARSS-
Tactical Engagement Simulator G-23
O), 8-102, 8-108
System (TESS), 1-23, 1-24 Theater Aviation Brigade, 1-2, 1-
Standard-use Army Aircraft
Tactical Information Broadcast 86 – 1-91
Flight Route (SAAFR), 7-50
Service (TIBS), L-12 Overview, 5-201
Standardization Instructor Pilot
(SP), 3-126 - 3-128, 3-133 Tactical Internet (TI), 3-164, K- Theater Missile Defense (TMD),
76, K-79, K-81, K-84, L-3 5-12
Standardized Integrated
Command Post System Tactical Local Area Network Theater Support Command
(SICPS), K-88, K-89 (TACLAN), 6-1, K-86, K-101 (TSC), 1-88, 3-199, 5-216,
Tactical Operations, Battle 8-39
Standing Operating Procedures
(SOP), 2-19, 3-11, A-22, B-1; Handover, 6-9 – 6-13 Thermal Imaging System (TIS),
Passage of Lines, 6-1 6-19, P-3, Q-39
Utilization, 3-77
Tactical Operations Center Threat Engagement Sequence,
Start Point, D-53, D-57 – D-59,
(TOC), 3-187 – 3-190, D-28, J-21
E-67
E-58 Time of Day (TOD), E-7, E-8, E-
Status Of Forces Agreements
Tactical Related Applications 29
(SOFA), C-35
(TRAP), L-12 Time of Flight (TOF), J-22, J-29
Support Aviation Companies
(SAC), 1-39, 1-47, 1-72, 1-94 Tactical Road March, D-48 – D- Time On Target (TOT), 3-39, P-
73; 15
Surface-to-Air Missile (SAM), H-
11 Actions at Release Point, D- Time Phased Force Deployment
73; Data (TPFDD), K-22
Sustaining Operations, 2-2, F-37
Actions During March, D-63 Traditional TTPs, 3-159
Synthetic Aperture Radar (SAR),
– D-72; Training Plan Development, O-
5-10, H-30
Control Measures, D-56 – 15
System Improvement Program
D-62;
(SIP), E-3, E-28, L-4
Planning, D-53; U
T Procedures and U.S. Army Safety Center
Considerations, D-48; (USASC), 8-125
Tactical Air (TACAIR), 3-169,
3-244, 5-226, 7-19, F-11, L-15 Quartering party, D-54, U.S. Information Agency (USIA),
D-55; M-32, M-35
Index-11
FM 3-04.111
V
Video Cross Link (VIXL), 3-61,
I-2
Video Teleconference (VTC),
3-220
Visual Meteorological Conditions
(VMC), 4-101
Volcano, 1-13, 1-21, 2-42,
3-141, 5-19, 5-58, 5-83
Index-12
FM 3-04.111 (FM 1-111)
21 AUGUST 2003
PETER J. SCHOOMAKER
General, United States Army
Chief of Staff
Official:
JOEL B. HUDSON
Administrative Assistant to the
Secretary of the Army
0320501
DISTRIBUTION:
Active Army, Army National Guard, and U. S. Army Reserve: Not to be distributed.
Electronic Means Only.
PIN: 080935-000